



Produced by Simon Gardner, Steven Giacomelli and the Online
Distributed Proofreading Team at http://www.pgdp.net (This
file was produced from images produced by Core Historical
Literature in Agriculture (CHLA), Cornell University)





Transcriber's Notes

This plain text version of the book has been prepared using the Latin-1
character set.

Italic typeface is represented by the use of _underscores_.

Small capital typeface is represented using ALL CAPS.

The oe ligature is indicated by [oe] and [OE].

Inconsistent spellings, hyphenation, formatting etc. are retained as in
the original, except where typographical errors have been corrected:
these are listed at the end of the book.

       *       *       *       *       *

[Illustration: frontispiece]



                     DOMESTIC ANIMALS.

                  HISTORY AND DESCRIPTION

                          OF THE

             HORSE, MULE, CATTLE, SHEEP, SWINE,
                  POULTRY, AND FARM DOGS.

                    WITH DIRECTIONS FOR

       THEIR MANAGEMENT, BREEDING, CROSSING, REARING,
               FEEDING, AND PREPARATION FOR A
                     PROFITABLE MARKET

                           ALSO,

               THEIR DISEASES, AND REMEDIES.

                       TOGETHER WITH

      FULL DIRECTIONS FOR THE MANAGEMENT OF THE DAIRY.

                      BY R. L. ALLEN,

      AUTHOR OF "COMPEND OF AMERICAN AGRICULTURE," ETC.

                         NEW-YORK:
                 ORANGE JUDD, 41 PARK ROW.
                AGRICULTURAL BOOK PUBLISHER.
                           1865.

Entered according to an Act of Congress in the year 1847

By RICHARD L. ALLEN,

In the Clerk's Office of the District Court of the United States for the
Southern District of New York.




INTRODUCTION.


The object of the following work, on the History, Breeding, Management,
Diseases, &c., of Domestic Animals, is to afford the Stock-breeder and
Grazier a connected view of the entire subject in which he has so deep
an interest. The writer has endeavored to compress within the limited
space assumed as necessary to secure a general circulation and perusal,
such principles and practice, and give to each that relative prominence,
which it becomes the practical man to observe, to realize the greatest
amount of value for the labor and capital devoted to his pursuits.

Their history is essential, as it shows their introduction into the
United States, their progress during the various stages of their
improvement, and the comparative value of the improved and ordinary
breeds. A knowledge of the best mode of breeding and management is of
still higher importance. The first will enable the breeder to preserve
the high character of the animals in his hands, or perhaps still farther
to advance them; while proper management and feeding will prevent that
deterioration and loss from disease, which frequently subtract so much
from his profits.

A larger space has been purposely devoted to the last topics, in
preference to the subject of diseases, as prevention is not only less
troublesome than cure, but much more economical. Feeding and management,
after breeding, are really the important objects in view to the
Stock-breeder and Grazier, for if these be judiciously attended to,
disease among the herds will rarely be known.

The subject of animal diseases is complicated and little understood; and
to be properly comprehended, requires years close, intelligent study,
under every advantage for obtaining the necessary information. Nearly
every disorder assumes various shades of difference, and to remove it
effectually a corresponding change of treatment is required. How absurd
then the idea, that a compilation of formal remedies, administered by an
unskilful or inexperienced manager, will be of material service in
rescuing his herds or flocks from the ravages of disease. All that can
consistently be done, is to give a few simple remedies for the most
common and well-known ailments, and leave to nature or a professional
farrier, such as are more complex or unusual.

This work (with many subsequent and important additions) constitutes a
small part of the "Compend of American Agriculture," the favorable
reception of which, though but recently given to the public, has induced
the writer to offer this important division of the subject in its
present detached form.

New York, November, 1847




INDEX.


                                                                    PAGE

  Animals, domestic, reared in the U. States                           9
      their number and value                                           9
      their improvement                                               10
      adaptation to various objects                                   10
      general form and characteristics                                13
      the lungs                                                       14
      respiration                                                     14
      effects of                                                      17
      perspiration                                                    18
      food which supplies respiration                                 18
      circumstances which augment respiration                         19
      food                                                            21
      purposes fulfilled by food                                      22
      nutritive qualities for various animals                         23
      profit of feeding                                               23
      See CATTLE, SHEEP, &c.

  Ass, the                                                           181
      varieties                                                      181
      characteristics                                                182
      breeding in the U. States                                      182
      as a beast of burden                                           183


  Breeding--principles of                                             11
      See CATTLE, SHEEP, &c.


  Cattle--neat or horned                                              26
      various domestic breeds                                         26
      native cattle                                                   27
      Devons                                                          29
      short horns                                                     30
      Herefords                                                       35
      Ayrshire                                                        38
      management of calves                                            39
      breeding                                                        41
      breaking steers                                                 42
      management of oxen                                              42
      fattening and stall-feeding                                     45
    Diseases                                                      41, 50
      hoven                                                           50
      choking                                                         52
      inflammation of stomach                                         52
      mange or scab                                                   52
      horn-ail--jaundice                                              53
      mad-itch--bloody murrain                                        54
      hoof-ail                                                        55
      loss of cud--scours or diarrh[oe]a--warbles or
        grubs--wounds--puerperal or milk-fever                        56
      caked bags--garget--sore teats--warts                           57

  Cows for dairy                                                      60
      management of                                                   61
      milking                                                         61
      See DAIRY.

  Comparative value of oxen and horses                               190

  Churns                                                              69


  Dairy, the                                                          60

  Dairy--selection and management of cows                         60, 61
      milking                                                         61
      properties of milk                                              62
      variations in                                                   63
      cream--clouted ditto                                            65
    Making butter from sour, sweet, and clouted cream             66, 67
      sourness of cream                                               68
      quickness in churning                                           68
      over-churning                                                   69
      temperature of milk and cream                                   69
      advantages of churn'g the whole                                 69
      cleanliness in churning                                         70
      premium butter, how made                                        70
      Orange county   do. do.                                         71
    Making cheese, how effected                                       72
      creamed and uncreamed                                           73
      buttermilk cheese                                               73
      whey       do.                                                  74
      vegetable substances added                                      74
      preparation of rennet                                           75
      different qualities of cheese                                   77
      warming the milk                                                77
      quality of rennet                                               78
      quantity of rennet                                              78
      treatment of curd                                               79
      separation of whey                                              80
      cheese, salting                                                 81
      addition of cream                                               81
      size of cheese                                                  81
      mode of curing                                                  82
      ammoniacal cheese                                               82
      inoculating  do.                                                82
      premium cheese, how made                                        83

  Ducks--see POULTRY.


  Farm dogs                                                      207-214

  Feeding defined                                                     21
      See CATTLE, SHEEP, &c.

  Food, comparative nutritive qualities of                            22
      how given, purposes fulfilled by it                             22
      changes in                                                      24
      See ANIMALS, PRODUCTS, &c.


  Geese--see POULTRY.

  Guinea-hen--see ditto.


  Hens--see POULTRY.

  Hinny--see ASS.

  Horse--the Arabian and Barb                                        138
      the English                                                    139
      American                                                       141
      Arabians in America                                       139, 140
      Ranger, the Barb--Bussorah--Narraganset pacers--Messenger,
        imported                                                     140
      Morgan horses                                                  142
      Canadian and Spanish                                           143
      Conestoga                                                      143
      Norman                                                         144
      Cart, Cleveland bay, Belfounder                                145
    Eclipse, American                                                141
      points of                                                      146
      habits                                                         147
      breeding                                                       148
      management of colts                                            149
      breaking                                                       150
      longevity, feeding                                             151
    Diseases                                                         154
      glanders                                                       154
      lampas, heaves, &c.                                            155
      catarrh or distemper, spasmodic colic                          156
      flatulent colic                                                158
      inflammation of bowels                                         159
      physicking                                                     162
      worms                                                          164
      bots                                                           164
      wind-galls                                                     165
      the fetlock                                                    166
      cutting                                                        166
      sprain of the coffin-joint--ringbone                           167
      enlargement of the hock                                        168
      curb                                                           168
      bone-spavin--swelled legs                                      170
      grease                                                         171
      setons                                                         173
      founder--poison from weeds                                     174
      inflammation of the eyes                                       175
      stings of hornets, &c.                                         175
      sprain                                                         175
      bruises--fistula                                               176
      wounds--galls                                                  176
      shoeing, contraction of the foot                               176
      corns                                                          177
      over-reach, forging or clicking                                178
      the bearing-rein                                               178
      the bit                                                        179
      stables                                                        180
      comparative labor with oxen                                    190


  Mule, the--breeding in the U. S.                                   183
      rearing and management                                         184
      advantages over horse labor                                    185
      valuable qualities                                             185
      enduringness of                                                186
      in California                                                  188
      economy of mule-labor                                          189


  Poultry--their value                                               214
    Hens--constituent of eggs                                        214
      food                                                           215
      general management                                             216
      the poultry-house                                              218
      varieties                                                 220, 221
      diseases                                                       222
    Turkey, the                                                      223
      breeding and management                                        223
    Peacock, the                                                     224
    Goose, the--varieties--breeding                                  225
      feeding and food                                               225
    Ducks--feeding--varieties                                        226
      breeding and rearing                                           227


  Sheep, the                                                          84
      uses of--importance of                                          85
      varieties of wild--domesticated                                 87
      native                                                          89
    Merino, the, history of                                           90
      exportation from Spain                                          92
      importation into the U. States                                  93
      varieties                                                       94
    Saxon, the                                                        96
    Rambouillet, the                                                  99
      history of Merino in U. States                                 101
      improvements of                                                102
      peculiarities of                                               103
      breeding                                                       104
      localities for rearing                                         106
    South-Down, the, history of                                      106
    Cheviot, the                                                     109
    Long-wools, the                                                  110
      improvement of the Bakewell                                    110
      improvement of Cotswold and Lincolnshire                       112
      peculiarities of the Long-wools                                113
      importation into the U. States                                 113
      breeding sheep                                                 113
    Winter management                                                116
      sheep-barns and sheds                                          116
      racks, mangers, and troughs                                    117
      food                                                           118
      management of ewes, yeaning                                    119
      management of lambs                                            119
      castrating and docking                                         120
      tagging or clatting                                            121
    Summer management and food                                       121
      washing                                                        122
      shearing                                                       124
      smearing and salving                                           125
      weaning                                                        126
      drafting                                                       126
      stall feeding--management on the prairies                      127
    Diseases                                                         128
      diarrh[oe]a or scours                                          129
      looseness in lambs, dysentery                                  130
      hoven, braxy                                                   130
      costiveness, stretches, poison, inflammation of lungs, rot     131
      foot-rot                                                       132
      flies, maggots, gad-fly                                        133
      swollen mouth, foul noses, weakness, scab                      134
      ticks, pelt-rot, staggers or sturdy                            135
      abortion, garget, bleeding                                     136
      wounds                                                         137
      to protect from wolves and foxes                               138

  Shepherd's dog                                                     209

  Swine                                                              192
      various breeds                                                 194
      breeding and rearing                                           198
      rearing and fattening, large weights                           199
      treatment of food                                              201
      products of the carcass                                        202
      lard oil, how made                                             203
      slearine and oleine                                            203
      curing pork and hams                                           203
    Diseases                                                         204
      coughs and inflammation of the lungs, costiveness, itch,
        kidney-worm                                                  205
      blind staggers                                                 206


  Wild Boar                                                          193




DOMESTIC ANIMALS.




CHAPTER I.

INTRODUCTORY REMARKS--GENERAL PRINCIPLES OF BREEDING, NUTRITION,
MANAGEMENT, &c.


The principal domestic animals reared for economical purposes in the
United States, are Horned or neat cattle, the Horse, the Mule, Sheep,
and Swine. A few Asses are bred, but for no other object than to keep up
the supply of jacks for propagating mules. We have also goats, rabbits,
and the house domestics, the dog and cat; the two former, only in very
limited numbers, but both the latter much beyond our legitimate wants.
There have been a few specimens of the Alpaca imported, and an
arrangement is now in progress for the introduction of a flock of
several hundred, which, if distributed among intelligent and wealthy
agriculturists, as proposed, will test their value for increasing our
agricultural resources. We shall confine ourselves to some general
considerations, connected with the first-mentioned and most important of
our domestic animals.

Their number as shown by the agricultural statistics collected in 1839,
by order of our General Government, was 15,000,000 neat cattle;
4,335,000 horses and mules, (the number of each not being specified;)
19,311,000 sheep; and 26,300,000 swine. There is much reason to question
the entire accuracy of these returns, yet there is doubtless an
approximation to the truth. Sheep have greatly increased since that
period, and would probably number, the present year, (1848,) not less
than 30,000,000; and if our own manufactures continue to thrive, and we
should moreover become wool exporters, of which there is now a
reasonable prospect, an accurate return for 1850, will undoubtedly give
us not less than 33,000,000 for the entire Union. There has been a great
increase in the value of the other animals enumerated, but not in a
ratio corresponding with that of sheep. This is not only manifest in
their augmented numbers, but in the gradual and steady improvement of
the species.

It may be safely predicted, that this improvement will not only be
sustained, but largely increased; for there are some intelligent and
spirited breeders to be found in every section of the country, whose
liberal exertions and successful examples are doing much for this
object. Wherever intelligence and sound judgment are to be found, it
will be impossible long to resist the effects of a comparison between
animals, which, on an equal quantity of the same food, with the same
attention and in the same time, will return 50, 20, or even 10 per cent.
more in their intrinsic value or marketable product, than the ordinary
class. This improvement has been, relatively, most conspicuous in the
Western and Southern states; not that the present average of excellence
in their animals surpasses, or even reaches that of the North and East;
but the latter have long been pursuing this object, with more or less
energy, and they have for many years had large numbers of excellent
specimens of each variety; while with few exceptions, if we exclude the
blood-horse or racing nag, the former have, till recently, paid
comparatively little attention to the improvement of their domestic
animals. The spirit for improvement through extensive sections, is now
awakened, and the older settled portions of the country may hereafter
expect competitors, whose success will be fully commensurate with their
own. Before going into the management of the different varieties, we
will give some general principles and remarks applicable to the
treatment of all.

_The purpose for which animals are required_, should be first
determined, before selecting such as may be necessary either for
breeding or use. Throughout the Northeastern states, cows for the dairy,
oxen for the yoke, and both for the butcher, are wanted. In much of the
West and South, beef alone is the principal object; while the dairy is
neglected, and the work of the ox is seldom relied on, except for
occasional drudgery.

Sheep may be wanted almost exclusively for the fleece, or for the fleece
and heavy mutton, or in the neighborhood of markets, for large early
lambs. The pastures and winter food, climate, and other conditions,
present additional circumstances, which should be well considered before
determining on the particular breed, either of cattle or sheep, that
will best promote the interest of the farmer.

The kind of work for which the horse may be wanted, whether as a
roadster, for the saddle, as a heavy team horse, or the horse of all
work, must be first decided, before selecting the form or character of
the animal.

The range of pig excellence is more circumscribed, as it is only
necessary to breed such as will yield the greatest amount of valuable
carcass, within the shortest time, and with the least expense.


PRINCIPLES OF BREEDING.

All breeding is founded on the principle, that _like begets like_. This
is, however, liable to some exceptions, and is much more generally true
when _breeding down_ than when _breeding up_. If two animals (which can
never be exactly similar in all respects) are requisite to the
perpetuation of the species, it necessarily results, that the progeny
must differ in a more or less degree from each parent. With wild
animals, and such of the domestic as are allowed to propagate without
the interference of art, and whose habits, treatment, and food are
nearly similar to their natural condition, the change through successive
generations is scarcely perceptible. It is only when we attempt to
improve their good qualities, that it is essential carefully to
determine, and rigidly to apply, what are adopted as the present
scientific principles of breeding. We cannot believe that we have
penetrated beyond the mere threshold of this art. Unless, then, we
launch into experiments, which are necessarily attended with
uncertainty, our duty will be, to take for our guide the most successful
practice of modern times, until further discoveries enable us to modify
or add to such as are already known and adopted. We may assume, then, as
the present rules for this art,

1st. That the animals selected for breed, should unite in themselves all
the good qualities we wish to perpetuate in the offspring.

2d. These qualities, technically called _points_, should be inbred in
the animals as far as practicable, by a long line of descent from
parents similarly constituted. The necessity for this rule is evident
from the fact, that in mixing different species, and especially
mongrels, with a long-established breed, the latter will most strongly
stamp the issue with its own peculiarities. This is forcibly illustrated
in the case of the Devon cattle, an ancient race, whose color, form, and
characteristics are strikingly perpetuated, sometimes to the sixth or
even a later generation. So far is this principle carried by many
experienced breeders, that they will use an animal of indifferent
external appearance, but of approved descent, (_blood_,) in preference
to a decidedly superior one, whose pedigree is imperfect.

3d. All the conditions of soil, situation, climate, treatment, and food,
should be favorable to the object sought.

4th. As a general rule, the female should be relatively larger than the
male. This gives ample room for the perfect development of the f[oe]tus,
easy parturition, and a large supply of milk for the offspring, at a
period in its existence, when food has a greater influence in perfecting
character and form, than at any subsequent time.

5th. Exceptions to this rule may be made, when greater size is required
than can be obtained from the female, and especially when more vigor and
hardiness of constitution are desirable. For this purpose, strong
masculine development in the sire is proper, and if otherwise
unattainable, something of coarseness may be admitted, as this may be
afterwards corrected, and nothing will atone for want of constitution
and strength.

6th. Pairing should be with a strict reference to correcting the
imperfections of one animal, by a corresponding excellence in the other.

7th. _Breeding in-and-in_, or propagating from animals nearly allied,
may be tolerated under certain circumstances, though seldom; and only in
extreme cases between those of the same generation, as brother and
sister. When the animal possesses much stamina and peculiar merit, which
it is desired to perpetuate in the breed, it may be done either in the
ascending or descending line, as in breeding the son to the parent, or
the parent to his own progeny. This has been practised with decided
advantage, and in some cases has even been continued successively, as
low as the sixth generation.

8th. It is always better to avoid close relationship, by the selection
of equally meritorious stock-getters of the same breed, from other
sources.

9th. Wholesome, nutritious food, at all times sufficient to keep the
animals steadily advancing, should be provided, but they must never be
allowed to get fat. Of the two evils, starving is preferable to surfeit.
Careful treatment, and the absence of disease, must be always fully
considered.

10th. Animals should never be allowed to breed either too early or too
late in life. These periods cannot be arbitrarily laid down, but must
depend on their time of maturity, the longevity of the breed, and the
stamina of the individual.

11th. No violent cross, or mixing of distinct breeds, should ever be
admitted for the purposes of perpetuation, as of cattle of diverse
sizes; horses of unlike characters; the Merino and the long-wools, or
even the long, or short, and the middle-wools. For carcass and
constitution, these crosses are unexceptionable; and it is a practice
very common in this country, and judicious enough where the whole
produce is early destined for the shambles. But when the progeny are
designed for breeders, the practice should be branded with unqualified
reprehension.


GENERAL FORM AND CHARACTERISTICS.

Within certain limits, these may be reduced to a common standard. All
animals should have a good head, well set up; a clean fine muzzle, and a
blight, clear and full, yet perfectly placid eye. With the exception of
the dog and cat, whose original nature is ferocity, and whose whole
life, unless diverted from their natural instincts, is plunder and prey;
and the jockey racehorse, which is required to take the purse, at any
hazard of life or limb to the groom; a mild, quiet eye is indispensable
to the profitable use of the domestic brute. The neck should be well
formed, not too long, tapering to its junction with the head, and
gradually enlarging to a firm, well-expanded attachment to the back,
shoulders, and breast. The back or chine should be short, straight, and
broad; the ribs springing out from the backbone nearly at right angles,
giving a rounded appearance to the carcass, and reaching well behind to
a close proximity to the hip; tail well set on, and full at its junction
with the body, yet gradually tapering to fineness; thighs, fore-arms,
and crops well developed; projecting breast or brisket; the fore-legs
straight, and hind ones properly bent, strong and full where attached to
the carcass, but small and tapering below; good and sound joints; dense,
strong bones, but not large; plenty of fine muscle in the right places;
and hair or wool, fine and soft. The chest in all animals should be
full, for it will be invariably found, that only such will do the most
work, or fatten easiest on the least food.


The Lungs.

From the last-mentioned principle, founded on long experience and
observation, Cline inferred, and he has laid it down as an
incontrovertible position, that the lungs should always be large; and
Youatt expresses the same opinion. This is undoubtedly correct as to
working beasts, the horse and the ox, which require full and free
respiration, to enable them to sustain great muscular efforts. But later
physiologists have assumed, perhaps from closer and more accurate
observations, that the fattening propensity is in the ratio of the
smallness of the lungs. Earl Spencer has observed, that this is fully
shown in the pig, the sheep, the ox, and the horse, whose aptitude to
fatten and smallness of lungs, are in the order enumerated.

This position is further illustrated by the different breeds of the same
classes of animals. The Leicester sheep have smaller lungs than the
South Down; and it has been found, that a number of the former, on a
given quantity of food, and in the same time, reached 28 lbs. a quarter,
while the South Downs with a greater consumption of food, attained in
the same period, only 18 lbs. The Chinese pigs have much smaller lungs
than the Irish, and the former will fatten to a given weight, on a much
less quantity of food than the latter. (_Playfair._) The principle would
seem to be corroborated by the fact, that animals generally fatten
faster in proportion to the quantity of food they consume, as they
advance towards a certain stage of maturity; during all which time, the
secretion of internal fat is gradually compressing the size, by reducing
the room for the action of the lungs. Hence, the advantage of carrying
the fattening beast to an advanced point, by which not only the quality
of carcass is improved, but the quantity is relatively greater for the
amount of food consumed. These views are intimately connected, and fully
correspond, with the principles of


RESPIRATION IN ANIMALS.

From careful experiments, it has been found that all animals daily
consume a much larger quantity of food than the aggregate of what may
have been retained in the system, added to what has been expelled in the
f[oe]ces and urine, and what has escaped by perspiration. Boussingault,
who combines the characteristics of an ingenious chemist, a vigilant
observer, and a practical agriculturist, made an experiment with a
"milch-cow and a full-grown horse, which were placed in stalls so
contrived that the droppings and the urine could be collected without
loss. Before being made the subjects of experiment, the animals were
ballasted or fed for a month with the same ration that was furnished to
them, during the three days and three nights which they passed in the
experimental stalls. During the month, the weight of the animals did not
vary sensibly, a circumstance which happily enables us to assume that
neither did the weight vary during the seventy-two hours when they were
under especial observation.

The cow was foddered with after-math, hay, and potatoes; the horse with
the same hay and oats. The quantities of forage were accurately weighed,
and their precise degree of moistness and their composition were
determined from average samples. The water drunk was measured, its
saline and earthy constituents having been previously ascertained. The
excrementitious matters passed, were of course collected with the
greatest care; the excrements, the urine, and the milk were weighed, and
the constitution of the whole estimated from elementary analyses of
average specimens of each. The results of the two experiments are given
in the table on the next page.

The oxygen and hydrogen that are not accounted for in the sum of the
products have not disappeared in the precise proportions requisite to
form water; the excess of hydrogen amounts to as many as from 13 to 15
dwts. It is probable that this hydrogen of the food became changed into
water by combining during respiration with the oxygen of the air."


FOOD CONSUMED BY THE HORSE IN 24 HOURS.

  Key to columns:
  [F] = Forage.
  [W] = Weight in the wet state
  [D] = Weight in the dry state

  -----+---+-------+-----------------------------------------------------------
       |   |       |             Elementary Matter in the Food.
   [F] |[W]|  [D]  |-------+------------+------------+------------+------------
       |   |       |       |            |            |            |Salts and
       |   |       |Carbon.| Hydrogen.  |  Oxygen.   |   Azote.   |  Earths.
  -----+---+-------+-------+------------+------------+------------+------------
       |lb.|lb. oz.|lb. oz.|lb. oz. dwt.|lb. oz. dwt.|lb. oz. dwt.|lb. oz. dwt.
  Hay  |20 |17   4 | 7  11 | 0  10    7 | 6   8    8 | 0   3    2 | 1   6   14
  Oats | 6 | 5   2 | 2   7 | 0   3   18 | 1  10   14 | 0   1    7 | 0   2   10
  Water|43 |  ...  |  ...  |    ...     |    ...     |    ...     | 0   0    8
  Total|69 |22   6 |10   6 | 1   2    5 | 8   7    2 | 0   4    9 | 1   9   12
  -----+---+-------+-------+------------+------------+------------+------------


PRODUCTS VOIDED BY THE HORSE IN 24 HOURS.

  -----------------+------------+------------+ ...
                   |            |            |
                   | Weight in  | Weight in  |
  [P]=Products.    |  the wet   |  the dry   |
                   |  state.    |  state.    |
  -----------------+------------+------------+
                   |lb. oz. dwt.|lb. oz. dwt.|
  [U]=Urine        | 3   6   15 | 9   9   14 |
  [E]=Excrements   |38   2    2 | 9   5    6 |
  -----------------+------------+------------+
  [T]=    Total    |71   8   17 |10   3    0 |
  [F]=Total matter}|69   0    0 |22   6    0 |
       of the food}|            |            |
                   +------------+------------+
  [D]=Difference   |27   3    3 |12   3    0 |
  -----------------+------------+------------+ ...

    ----+----------------------------------------------------------------
        |               Elementary Matter in the Products.
        +------------+------------+------------+------------+------------
    [P] |            |            |            |            |Salts and
        |  Carbon.   | Hydrogen.  |  Oxygen.   |   Azote.   |  Earths.
    ----+------------+------------+------------+------------+------------
        |lb. oz. dwt.|lb. oz. dwt.|lb. oz. dwt.|lb. oz. dwt.|lb. oz. dwt.
    [U] | 0   3   10 | 0   0    7 | 0   1    2 | 0   1    4 | 0   3   10
    [E] | 3   7   17 | 0   5   15 | 3   6   14 | 0   2   10 | 1   6   10
    ----+------------+------------+------------+------------+------------
    [T] | 3  11    7 | 0   6    2 | 3   7   16 | 0   3   14 | 1  10    0
    [F] |10   6    0 | 1   2    5 | 8   7    2 | 0   4    9 | 1   9   12
        |            |            |            |
        +------------+------------+------------+------------+------------
    [D] | 6   6   13 | 0   8    3 | 4  11    6 | 0   0   15 | 0   0   12
    ----+------------+------------+------------+------------+------------

  WATER CONSUMED BY THE HORSE       |WATER VOIDED BY THE HORSE
        IN  24 HOURS.               |      IN  24 HOURS.
  ------------------+---------------+--------------------+------------
                    |  lbs.   oz.   |                    |  lbs.   oz.
  With the hay      |    2     3    |With the urine      |    2     6
  With the oats     |    0    14    |With the excrements |   23     8
  Taken as drink    |   35     3    |                    |
                    +---------------|                    |------------
    Total consumed  |   38     4    |  Total voided      |   25    14
                                    |Water consumed      |   38     4
                                    |                    |------------
  Water exhaled by pulmonary and cutaneous transpiration |   12     6
  -------------------------------------------------------+------------

       *       *       *       *       *

  FOOD CONSUMED BY THE COW IN 24 HOURS.
  -------------------+------------+------------+ ...
                     |            |            |
  [F]=Fodder.        | Weight in  | Weight in  |
                     |  the wet   |  the dry   |
                     |  state.    |  state.    |
  -------------------+------------+------------+
                     |lb. oz. dwt.|lb. oz. dwt.|
  [P]=Potatoes       | 40  2    5 |11   2    1 |
  [H]=After-math hay | 20  1    2 |16  11    0 |
  [W]=Water          |160  0    0 |    ...     |
                     +------------+------------+
  [T]=  Total        |220  3    7 |28   1    1 |
  -------------------+------------+------------+ ...

    ----+----------------------------------------------------------------
        |                 Elementary Matter in the Food.
    [F] +------------+------------+------------+------------+------------
        |            |            |            |            |Salts and
        |  Carbon.   | Hydrogen.  |  Oxygen.   |   Azote.   |  Earths.
    ----+------------+------------+------------+------------+------------
        |lb. oz. dwt.|lb. oz. dwt.|lb. oz. dwt.|lb. oz. dwt.|lb. oz. dwt.
    [P] | 4  11    2 | 0   7   15 | 4  10   17 | 0   1   12 | 0   6   13
    [H] | 7  11   11 | 0  11    7 | 5  10   17 | 0   4   17 | 1   8    6
    [W] |    ...     |    ...     |    ...     |    ...     | 0   1   12
        +------------+------------+------------+------------+------------
    [T] |12  10   13 | 1   7    2 |10   9   14 | 0   6    9 | 2   4   11
    ----+------------+------------+------------+------------+------------

  PRODUCTS VOIDED BY THE COW IN 24 HOURS.
  ------------------------+-------------+------------+ ...
                          |             |            |
                          | Weight in   | Weight in  |
  [P]=Products.           |  the wet    |   the dry  |
                          |  state.     |    state.  |
  ------------------------+-------------+------------+
                          | lb. oz. dwt.|lb. oz. dwt.|
  [E]=Excrements          | 76   1    9 |10   8   12 |
  [U]=Urine               | 21  11   12 | 2   6   17 |
  [M]=Milk                | 22  10   10 | 3   1    0 |
                          +-------------+------------+
  [T]=Total               |120  11   11 |16   4    9 |
  [F]=  "  matter of food |220   3    7 |28   1    1 |
                          +-------------+------------+
  [D]=Difference          | 99   3   16 |11   8   12 |
  ------------------------+-------------+------------+ ...

    ----+----------------------------------------------------------------
        |               Elementary Matter in the Products.
        +------------+------------+------------+------------+------------
    [P] |            |            |            |            |Salts and
        |  Carbon.   | Hydrogen.  |  Oxygen.   |   Azote.   |Earths.
    ----+------------+------------+------------+------------+------------
        |lb. oz. dwt.|lb. oz. dwt.|lb. oz. dwt.|lb. oz. dwt.|lb. oz. dwt.
    [E] | 4   7    0 | 0   6   13 | 4   0    9 | 0   2   19 | 1   3    8
    [U] | 0   8    7 | 0   0   16 | 0   8    3 | 0   1    3 | 1   0    6
    [M] | 1   8    3 | 0   3    3 | 0  10    6 | 0   1    9 | 0   1   16
        +------------+------------+------------+------------+------------
    [T] | 6  11   10 | 0  10   12 | 5   6   18 | 9   5   11 | 2   5   10
    [F] |12  10   13 | 1   7    2 |10   9   14 | 0   6    9 | 2   4   11
        +------------+------------+------------+------------+------------
    [D] | 5  11    3 | 0   8   10 | 5   2   16 | 0   0   18 | 0   0   19
    ----+------------+------------+------------+------------+------------

  WATER CONSUMED BY THE COW            | WATER VOIDED BY THE COW
       IN  24 HOURS.                   |       IN  24 HOURS.
  ------------------------+------------+----------------------+-----------
                          | lbs.   oz. |                      | lbs.   oz.
  With the potatoes       |  23    12  |With the excrements   |  53    10
  With the hay            |   2     9  |With the urine        |  15    14
  Taken as drink          | 132     0  |With the milk         |  16     3
                          +------------+                      +-----------
    Total consumed        | 158     5  |  Total voided        |  85    11
                                       |Water consumed        | 158     5
                                                              +-----------
  Water passed off by pulmonary and cutaneous transpiration   |  79     2

We here perceive a large loss of water, carbon, hydrogen, &c. Nearly all
this loss of carbon and hydrogen escaped by respiration, while most of
the water, oxygen, nitrogen, and salts, passed off in perspiration. In
further illustration of the subject of respiration, Liebig says, "from
the accurate determination of the quantity of carbon daily taken into
the system in the food, as well as of that proportion of it which passes
out of the body in the f[oe]ces and urine, _unburned_, that is, in some
form uncombined with oxygen, it appears that an adult taking moderate
exercise, consumes 13.9 oz. of carbon daily." The foregoing are facts in
the animal economy, capable of vast practical bearing in the management
of our domestic animals. But before following out these principles to
their application, let us briefly examine


The Effects of Respiration.

We have seen from the experiment of Boussingault, that there is a loss
of 6 lbs. 6 oz. of carbon, and 8 oz. 3 dwt. of hydrogen in the food of
the horse, and something less in that of the cow, every 24 hours, which
has not been left in the system, nor has it escaped by the evacuations.
What has become of so large an amount of solid matter? It has escaped
through the lungs and been converted into air. The carbon and hydrogen
of the food have undergone those various transformations which are
peculiar to the animal economy, digestion, assimilation, &c., which it
is not necessary, nor will our limits permit us here to explain; and
they appear at last in the veinous blood, which in the course of its
circulation is brought into the cells of the lungs. The air inhaled is
sent through every part of their innumerable meshes, and is there
separated from the blood, only by the delicate tissues or membranes
which enclose it. A portion of the carbon and hydrogen escapes from the
blood into the air-cells, and at the instant of their contact with the
air, they affect a chemical union with its oxygen, forming carbonic acid
and the vapor of water, which is then expired, and a fresh supply of
oxygen is inhaled. This operation is again repeated, through every
successive moment of animal existence.

Besides other purposes which it is probably designed to subserve, but
which have hitherto eluded the keenest research of chemical physiology,
one obvious result of respiration is, the elevation of the temperature
of the animal system. By the ever-operating laws of nature, this
chemical union of two bodies in the formation of a third, disengages
latent heat, which taking place in contact with the blood, is by it
diffused throughout the whole frame. The effect is precisely analogous
to the combustion of fuel, oils, &c., in the open air.


Perspiration

Is the counteracting agent which modifies this result, and prevents the
injurious effects, which, under exposure to great external heat, would
ensure certain destruction. And this too, it will have been seen, is
provided at the expense of the animal food. When from excessive heat,
caused by violent exercise or otherwise, by which respiration is
accelerated and the animal temperature becomes elevated, the papillae of
the skin pour the limpid fluid through their innumerable ducts, which in
its conversion into vapor, seize upon the animal heat and remove it from
the system, producing that delicious coolness so grateful to the
laboring man and beast in a sultry summer's day. These two opposing
principles, like the antagonistic operations of the regulator in
mechanics, keep up a perfect balance in the vital machine, and enable
that entire division of the animal creation, distinguished as
warm-blooded, including man and the brute, all the feathered tribes, the
whale, the seal, the walrus, &c., to maintain an equilibrium of
temperature, whether under the equator or the poles; on the peaks of
Chimborazo, the burning sands of Zahara, or plunged in the depths of the
Arctic Ocean.

The connection between the size of the lungs, and the aptitude of
animals to fatten, will be more apparent from the fact, that the carbon
and hydrogen which are abstracted, constitute two of the only three
elements of fat. The larger size, the fuller play, and the greater
activity of the lungs, by exhausting more of the materials of fat, must
necessarily diminish its formation in the animal system; unless it can
be shown, which has never yet been done, that the removal of a portion
of the fat-forming principles accelerates the assimilation of the
remainder.


The Food which supplies Respiration.

This, in the herbivorous animals, after they are deprived of the milk,
which furnishes it in abundance, is the starch, gum, sugar, vegetable
fats, and oils that exist in the vegetables, grain, and roots which they
consume; and in certain cases where there is a deficiency of other
food, it is sparingly furnished in woody and cellular fibre. All these
substances constitute the principal part of dry vegetable food, and are
made up of three elements, _which in starch, gum, cane-sugar, and
cellular fibre, exist in precisely the same proportions_, viz: 44 per
cent. of carbon, 6.2 of hydrogen, and 40.8 of oxygen.

Grape sugar, woody fibre, and vegetable and animal fats and oils are
made up of the same elements, but in different proportions, the last
containing much more carbon and hydrogen than those above specified. In
the fattening animals, it is supposed the vegetable fats and oils are
immediately transferred to the fat cells, undergoing only such slight
modification as perfectly adapts them to the animal economy, while
respiration is supplied by the other enumerated vegetable matters. If
these last are taken into the stomach beyond the necessary demand for
its object, they too are converted by the animal functions into fat, and
are stored up in the system for future use. But if the supply of the
latter is insufficient for respiration, it first appropriates the
vegetable fat contained in the food; if this is deficient, it draws on
the accumulated stores of animal fat already secreted in the system, and
when these too are exhausted, it seizes upon what is contained in the
tissues and muscle. When the animal commences drawing upon its own
resources for the support of its vital functions, deterioration begins;
and if long continued, great emaciation succeeds, which is soon followed
by starvation and death.

The carnivorous animals are furnished with their respiratory excretions,
from the animal fat and fibre which exist in their food, and which the
herbivorae had previously abstracted from the vegetable creation.


Circumstances which augment Respiration.

These are, exercise, cold, and an abundant supply of food. Exercise,
besides exhausting the materials of fat, produces a waste of fibre and
tissue, the muscular and nitrogenized parts of the animal system; and it
is obvious from the foregoing principles, that cold requires a
corresponding demand for carbon and hydrogen to keep up the vital
warmth. The consumption of food to the fullest extent required for
invigorating the frame, creates a desire for activity, and it insensibly
induces full respiration. The well-fed, active man, unconsciously draws
a full, strong breath; while the abstemious and the feeble, unwittingly
use it daintily, as if it were a choice commodity not to be lavishly
expended. If the first be observed when sleep has effectually arrested
volition, the expanded chest will be seen, heaving with the long-drawn,
sonorous breath; while that of the latter will exhibit the gentle repose
of the infant on its mother's breast.

The difference between the food of the inhabitants of the polar and
equatorial regions, is strikingly illustrative of the demands both for
breathing and perspiration. The latter are almost destitute of clothing,
and subsist on their light, juicy, tropical fruits, which contain
scarcely 12 per cent. of carbon, yet furnish all the elements for
abundant perspiration; while the former are imbedded in furs, and devour
gallons of train oil or its equivalent of fat, which contains nearly 80
per cent. of carbon, that is burnt up in respiration to maintain a
necessary warmth.

The bear retires to his den in the beginning of winter, loaded with fat,
which he has accumulated from the rich, oily mast abounding in the woods
in autumn. There he lies for months, snugly coiled and perfectly
dormant; the thickness of his shaggy coat, his dry bed of leaves, and
well-protected den, effectually guarding him from cold, which in
addition to his want of exercise, draw slightly upon respiration to keep
up the vital heat. When the stores of carbon and hydrogen contained in
the fat are expended, his hunger and cold compel him to leave his
winter-quarters, again to wander in pursuit of food.

Many of the swallow tribes, in like manner, hybernate in large hollow
trees, and for months eke out a torpid, scarcely perceptible existence,
independent of food. Activity and full respiration, on the return of
spring, demand a support, which is furnished in the myriads of flies
they daily consume. The toad and frog have repeatedly been found in a
torpid state, imbedded in limestones, sandstones, and the breccias,
where they were probably imprisoned for thousands of years without a
morsel of food; yet when exposed to the warmth of the vital air and the
stimulus of its oxygen, they have manifested all the activity of their
species. This they are enabled to sustain only by an enormous
consumption of insects.

Dr. Playfair states, that in an experiment made by Lord Ducie, 100 sheep
were placed in a shed, and ate 20 pounds of Swedes turnips each per day;
another 100 were placed in the open air, and ate 25 pounds per day; yet
the former, which had one-fifth less food, weighed, after a few weeks,
three pounds more per head than the latter. He then fed five sheep in
the open air, between the 21st November and 1st December. They consumed
90 pounds of food per day, the temperature being at 44 deg., and at the end
of this time, they weighed two pounds less than when first exposed. Five
sheep were then placed under a shed, and allowed to run about in a
temperature of 49 deg.. At first they consumed 82 pounds per day; then 70
pounds, and at the end of the time they had gained 23 pounds. Again,
five sheep were placed under a shed as before, and not allowed to take
any exercise. They ate at first, 64 pounds of food per day, then 58
pounds, and increased in weight 30 pounds. Lastly, five sheep were kept
quiet and covered, and in the dark. They ate 35 pounds per day, and
increased eight pounds.

Mr. Childers states, that 80 Leicester sheep in the open field, consumed
50 baskets of cut turnips per day, besides oil-cake. On putting them in
a shed, they were immediately able to consume only 30 baskets, and soon
after but 25, being only half the quantity required before, and yet they
fattened as rapidly as when eating the largest quantity. The minimum of
food, then, required for the support of animals, is attained when
closely confined in a warm, dark shelter; and the maximum, when running
at large, exposed to all weathers.


THE FEEDING OF ANIMALS.

This should be regulated by a variety of considerations. The young which
may be destined for maturity, should be supplied with milk from the dam
until weaning-time. No food can be substituted for the well-filled udder
of the parent, which is so safe, healthful, and nutritious. If from any
cause there is deficiency or total privation, it must be made up by that
kind of food, meal-gruel, &c., which, in its composition, approaches
nearest in quality to the milk. At a more advanced age, or the time for
weaning, grass, hay, roots, or grain, may be substituted, in quantities
sufficient to maintain a steady but _not a forced growth_. Stuffing can
only be tolerated in animals which are speedily destined for the
slaughter. Alternately improving and falling back, is injurious to all
stock. _An animal should never be fat but once._ Especially is high
feeding bad for breeding animals. Much as starving is to be deprecated,
the prejudicial effects of repletion are still greater. The calf or lamb
intended for the butcher, may be pushed forward with all possible
rapidity. Horses or colts should never exceed a good working or breeding
condition.


Purposes fulfilled by different Kinds of Food.

The objects designed to be answered by food, are to a certain extent the
same. All food is intended to meet the demands of respiration and
nutrition, and fattening to a greater or less degree. But some are
better suited to one object than others, and it is for the intelligent
farmer to select such as will most effectually accomplish his particular
purposes.

The very young animal requires large quantities of the phosphate of lime
for the formation of bone; and this is yielded in the milk in larger
proportions than from any other food. The growing animal wants bone,
muscle, and a certain amount of fat, and these are procured from the
grasses, roots, and grain; from the former when fed alone, and from the
two latter when mixed with hay or grass.

Horses, cattle, and sheep need hay to qualify the too watery nature of
the roots, and the too condensed nutritiveness of the grain. Animals
that are preparing for the shambles, require vegetable oils or fat,
starch, sugar, or gum. The first is contained in great abundance in flax
and cotton-seed, the sun-flower, and many other of the mucilaginous
seeds. Indian corn is the most fattening grain. The potato contains the
greatest proportion of starch, and the sugar-beet has large quantities
of sugar, and both consequently are good for stall-feeding. The ripe
sugar-cane is perhaps the most fattening of vegetables, if we except the
oily seeds and grain. The Swedes turnip is a good food to commence with
fattening cattle and sheep; but where great ripeness in animals is
desired, they should be followed with beets, carrots or potatoes, and
grain.

The table of the average composition of the different crops, which we
subjoin from Johnston, shows the comparative qualities of various kinds
of food, and it will be found a valuable reference for their nutritive
and fattening qualities. He says, "In drawing up this table, I have
adopted the proportions of gluten, for the most part, from Boussingault.
Some of them, however, appear to be very doubtful. The proportions of
fatty matter are also very uncertain. With a few exceptions, those above
given have been taken from Sprengel, and they are, in general, stated
considerably too low. It is an interesting fact, that the proportion of
fatty matter in and immediately under the husk of the grains of corn, is
generally much greater than in the substance of the corn itself. Thus I
have found the pollard of wheat to yield more than twice as much oil as
the fine flour obtained from the same sample of grain. The four
portions separated by the miller from a superior sample of wheat grown
in the neighborhood of Durham, gave of oil respectively: fine flour, 1.5
per cent.; pollard, 2.4; boxings, 3.6; and bran, 3.3 per cent. Dumas
states that the husk of oats sometimes yields as much as five or six per
cent. of oil." The columns under starch, &c., and fatty matter, denote
the value for respiration or sustaining life, and the fattening
qualities; that under gluten, the capacity for yielding muscle and
supporting labor; and saline matter indicates something of the
proportions which are capable of being converted into bones.

                Water.  Husk or  Starch,   Gluten,      Fatty     Saline
                        woody    gum, and  albumen,     matter.   matter
                        fibre.   sugar.    legumen, &c.

  Wheat,          16     15      55        10 to 15     2 to 4 J.   2.0
  Barley,         15     15      60          12?          2.5 J.    2.0
  Oats,           16     20      50          14.5?        5.6 J.    3.5
  Rye,            12     10      60          14.5         3.0       1.0
  Indian corn,    14     15?     50          12.0       5 to 9 D.   1.5
  Buckwheat,      16?    25?     50          14.5         0.4?      1.5
  Beans,          16     10      40          28.0         2 +       3.0
  Peas,           13      8      50          24.0         2.8?      2.8

  Potatoes,       75?     5?     12?          2.25        0.3      0.8 to 1
  Turnips,        85      3      10           1.2            ?     0.8 to 1
  Carrots,        85      3      10           2.0         0.4       1.0

  Meadow hay,     14     30      40           7.1       2 to 5 D.  5 to 10
  Clover hay,     14     25      40           9.3         3.0       9
  Pea straw,   10 to 15  25      45          12.3         1.5       5
  Oat do.         12     45      35           1.3         0.8       6
  Wheat do.    12 to 15  50      30           1.3         0.5       5
  Barley do.      do.    50      30           1.3         0.8       5
  Rye do.         do.    45      38           1.3         0.5       3
  Indian corn do. 12     25      52           3.0         1.7       4

This table, it will be perceived, is far from settling the _precise_
relative value of the different enumerated articles. An absolute,
unchanging value can never be assumed of any one substance, as the
quality of each must differ with the particular variety, the soil upon
which it is grown, the character of the season, the manner of curing,
and other circumstances. An approximate relative value is all that can
be expected, and this we may hope ere long to obtain, from the spirit of
analytical research, which is now developed and in successful progress.
More especially do we need these investigations with _American
products_, some of which are but partially cultivated in Europe, whence
we derive most of our analyses. And many which are there reared, differ
widely from those produced here, as these also differ from each other.
What, for instance, is the character of _meadow hay_? We know that this
varies as four to one, according to the particular kinds grown; and our
Indian corn has certainly a less range than from five to nine.


The Changes in the Food of Animals.

Potatoes, when first ripe, are estimated to be worth, for feeding
purposes, nearly twice as much as when old; and the relative value of
the different kinds, varies greatly at the same age and under similar
conditions of growth. Perrault ascertained by careful experiment, that
hay, clover, and lucerne lost much of their nutritive qualities by
drying, and in lucerne this loss amounted to about thirty-five per cent.
This is an important consideration in the feeding of green and dry
forage. Oats are among the best feed, both for young and working
animals; but it has been found that they are greatly improved for the
latter, and perhaps for both, by allowing the new crop to remain till
the latter part of winter, before feeding.

The improvement by steaming and cooking food, is seldom sufficiently
appreciated. Food properly managed, can never be made worse by cooking
for any stock; although it has not been considered so essential for
working, and generally, for ruminating animals, as for swine, and such
as were stall-feeding. But the alteration produced in cooking, by
fitting it for a more ready assimilation, must, as a general rule, add
much to the value of the food, and the rapid improvement of the animal.

The effect of slight fermentation, or souring the food, produces the
same result. Animals accustomed to this acid food, will reject what is
unprepared when they can get at the former; and we have no doubt, from
our own experience, that there is a saving in thus preparing it, from 20
to 40 per cent. A mixture of food should be supplied to all animals.
Like man, they tire of any constant aliment. For such, especially, as
are fattening, and which it is desirable to mature with the greatest
rapidity, a careful indulgence of their appetite should be studied. They
should be provided with whatever they most crave, if it be adapted to
the secretion of fat. Cutting, crushing, and grinding the food; cooking,
souring, and mixing it, are each by themselves an improvement for
feeding; and frequently two or more of these preparations combined, are
of great utility in effecting the object proposed.


The Profit of Feeding.

It is evident, that this consists in a valuable return from the animal
of the food consumed. In the horse, this can only be received in labor
or breeding; in the ox, from labor and flesh; in the cow, from the milk,
the flesh, and her young. In the sheep, it may be returned in its
fleece, its carcass, or its progeny; and in the swine only by its
progeny and flesh. The manure we expect from all; and if this be not
secured and judiciously used, few animals about the farm will be found
to yield a satisfactory profit for their food and attention; though it
is evident, it should form but a small part of the return looked for.

Animals are only profitable to the farmer, when they yield a daily
income, as in their milk or labor; or annually, by their young or
fleece; unless it be in a course of regular improvement, either in their
ordinary growth or preparation for the butcher. The animal must consume
a certain amount of food merely to keep up its stationary condition, and
to supply the materials for waste, respiration, perspiration, and the
evacuations. These must first be provided for in all cases, before the
farmer can expect any thing for the food.

Frequent observation has shown, that an ox will consume about two per
cent, of his weight of hay per day, to maintain his condition. If put to
moderate labor, an increase of this quantity to three per cent., will
enable him to perform his work, and still maintain his flesh. If to be
fattened, he requires about 41/2 per cent. of his weight daily, in
nutritious food. A cow to remain stationary and give no milk, eats two
per cent. of her weight daily; and if in milk, she will consume three
per cent. If these statements are correct, which it is certain they are
in principle, though they may not be entirely in degree, it will require
the same food to keep three yoke of cattle in idleness, as two at work;
and the food of every two that are idle, will nearly support one under
the most rapid condition of fatting. Two cows may be kept in milk, with
the same feed that will keep three without.

No practice is more impolitic, than barely to sustain the stock through
the winter, or a part of the year, as is the case in too many instances,
and allow them to improve only when turned on grass in summer. Besides
subjecting them to the risk of disease, consequent upon their privation
of food, nearly half the year is lost in their use, or in maturing them
for profitable disposal; when if one-third of the stock had been sold,
the remainder would have been kept in a rapidly improving condition, and
at three years of age, they would probably be of equal value, as
otherwise at five or six. It is true that breed has much to do with this
rapid advancement, but breed is useless without food to develop and
mature it.




CHAPTER II.

NEAT OR HORNED CATTLE.


The value of our neat cattle exceeds that of any other of the domestic
animals in the United States. They are as widely disseminated, and more
generally useful. Like sheep and all our domestic brutes, they have been
so long and so entirely subject to the control of man, that their
original type is unknown. They have been allowed entire freedom from all
human direction or restraint for hundreds of years, on the boundless
pampas of South America, California, and elsewhere; but when permitted
to resume that natural condition, by which both plants and animals
approximate to the character of their original head, they have scarcely
deviated in any respect, from the domestic herds from which they are
descended. From this it may be inferred, that our present races do not
differ, in any of their essential features and characteristics, from the
original stock.


Various Domestic Breeds.

Cultivation, feed, and climate, have much to do in determining the form,
size, and character of cattle. In Lithuania, cattle attain an immense
size, with but moderate pretensions to general excellence, while the
Irish Kerry and Scotch Grampian cows but little exceed the largest
sheep; yet the last are compact and well-made, and yield a good return
for the food consumed. Every country, and almost every district, has its
peculiar breeds, which by long association have become adapted to the
food and circumstances of its position, and when found profitable, they
should be exchanged for others, only after the most thorough trial of
superior fitness for the particular location, in those proposed to be
introduced.

More attention has been paid to the improvement of the various breeds of
cattle in England, than in any other country; and it is there they have
attained the greatest perfection in form and character for the various
purposes to which they are devoted. We have derived, directly from Great
Britain, not only the parent stock from which nearly all our cattle are
descended, but also most of those fresh importations, to which we have
looked for improvement on the present race of animals.

A few choice Dutch cattle, generally black and white, and of large size,
good forms, and good milkers, with a decided tendency to fatten, have
been occasionally introduced among us, but not in numbers sufficient to
keep up a distinct breed; and in the hands of their importers, or
immediate successors, their peculiar characteristics have soon become
merged in those herds by which they were surrounded. Some few French and
Spanish cattle, the descendants of those remote importations, made when
the colonies of those kingdoms held possession of our northern, western,
and southern frontiers, still exist in those sections; and although
possessing no claims to particular superiority, at least in any that
have come within our notice, yet they are so well acclimated, and
adapted to their various localities, as to render it inexpedient to
attempt supplanting them, except with such as are particularly
meritorious.


Native Cattle.

This is a favorite term with Americans, and comprehends every thing in
the country, excepting such as are of a pure and distinct breed. It
embraces some of the best, some of the worst, and some of almost every
variety, shape, color, and character of the bovine race. The designation
has no farther meaning, than that they are indigenous to the soil, and
do not belong to any well-defined or distinct variety.

The best native cattle of the Union are undoubtedly to be found in the
Northeastern states. Most of the early emigrant cattle in that section
were from the southern part of England, where the Devon cattle abound;
and though not at the present time bearing a close resemblance to that
breed, unless it has been impressed upon them by more recent
importations, yet a large number have that general approximation in
character, features, and color, which entitles them to claim a near
kindred with one of the choicest cultivated breeds. They have the same
symmetry, but not in general the excessive delicacy of form, which
characterizes the Devons; the same intelligence, activity, and vigor in
the working cattle, and the same tendency to fattening; but they are
usually better for the dairy than their imported ancestors. Some
valuable intermixtures have occasionally been made among them. Among
these, there have been many brindled cattle widely disseminated, of
great merit as workers, and not often surpassed for the dairy and
shambles.

The Herefords have in a few instances been introduced among the eastern
cattle, and apparently with great improvement. The importation made by
Admiral Coffin, of four choice Hereford bulls and cows, which were
presented to the State Agricultural Society of Massachusetts, nearly
thirty years since, is especially to be mentioned, as resulting in
decided benefit wherever they were disseminated. Some of the old
Yorkshire, or as they are sometimes styled, the long-horned Durhams,
have been introduced, though these have been isolated individuals and
never perpetuated as a separate breed. A few small importations have
been made of the Short Horns and Ayrshires, but neither of these have
been bred in the New England states in distinct herds, to any extent.

Their _native breed_ has hitherto, and generally with good reason,
possessed claims on the attention of their owners, which, with some
slight exceptions, it has not been in the power of any rivals to
supplant. With entire adaptedness to the soil, climate, and wants of the
farmer, an originally good stock has, in frequent instances, been
carefully fostered, and the breeding animals selected with a strict
reference to their fitness for perpetuating the most desirable
qualities. As a consequence of this intelligent and persevering policy,
widely, but not universally pursued, they have a race of cattle, though
possessing considerable diversity of size and color, yet coinciding in a
remarkable degree in the possession of those utilitarian features, which
so justly commend them to our admiration.

In proceeding southwestwardly through New York, New Jersey, and
elsewhere, we shall find in this branch of stock, a greater diversity
and less uniform excellence; though they have extensive numbers of
valuable animals. Here and there will be found a choice collection of
some favorite foreign breed, which emigrants have brought from their
native home, as did the Pagan colonists their penates or household gods;
the cherished associates of early days, and the only relics of their
father-land. Such are an occasional small herd of polled or hornless
cattle, originally derived from Suffolk or Galloway, excellent both for
the dairy and shambles; the Kyloe, or West Highland, (Scottish,) a hardy
animal, unrivalled for beef; the Welsh runt; the Irish cattle; the
crumpled-horn Alderney, and some others.


The Devon

Is among the oldest distinctly cultivated breeds in this country, as it
undoubtedly is of England, and probably it is the most universal
favorite. This popularity is well deserved, and it is based upon several
substantial considerations. They are beautifully formed, possessing
excessive fineness and symmetry of frame, yet with sufficient bone and
muscle to render them perfectly hardy; and they are among the most
vigorous and active of working cattle. They have great uniformity of
appearance in every feature, size, shape, horns, and color. The cows and
bulls appear small, but the ox is much larger; and both he and the dam,
on cutting up, are found to weigh much beyond the estimates which an eye
accustomed only to ordinary breeds, would have assigned to them. The
flesh is finely marbled or interspersed with alternate fat and lean, and
is of superior quality and flavor.

The cows invariably yield milk of great richness, and when appropriately
bred, none surpass them for the quantity of butter and cheese it yields.
Mr. Bloomfield, the manager of the late Lord Leicester's estate at
Holkham, has, by careful attention, somewhat increased the size, without
impairing the beauty of their form, and so successful has he been in
developing their milking properties, that his average product of butter
from each cow, is 4 lbs. per week for the whole year. He has challenged
England to milk an equal number of cows of any breed, against 40 pure
Devons, to be selected out of his own herd, without as yet having found
a competitor. Although this is not a test of their merits, and by no
means decides their superiority, yet it shows the great confidence
reposed in them by their owner. The Devon ox, under six years old, has
come up to a nett dead weight of 1,593 lbs.; and at three years and
seven months, to 1,316 lbs., with 160 lbs. of rough tallow.

_Description._ The Devon is of medium size, and so symmetrical, as to
appear small. The color is invariably a deep mahogany red, with usually
a white udder and strip under the belly; and the tuft at the end of the
tail is red while they are calves, but white in the older animal. The
head is small, broad in the forehead, and somewhat indented. The muzzle
is delicate, and both the nose and the rings around the eye, in the pure
breed, are invariably of a bright, clear orange. The cheeks and face are
thin and fleshless; the horns clear, smooth, and of a yellowish white,
handsomely curved upward. The neck is small and delicate at its junction
with the head, but is well expanded in its attachment to the breast and
shoulders. The last has the true slant for activity and strength, in
which it excels all other breeds of equal weight. The barrel is round
and deep, with a projecting brisket. The back is broad and level; the
flank full; hips wide; the rumps long; the quarters well developed, and
capable of holding a great quantity of the most valuable meat. The tail
is on a level with the back, and gracefully tapers like a drum-stick, to
the tuft on the end. The legs are of peculiar delicacy and fineness, yet
possess great strength. The skin is of medium thickness, of a rich
orange hue, pliable to the touch, and covered with a thick coating of
fine, soft, curly hair. The Devon is intelligent, gentle, and tractable;
is good for milk, and unsurpassed for the yoke and for fattening. No
animal is better suited to our scanty or luxuriant hill pastures than
the Devon, and none make a better return for the attention and food
received. They ensure a rapid improvement when mixed with other cattle,
imparting their color and characteristics in an eminent degree. Several
importations have been made into this country within the last 30 years,
of the choicest animals, and though not yet numerous in the United
States, we possess some of the best specimens that exist.


The Short Horns, or Durhams.

Are decidedly the most showy among the cattle species. They are of all
colors between a full, deep red, and a pure creamy white; but generally
have both intermixed in larger or smaller patches, or intimately blended
in a beautiful roan. Black, brown, or brindled, are colors not
recognised among pure-bred Short Horns. Their form is well-spread,
symmetrical, and imposing, and capable of sustaining a large weight of
valuable carcass. The horn was originally branching and turned upward,
but now frequently has a downward tendency, with the tips pointing
towards each other. They are light, and comparatively short; clear,
highly polished, and waxy. The head is finely formed, with a longer
face but not so fine a muzzle as the Devon. The neck is delicately
formed without dewlap, the brisket projecting; and the great depth and
width of the chest giving short, well-spread fore-legs. The crops are
good; back and loin broad and flat; ribs projecting; deep flank and
twist; tail well set up, strong at the roots and tapering. They have a
thick covering of soft hair, and are mellow to the touch, technically
termed, _handling well_. They mature early and rapidly for the quantity
of food consumed, yielding largely of good beef with little offal. As a
breed, they are excellent milkers; though some families of the Short
Horns surpass others in this quality. They are inferior to the Devons,
in their value as working oxen, and in the richness of their milk.

[Illustration: A Short-Horn Bull.]

The Short Horns are assigned a high antiquity, by the oldest breeders in
the counties of Durham and Yorkshire, England, the place of their
origin, and for a long time, of their almost exclusive breeding. From
the marked and decided improvement which they stamp upon other animals,
they are evidently an ancient breed, though much the juniors of the
Devon and Hereford. Their highly artificial style, form, and character,
are unquestionably the work of deeply studied and long-continued art;
and to the same degree that they have been moulded in unresisting
compliance with the dictation of their intelligent breeders, have they
departed from that light and more agile form of the Devon, which
conclusively and beyond the possibility of contradiction, marks the more
primitive race.


THE IMPORTATION OF SHORT HORNS INTO THIS COUNTRY.

This is claimed to have been previous to 1783. They are the reputed
ancestors of many choice animals existing in Virginia, in the latter
part of the last century, and which were known as the _milk breed_; and
some of these, with others termed the _beef breed_, were taken into
Kentucky by Mr. Patton, as early as 1797, and their descendants, a
valuable race of animals, were much disseminated in the West, and known
as the _Patton stock_.

The first authentic importations we have recorded, are those of Mr.
Heaton, into Westchester, N. Y., in 1791 and '96, from the valuable
herds of Messrs. Culley and Colling, which consisted of several choice
bulls and cows. These were for many years bred pure, and their progeny
was widely scattered. (_American Herd Book._) They were also imparted
into New York, by Mr. Cox, in 1816; by Mr. Bullock, in 1822; by the late
Hon. S. Van Rensselaer in 1823; and immediately after, by Mr. Charles
Henry Hall, of Harlem. Some small importations were made into
Massachusetts between 1817 and '25, by several enterprising
agriculturists, Messrs. Coolidge, Williams, and others; into Connecticut
by Mr. Hall and others; into Pennsylvania by Mr. Powell; and into Ohio
and some other states, by various individuals early in the present
century.

[Illustration: Fig. 2.

Short-Horned Cow.]

Since the first importations, larger accessions from the best English
herds have been frequently made; and with the nice regard for pedigrees
which the introduction of the herd book, and careful purity in breeding
has produced, the Short Horns have become the most extensive pure-bred
family of cattle in the United States.

During the speculative times of 1835 to 1840, they brought high prices,
frequently from $500 to $1000, and sometimes more. The following years
of financial embarrassment, reduced their market price below their
intrinsic value; but the tide is again turning, and they are now in
demand, but still at prices far below their utility and merits. They
have from the first, been favorites in the rich, corn valleys of the
West, their early maturity and great weight giving them a preference
over any other breed. The only drawback to this partiality, is their
inability, from their form and weight, to reach remote eastern markets
in good condition; an objection now in a great measure remedied, by the
recent remission of duties on foreign beef in the English market, which
makes them of nearly equal value where fed, to pack for exportation. On
light lands and scanty pastures, they will probably never be largely
introduced. All heavy animals require full forage within a limited
compass, so as to fill their stomachs at once, and quietly compose
themselves to their digestion.

The weights reached by the Short Horns in England, as given by Mr.
Berry, have been enormous. Two oxen, six years old, weighed nett, 1820
lbs. each. A heifer of three years, and fed on grass and hay alone,
weighed 1260 lbs. A four-year-old steer, fed on hay and turnips only,
dressed 1890 lbs. A cow reached the prodigious weight of 1778 lbs. A
heifer, running with her dam, and on pasture alone, weighed at seven
months, 476 lbs. An ox, seven years old, weighed 2362 lbs. From their
comparatively small numbers in this country, most of them have been
retained for breeders; few, as yet, have been fattened, and such only as
were decidedly inferior. Such animals as have been extensively produced
by crossing this breed upon our former stocks, have given evidence of
great and decided improvement; and the Short Horns, and their grade
descendants are destined, at no distant day, to occupy a large portion
of the richest feeding grounds in the United States.

[Illustration: Fig. 3.

Hereford Cow]


Herefords.

This is the only remaining pure breed, which has hitherto occupied the
attention of graziers in this country. Like the Devons, they are
supposed to be one of the most ancient races of British cattle. Marshall
gives the following description. "The countenance pleasant, cheerful,
open; the forehead broad; eye full and lively; horns bright, taper, and
spreading; head small; chap lean; neck long and tapering; chest deep;
bosom broad, and projecting forward; shoulder-bone thin, flat, no way
protuberant in bone (?) but full and mellow in flesh; chest full; loin
broad; hips standing wide, and level with the chine; quarters long, and
wide at the neck; rump even with the level of the back, and not
drooping, nor standing high and sharp above the quarters; tail slender
and neatly haired; barrel round and roomy; the carcass throughout deep
and well spread; ribs broad, standing flat and close on the outer
surface, forming a smooth, even barrel, the hindmost large and full of
length; round-bone small, snug, and not prominent; thigh clean, and
regularly tapering; legs upright and short; bone below the knee and hock
small; feet of middle size; flank large: flesh everywhere mellow,
soft, and yielding pleasantly to the touch, especially on the chine, the
shoulder, and the ribs; hide mellow, supple, of a middle thickness, and
loose on the neck and huckle; coat neatly haired, bright and silky;
color, a middle red, with a bald face characteristic of the true
Herefordshire breed."

[Illustration: Fig. 4.

Hereford Bull.]

Youatt further describes them as follows: "They are usually of a darker
red; some of them are brown, and even yellow, and a few are brindled;
but they are principally distinguished by their white faces, throats,
and bellies. In a few the white extends to the shoulders. The old
Herefords were brown or red-brown, with not a spot of white about them.
It is only within the last fifty or sixty years that it has been the
fashion to breed for white faces. Whatever may be thought of the change
of color, the present breed is certainly far superior to the old one.
The hide is considerably thicker than that of the Devon, and the beasts
are more hardy. Compared with the Devons, they are shorter in the leg,
and also in the carcass; higher, and broader, and heavier in the chine;
rounder and wider across the hips, and better covered with fat; the
thigh fuller and more muscular, and the shoulders larger and coarser.

They are not now much used for husbandry, although their form adapts
them for the heavier work; and they have all the honesty and docility of
the Devon ox, and greater strength, if not his activity. The
Herefordshire ox fattens speedily at a very early age, and it is
therefore more advantageous to the farmer, and perhaps to the country,
that he should go to market at three years old, than be kept longer as a
beast of draught.

They are not as good milkers as the Devons. This is so generally
acknowledged, that while there are many dairies of Devon cows in various
parts of the country, a dairy of Herefords is rarely to be found. To
compensate for this, they are even more kindly feeders than the Devons.
Their beef may be objected to by some as being occasionally a little too
large in the bone, and the fore-quarters being coarse and heavy; but the
meat of the best pieces is often very fine-grained and beautifully
marbled. There are few cattle more prized in the market than the genuine
Herefords."

There have been several importations of the Herefords into the United
States, which by crossing with our native cattle, have done great good;
but with the exception of a few fine animals at the South, we are not
aware of their being kept in a state of purity, till the importation of
the splendid herd. within the last six years, by Messrs. Corning and
Sotham of Albany, N. Y. These Herefords are among the very best which
England can produce, and come up fully to the description of the
choicest of the breed. Mr. Sotham, after an experience of several years,
is satisfied with the cows for the dairy; and he has given very
favorable published statements of the results of their milking
qualities, from which it may be properly inferred, that Youatt drew his
estimates from some herds which were quite indifferent in this property.
They are peculiarly the grazier's animal, as they improve rapidly and
mature early on medium feed. They are excelled for the yoke, if at all,
only by the Devons, which, in some features, they strongly resemble.
Both are probably divergent branches of the same original stock.


The Ayrshire

Is a breed that has been much sought after of late years, from their
reputation for fine dairy qualities. The milk is good both in quantity
and quality, yielding, according to a recent statement of Mr. Tennant,
of Scotland, who owns a large herd, fifteen quarts per day during the
best of the season, twelve of which made a pound of butter. The product
of the latter averages about 170 pounds per annum to each cow. Another
authority says, on the best low-land pasture, a good cow yields nearly
4000 quarts per year. This is a large quantity, and implies good cows
and extra feed.

Mr. Cushing, of Massachusetts, who imported several select animals,
without regard to their cost, informed us, after three or four years'
trial, that he did not perceive any superiority in them, over the good
native cows of that state, for dairy purposes. A large number have been
imported in detached parcels, and scattered through the country. They
are good animals, but seem to combine no valuable properties in a higher
degree than are to be found in our own good cattle, and especially such
as are produced from a cross of the Short Horn bull of a good milking
family, on our native cows. They are evidently a recent breed, and do
not therefore possess that uniformity of appearance and quality, which
attaches to one of long cultivation.

Mr. Aiton, of Scotland, gives the following account of them. "The dairy
breed of Scotland have been formed chiefly by skilful management, within
the last 50 years; and they are still improving and extending to other
countries. Till after 1770, the cows in Cunningham were small, ill-fed,
ill-shaped, and gave but little milk. Some cows of a larger breed and of
a brown and white color, were about that time brought to Ayrshire from
Teeswater, and from Holland, by some of the patriotic noblemen of
Ayrshire; and these being put on good pasture, yielded more milk than
the native breed, and their calves were much sought after by the
farmers."

We may fairly infer from the foregoing, which is deemed indisputable
authority; from the locality of their origin, in the neighborhood of the
Short Horns; and from their general resemblance, both externally and in
their general characteristics to the grade animals, that they owe their
principal excellence to this long-established breed.


MANAGEMENT OF CALVES.

The safest and least troublesome manner of raising calves, is at the
udder of the dam; and whenever the milk is converted into butter and
cheese, we believe this to be the most economical. The milk of one good
cow is sufficient, with a run of fresh, sweet pasture, to the feeding of
two calves at the same time; and if we allow the calves to arrive at
three or four months of age before weaning, we may safely estimate, that
one good cow will yield a quantity of milk in one season, fully
equivalent to bringing up four calves to a weaning age.

By keeping the calf on the fresh milk, whether he take it directly from
the udder, or warm from the pail, all risk of disordered bowels is
avoided. The milk is precisely adapted to the perfect health and thrift
of the young, and whenever we substitute for it any other food, we must
watch carefully that not the slightest mismanagement produces disorder,
lest more is lost by disease or want of improvement, than is gained by
the milk of which they are robbed.

The first milk of the cow after calving, is slightly purgative, which is
essential to cleanse the stomach of the calf. It is, moreover, perfectly
worthless for two or three days, for any other purpose except for swine.
The calf will seldom take all the milk at first, and whatever is left in
the bag should be thoroughly removed by the hand. If the calf is
destined for the butcher, he must have all the milk he wants for at
least six weeks, and eight or ten is better; and if the cow does not
furnish enough, he ought to be fed gruel or linseed tea. He must be
closely confined in a snug, but clean and airy stable, and the darker
this is, and the more quiet he is kept, the more readily he will fatten.

If designed to be reared, the safest and least troublesome method, is to
keep the calf on new milk. If saving the milk be an object, it is still
doubtful whether it is not better that he should have a part of it fresh
from the cow, and depend for his remaining food on a good grass or
clover pasture, meal, or roots.

Some farmers never allow the calf to approach the dam, but take it when
first dropped, and put a handful of salt in its mouth, which is daily
repeated till he is put to grass. This has a purgative effect, similar
to the first milk. Flaxseed is then prepared, by boiling a pint in four
to six quarts of water, and diluted with hay tea till it is rather
thicker than milk, and fed at blood heat.

_Hay tea_ is made, by boiling a pound of sweet, well-cured clover, in
one and a half gallons of clean water.

As the calf becomes older, oat, barley, rye, or Indian meal may be
scalded and added to the flaxseed.

When the skim-milk is of little consequence, a better way is to withdraw
him from the cow after three or four days, then scald the milk, adding a
little oat meal, and cool to the natural temperature of the milk, and
feed it. Oats, either crushed or ground, is the best and safest grain
for all young stock. The milk should not stand more than half a day
before feeding to young calves. As they advance in age, it may be fed
rather older, but should never be allowed to become sour; nor should it
ever be fed cold. Connected with this feed, should be a good range of
short, sweet pasture, and shelter against both sun and storms. If
expedient, at about 10 weeks old, he may be safely weaned, but four
months' nursing is better for the calf.

If allowed too much milk for several months, it is injurious to the
future development of the young. It does not distend the stomach
properly, nor call into use its ruminating habits. Calves thus brought
up, have often proved light-bellied, indifferent feeders, and decidedly
inferior animals. When the calf is removed from the cow, they should be
effectually separated from sight and hearing, as recognition creates
uneasiness, and is an impediment to thrift in both.

If there be any deficiency of suitable pasture for the calf, a small
rack and trough should be placed under the shed in his range, and fine
hay put in the former, and wheat bran or oat meal with a little salt in
the latter.


Diseases and Remedies.

For _disordered bowels_, mix 2 dr. rhubarb, 2 oz. castor oil, and 1/2 dr.
ginger, with a little warm milk or gruel; or give 2 oz. castor oil
alone; or 3 oz. of Epsom salts.

For _scours_ and _diarrh[oe]a_, a homely remedy is, to administer half a
pint of cider, with an equal quantity of blood drawn from the calf's
neck.

Or, add a little rennet to its food.

A good remedy is, 1 oz. powdered canella bark; 1 oz. laudanum; 4 oz.
prepared chalk; and one pint water. Mix together, and give a wine-glass
full or more, according to the size of the calf, three times a day.

_Costiveness_ is removed by giving pork broth.

Or, give 3 to 4 oz. Epsom salts, dissolved in 3 pints of water, injected
into the stomach; and repeat part of this dose every 3 or 4 hours, till
the desired effect is produced.

Calves, like all young stock, should be allowed to change their feed
gradually, from new milk to skimmed, or from the latter to other food.
Their stomachs are delicate, and need gentle, moderate changes, when
necessary to make them at all. Much depends on the care and attention
they receive. It is well to have a little resin within its reach.

A comfortable shelter, with a dry, warm bed, suitable food, regularly
given three times a day, at blood heat, and keeping the stomach in
proper order, will do much to bring them forward rapidly, and with a
small expenditure of food.

The calf requires to be supplied through the winter with an abundance of
fine, sweet hay and roots, the latter either chopped or mashed by a
roller, with the addition of a trifle of meal or oats, and a full supply
of salt and pure water.

When there are larger animals on the premises, the calves ought to be
kept by themselves. They should be sustained on their winter feed
through the following spring, until the grass furnishes a good bite on a
well-compacted sod. The change from hay to grass must be gradual, unless
the latter is considerably matured. The extreme relaxation of the bowels
from the sudden change, frequently produces excessive purging. A slight
and temporary relax from the early spring grass, is not objectionable.


Breeding.

The young animals should never be put to breeding under 15 months old,
so as to bring their first calf at two years old nor then, unless they
have large size and good feed. Much depends on the progress towards
maturity, and the supply of food in selecting the proper time for
breeding. Some are as ready for this at a year and a half as others are
at three. Early breeding gives delicacy and symmetry to the form of the
heifer, but it checks its growth; and when it is found to put her back
too much, she may be allowed to rest for a few months, or even a year,
to brings her up to the desired standard. These remarks apply
principally to choice breeders, or as they are sometimes termed, _fancy
stock_. For ordinary milch cows which have been moderately fed, three
years is a proper age to come in, after which they must be milked as
regularly, and as late before drying as possible.


Breaking Steers

Should be commenced when two or three years old. Some begin with the
calf, accustoming him to a light yoke and occasional training. This
practice will do as a pastime for trustworthy boys, as it makes them
gentle and manageable afterwards, but is hardly worth a man's time. If
always carefully handled when young, they will be found tractable.

They should at first be placed behind a pair of well-broke cattle, nor
should they be put to hard labor until quite grown, strong, and
perfectly accustomed to the yoke. If properly managed, cattle may be
trained with all the docility, intelligence, and much of the activity of
the horse. That they are not, is more frequently the fault of their
masters.


Management of Oxen.

To procure perfect working cattle, it is necessary to begin with the
proper breed. Many parts of the country furnish such as are well suited
to this purpose. A strong dash of Devon or Hereford blood is desirable,
when it needs to be improved. A well-formed, compact, muscular body;
clean, sinewy limbs; strong, dense bones; large, well-formed joints,
with a mild expressive eye, are essential for good working oxen.

After breaking, they must be led along gently, and taught before they
are required to perform their task; and never put to a load which they
cannot readily move, nor dulled by prolonging exertion beyond that
period when it becomes irksome. A generous diet is necessary, to keep up
the spirit and ability of cattle, when there is hard work to be done.
The horse and mule are fed with their daily rations of grain when at
hard service, and if the spirit of the ox is to be maintained, he
should be equally well fed, when as fully employed. Great and permanent
injury is the result of niggardly feeding and severe toil, exacted from
the uncomplaining animal. His strength declines, his spirit flags, and
if this treatment be continued, he rapidly becomes the stupid, moping
brute, which is shown off in degrading contrast with the more spirited
horse, that performs, it may be, one half the labor, on twice his
rations.

The ox should be as little abused by threats and whipping, as by stinted
feed and overtasked labor. Loud and repeated hallooing, or the severe
use of the lash, is as impolitic as it is cruel and disgraceful. We
never witness this barbarity without wishing the brutes could change
places, long enough at least to teach the biped that humanity by his own
sufferings which his reason and sensibility have failed to inspire.
Clear and intelligible, yet low and gentle words are all that are
necessary to guide the well-trained, spirited ox. The stick, or whip, is
needed rather to indicate the precise movement desired, than as a
stimulant or means of punishment. The ox understands a moderate tone
more perfectly than a boisterous one, for all sounds become indistinct
as they increase.

It is of great advantage to have oxen well trained to _backing_. They
may soon be taught, by beginning with an empty cart on a descent; then
on a level; then with an increasing load, or uphill, till the cattle
will back nearly the same load they will draw.

Some oxen have a bad trick of _hauling_ or _crowding_. Changing to
opposite sides, longer or shorter yokes, and more than all, gentle
treatment, are the only remedies, and those not unfrequently fail.
Cattle will seldom contract this habit, in the hands of a judicious,
careful driver. _The yokes_ should be carefully made, and set easy, and
the bows fitted to the necks and properly attached to the yoke. Cattle
are liable to sore necks if used in a storm; and when subject to this
exposure, they must be well rubbed with grease, where the yoke chafes
them, and respite from work should be allowed till the necks heal.


Management of Bulls or Vicious Animals.

If inclined to be vicious, the bulls should have rings thrust through
the cartilage of their nose when young. They are to be found at the
agricultural warehouses; and are made of round iron, three-eighths of an
inch diameter, with a joint in one side to open, and when thrust through
the nose, are fastened in a moment, by a rivet previously prepared.

[Illustration: Fig. 5.

Cattle-Handler.]

Fig. 5 is a _cattle-handler_, consisting of a bar of iron A, eight
inches long, with a ring for a man's hand, which turns on a swivel at B,
and at the other end is a pair of calliper-shaped legs, one stationary,
and the other opening on a joint. The fixed leg is inserted against one
side of the nostril, and the other is pressed upon the opposite side,
and there fastened by a slide, C, when the animal is firmly held for
administering medicine or performing any operation.

[Illustration: Fig. 6. Fig. 7.

For taming savage Animals.]

Figs. 6 and 7, for _taming a bull_; b, in Fig. 6, is a cap screwed on to
the tip of the horn; a c, an iron rod hanging on a pivot in the cap,
with a chain reaching to the ring in the nose. The effect of his
attempting to hook, is illustrated by the various positions of the chain
in Fig. 7. If the rod at a, is pushed in either direction, it jerks up
the nose in a manner that cures him of his inclination.

[Illustration: Fig. 8.

Cattle-Tie.]

Fig. 8, shows a _cattle-tie_.--This is a much more convenient and
comfortable mode of fastening cattle in the stable, than the common
stanchions.


The proper time for turning off Cattle.

This must depend on their previous feeding and management, the breed,
and the purposes required. The improved breeds and many of their
crosses, will mature for the butcher as fully at three or four, as
inferior cattle at five to seven years old. If pushed rapidly with
proper food, they will of course be _ripe_ much sooner than if stinted.
When cattle have to be purchased for work, or cows for the dairy, it
becomes an object to keep them as long as they can be made profitable,
and yet be turned off for fattening at a fair price. We have seen active
and spirited oxen in the yoke at 16 or 17; but they seldom do as well
after 12 or even 10 years. Old cattle are liable to more diseases than
young; are less hardy; and they recover more slowly when exposed to
scanty feed or hard usage. They also fatten with more difficulty, and
their meat is inferior. When they can be sold advantageously to the
feeder, and replaced without inconvenience, it is found to be most
profitable to turn them off at seven or eight years. They will by that
time have attained full maturity; they will feed rapidly, and make the
largest amount of good beef. If there are extraordinary milkers among
the cows, or superior workers among the oxen, it is better to keep them
as long as they maintain their full vigor.


Fattening Cattle.

Such as are designed for the shambles the ensuing fall or winter, may be
allowed to do their spring's labor; or if cows, they may be milked into
summer after calving, or go farrow during the previous year. They should
early be put on the best summer feed, and it is better to be
occasionally changed, to give variety and freshness, and keep the animal
in good appetite. Let the fattening animals have the best, and after
they have cropped it a while, give them a fresh field; and the other
animals or sheep can follow and clear off the remaining herbage,
preparatory to shutting it up for a new growth. Some prefer an extensive
range of rich feed, which is unchanged throughout the season; and when
it is not necessary to divide the pasture with the other animals, this
is a good practice.

[Illustration: Fig. 9.]

[Illustration: Fig. 10.]

[Illustration: Fig. 11.]

Three cuts of improved forms, Nos. 9, 10, and 11. The above cuts
illustrate the forms which the most improved beef-cattle should possess.


The selection of Animals for Stall Fattening.

This is a nice point, and none without a practised eye and touch, can
choose such as will make the best return for the food consumed. The
characteristics of choice animals, heretofore enumerated, are
particularly essential in those intended for profitable fattening. But
the most important of all, is that firm mellowness, and quick elasticity
of touch, which unerringly mark the kindly feeder and profitable
bullock. When other means for ascertaining fail, it is a safe rule to
select the best-conditioned animals, out of a herd of grass-fed; for if
all were of equal flesh and health, when turned out, those which have
thriven most on their summer pasture, will generally fatten quickest on
their fall and winter keep. Only the best should be selected. The
remainder, after consuming the coarser forage, may be at once disposed
of for early use. From repeated trials, it is found that the carcass of
stall-fed animals will barely return the value of the materials
consumed, and their manure is generally the only compensation for the
time and attention bestowed. None but choice, thrifty beasts will pay
for their food and attention, and all others will make their best
returns, by an immediate disposal, after the surplus fodder is gone.

[Illustration: Fig. 12.

Points of Cattle Illustrated.

EXPLANATION.--A, forehead; B, face; C, cheek; D, muzzle; E, neck; F,
neck vein; G, shoulder point; H, arm; I, shank; J, gambril, or hock; K,
elbow; L, brisket, bosom, or breast; M, shoulder; N, crops; O, loin; P,
hip, hucks, hocks, or huckles; Q, crupper bone, or sacrum; R, rump, or
pin-bone; S, round bone, thurl, or whirl; T, buttock; U, thigh, or
gaskit; V, flank; W, plates; X, back, or chine; Y, throat; Z, chest.]


Stall-Feeding.

This ought to be commenced early in the season. An ox may be fed in a
box-stall, or if accustomed to a mate, they do better by tying together
with sufficient room, yet not so near as to allow of injuring each
other. The building should be warm, but not hot; well ventilated, yet
having no current of cold air passing through; and as dark as possible.
The stall ought to be kept clean and dry, and a deep bed of clean straw
is of decided advantage.

The ox should be first fed the inferior and most perishable roots with
his grain and dry forage, and his food should be gradually increased in
richness, as he advances towards maturity. The food and water should be
given three times a day, from thoroughly cleaned mangers or troughs. The
animal likes a change of food, in which he should be indulged as often
as may be necessary. If he refuses his food, a temporary privation, or
variety is essential. When the food is changed, he should be moderately
fed at first, till he becomes accustomed to it, as there is otherwise
danger of cloying, which is always injurious. The moment the animal has
done feeding, the remainder of the food ought to be at once removed. He
then lies down, and if undisturbed, rests quietly till the proper hour
induces him again to look for his accustomed rations. Regularity in the
time of feeding, is of the utmost consequence. An animal soon becomes
habituated to a certain hour, and if it be delayed beyond this, he is
restless and impatient, which are serious obstacles to speedy fattening.

[Illustration: Fig. 13.

Ox cut up.

Fig. 13--Shows the London method of cutting up the carcass--Fig. 1, is
the loin; 2, rump; 3, aitch or adz-bone; 4, buttock; 5, hock; 6, thick
flank; 7, thin flank; 8, fore-rib; 9, middle rib; 10, cuck-rib; 11,
brisket; 12, leg of mutton piece; 13, clod or neck; 14, brisket.]

[Illustration: Fig. 14.

Skeleton of an Ox.

1. Temporal bone.--2. Frontal bone, or bone of the forehead.--3. Orbit
of the eye.--4. Lachrymal bone.--5. Malar, or cheek bone.--6. Upper jaw
bone.--7. Nasal bone, or bone of the nose.--8. Nippers, found on the
lower jaw alone.--9. Eight true ribs.--10. Humerus, or lower bone of the
shoulder.--11. Sternum.--12. Ulna, its upper part forming the
elbow.--13. Ulna.--14. Radius, or principal bone of the arm.--15. Small
bones of the knee.--16. Large metacarpal, or shank bone.--17.
Bifurcation at the pasterns, and the two larger pasterns to each
foot.--18. Sesamoid bones.--19. Bifurcation of the pasterns.--20. Lower
jaw and the grinders.--21. Vertebrae, or bones of the neck.--22.
Navicular bones.--23. Two coffin bones to each foot.--24. Two smaller
pasterns to each foot.--25. Smaller or splint-bone.--26. False ribs,
with their cartilages.--27. Patella, or bone of the knee.--28. Small
bones of the hock.--29. Metatarsals, or larger bones of the hind
leg.--30. Pasterns and feet.--31. Small bones of the hock.--32. Point of
the hock.--33. Tibia, or proper leg-bone.--34. Thigh-bone.--35. Bones of
the tail.--36, 37. Haunch and pelvis.--38. Sacrum.--39. Bones of the
loins.--40. Bones of the back--41. Ligament of the neck and its
attachments.--42. Scapula, or shoulder-blade.--43. Bones of the
back.--44. Ligament of the neck.--45. Dentata.--46. Atlas.--47.
Occipital bone, deeply depressed below the crest or ridge of the
head--48. Parietal bone, low in the temporal fossa.--49. Horns, being
processes or continuations of the frontal bone.]




DISEASES IN CATTLE.

Hoven, or Swelling of the Paunch,


Is a temporary ailment, caused by eating too freely of fresh and
generally wet clover, or other succulent food. The animal gorges the
first stomach with so much food, that its contents cannot be expelled.
Inflammation of the membrane takes place, and decomposition of the food
soon follows. This is known by the distension of the paunch, and
difficulty of breathing, and unless speedily relieved, suffocation and
death will ensue. Both sheep and cattle are subject to it.

_Remedies._[1]--In its early stages, when not too severe, it has been
removed by administering some one of the following remedies.

A pint of gin poured down the throat.

From one to two pints of lamp or other oil.

Strong brine.

New milk with one-fifth its bulk of tar mixed.

An egg-shell full of tar forced down the throat, followed by a second,
if the first fails.

A tablespoonful of volatile spirit of ammonia, diluted with water.

A wine-glass full of powder, mixed with cold lard and forced in balls
into the stomach.

A teaspoonful of unslaked lime dissolved in a pint of warm water, shaken
and given immediately.

A pint of tolerably strong lye.

[1] Besides his own experience, the writer has drawn from the N. E.
Farmer, the Albany Cultivator, the American Agriculturist, and other
reliable American and English works, some of the remedies for diseases
herein mentioned.


The Proper Mode of giving the above Remedies

Is for a person to hold the horn and cartilage of the nose, while
another seizes and draws out the tongue as far as possible, when the
medicine is thrust below the root of the tongue. If liquid, it must be
inserted by the use of a bottle.

_The probang_ is used when the former remedies are ineffectual. This
consists of a tarred rope, or a flexible whip-stalk, three-fourths of an
inch in diameter, with a swab or bulbous end. Two persons hold the head
of the animal, so as to keep the mouth in a line with the throat, while
a third forces it into the stomach, when the gas finds a passage out. A
stiff leather tube with a lead nozzle pierced with holes, is best for
insertion, through which the gas will readily escape.

Some one of the above purgatives should be given after the bloat has
subsided, and careful feeding for some days must be observed.

Light gruels are best for allaying inflammation, and restoring the tone
of the stomach.

When no other means are available, the paunch may be tapped with a sharp
penknife, plunging it 11/2 inches forward of the hip bone, towards the
last rib in the left side. If the hole fills up, put in a large
goose-quill tube, which to prevent slipping into the wound, may remain
attached to the feather, and the air can escape through a large hole in
the upper end.

_Prevention_ is vastly better than cure, and may be always secured, by
not allowing hungry cattle to fill themselves with clover, roots,
apples, &c. When first put upon such feed, it should be when the dew and
rain are off, and their stomachs are already partially filled; and they
should then be withdrawn before they have gorged themselves.

[Illustration: Fig. 15.]

[Illustration: Fig. 16.

The Stomach Pump.]

This is a convenient instrument for extracting poisonous substances from
the stomach. It is also highly useful for administering medicines and
injections, and if fitted with several tubes, one may suffice for
animals of any size. It consists of a syringe, _a_, with a side opening
at _b_, and another at the bottom _d_, as shown in Fig. 16. For
injections, Fig. 15 is used, and the end of the syringe is placed in a
vessel containing the fluid, when a probang or injection-tube is screwed
on to the side opening at _b_, through which the fluid is forced into
the stomach or rectum, as may be required. The probang should be a tube
of thick but elastic leather, and it may be passed into the mouth,
through an aperture in a block, placed on edge between the teeth, which
is easily done while a person holds the head of the animal firmly.


Choking

Is frequently relieved by some of the following expedients.

The use of the probang or whip-stock, mentioned under the head of
_remedies for Hoven_, by which the root is forced into the stomach.

A soft root may be crushed so as to allow of swallowing, by holding a
smooth block against it, and striking with a mallet on the opposite
side.

If within arms-length, the root may be removed by hand.

It is said this can be done, by tying up the fore-leg with a small cord,
close to the body, and giving the animal a sudden start with a whip; or
by jerking the fore-leg out forward.

Or pour down the throat a pint bottle full of soft soap, mixed with
sufficient hot water to make it run freely.

_Prevention_ consists in cutting the roots; not feeding them when the
animals are very hungry, and not disturbing them while eating.


Inflammation of the Stomach.

This is frequently produced by a sudden change from dry to green food,
and some other causes.

Epsom salts, castor oil, sulphur, and carbonate of soda, in sufficient
quantity to purge freely, are good remedies.

It may be prevented by changing the food gradually.


Mange, or Scab.

This is denoted by the animal rubbing the hair off about the eyes and
other parts. The skin is scaly or scabby, sometimes appearing like a
large seed-wart.

_Remedies._--Rub the spots with sulphur and lard, after scraping and
washing with soap.

When the skin is cracked, take sulphur, 1 lb.; turpentine, 1/4 lb.;
unguentum, (or mercurial ointment,) 2 ounces; linseed oil, 1 pint. Melt
the turpentine and warm the oil, and when partly cooled, stir in the
sulphur; when cold, add the unguentum, mixing all well. Rub this
thoroughly with the hand on the parts affected.

We have no doubt this, like scab in sheep and itch in the human species,
will be found, on close investigation, to be caused by minute insects
located in the skin. Salt and water ought, in that case, to be a good
remedy.


Hollow Horn, or Horn Ail.

This is not unfrequently _hollow stomach_, and very often follows
stinted fare, hard usage, and exposure to cold. We have noticed this as
most prevalent among oxen that have done a severe winter's work.

_Symptoms._--Bloody urine; swollen udder; shaking the head; eyes and
head swollen; standing with the head against a fence or barn; eyes dull
and sunken, and horns cold.

_Remedies._--Bleed and physic, shelter and feed properly.

Take a half pint of good vinegar, two tablespoonfuls of salt, one
teaspoonful of pepper, and mix and pour into each ear, holding the head
on one side for two minutes.

Bore with a large gimlet on the under side of the horn, three or four
inches from the head; and if hollow, bore nearer the head and let out
all the matter, and syringe two or three times a day with salt and
water, or soap-suds, or salt and vinegar.

Spirits of turpentine rubbed in around the base of the horns, will
arrest the disease in its incipient stages.

Pour a spoonful of boiling hot brimstone into the cavity between the
horns.

Pour a teakettle of boiling water on the horns, holding so as to prevent
injury to the other parts.

Soot and pepper given internally are good.


Jaundice, or Yellows.

This is owing to gall-stones or calculi, which occasionally accumulate
in large numbers, and is sometimes owing to increased or altered quality
of the bile. It is manifested by the yellowness of the eye and skin, and
high color of the urine, and poor appetite.

_Remedies._--Bleed, and purge with Epsom salts.

If taken in season, 2 ounces of ground mustard may be mixed with a
liquid, and given twice a day.

Green food is a good preventive.


Mad Itch.

This disease exists in some of the Western states, and shows itself by
jerking of the head, and itching around the nose and base of the horns.
They will lick their sides and backs, and jerk and hiccup till they fill
themselves with wind; afterwards they froth at the mouth, and in 24
hours die raving mad.

_Remedy._--Give as much soot and salt as the animal will eat; soon
after, give 3/4 or 1 lb. of brimstone or sulphur; and 8 hours after, as
many salts.


Bloody Murrain, or Red Water.

This disease first shows itself in a cough, then heaving of the flanks,
with bloody, black, and f[oe]tid evacuations, tenderness over the loins,
and coldness of the horns. Tumors and biles sometimes appear. The animal
holds down the head, moans, is restless, and staggers when walking.

_Causes._--We have lost several animals by this fatal disease, and are
not aware of having cured any when severely attacked. In repeated
instances, we have seen large flukes taken out of the liver, strongly
resembling the common leech, which abounds in many of our swampy lands.
It is certain that on new, low swamps and clay lands, cattle are most
liable to it; and when they have been subject to repeated attacks in
such localities, clearing and draining have checked it.

Youatt attributes it to certain kinds of forage, which are peculiar to
the above situations. We are rather inclined to ascribe it to exposure,
to excessive dampness, and especially to miasma; for although the brute
creation are perhaps less sensitive to these influences than man, yet,
as they are governed by the same unvarying laws of nature, when
subjected to conditions totally unsuited to their economy, they must
suffer equally in kind, though probably not in degree, with the more
refined human frame. But it is evident the disease, its causes, and
remedies, are as yet imperfectly understood.

_Remedies._--However intelligent men may differ as to its causes, all
agree that the animal should first be bled, and then thoroughly purged.
In obstinate cases, this last is a difficult matter. We have given
repeated doses of powerful cathartics without producing any effect; and
whenever the medicine is inoperative, death speedily follows.

Large doses of common salt, or Epsom salts dissolved in water, are good
purgatives, and if the animal neglects drinking after taking them, he
should be drenched with copious draughts of water. These should be
repeated every few hours, if ineffectual.

Injections are sometimes useful, when medicine fails to act. These may
be made of soap and water; or take 2 or 3 gills of oats boiled, 3
drachms saltpetre, 11/2 oz. linseed oil, mix and use them when warm.

The opening of the bowels may be followed with a pint of linseed oil, as
an additional and gentle laxative.

When the animal begins to recover, gentle astringents and tonics may be
given.

_Preventives._--We have more confidence in preventives than in remedies.
Good keep, shelter, dryness, and clean pastures, will generally prevent
attack. The cattle should at all times be supplied with two or three
troughs under cover, on the sides and bottoms of which tar should be
plentifully spread. Let equal portions of salt and slaked lime be in
one; salt and wood ashes in another; and salt and brimstone in a third.
Many farmers have entirely avoided this disease while using one or more
of these, when they annually lost many by it previously.


Hoof Ail

Is indicated by lameness, fever, and a soft swelling just above the
hoof.

_Remedies._--Carefully wash the foot in warm soap-suds, and while still
damp, apply between the claws on the affected part from one to three
grains of corrosive sublimate. If it does not fully adhere, it must be
mixed with hog's lard, but it should be so applied as to be out of the
reach of the animal's tongue, as it is a powerful poison, and the
extreme irritability of the feet will induce him to lick them.

The claw is efficiently cleansed, by drawing a cord briskly through it,
when either of the above applications, or blue vitriol put on two or
three times a day, or spirits of turpentine, will effect a cure.

It is sometimes cured by putting the animals in the stanchions, and
applying a sharp chisel three-fourths of an inch from the toe, and
striking it with a mallet till it is cut off. If it does not bleed
freely, cut off shavings till it does. If the animal is refractory, let
a person hold up the opposite foot. Keep them in the stable two or three
days, and out of the mud for a week.


Loss of Cud

Is loss of appetite, prostration, and general ill-health.

_Remedies._--Give a warm bran mash, with good hay, and warm water with
salt.

An aloe tincture, made with brandy and ginger, is good.

Afterwards give good, dry, nourishing food; and bitter infusions,
chamomile flowers, hoarhound, oak bark, &c., in beer.


Scours, or Diarrh[oe]a.

A common remedy, is to boil the bark of white oak, white pine, and
beech, and give a strong infusion in bran. If they refuse to eat it,
pour it down. The oak is astringent, and the pine and beech soothing and
healing.


Warbles

Are grubs, the egg of which is deposited in the back of cattle by the
gad-fly, (_[OE]strus bovis._) They are discernible by a protuberance or
swelling on the back. They may be pressed out by the thumb and finger;
or burnt out by plunging a hot wire in them; or a few applications of
strong brine will remove them.


Wounds

In cattle are readily healed, when the animal's blood is in good order,
by applying a salve made of 1 oz. green copperas; 2 oz. white vitriol; 2
oz. salt; 2 oz. linseed oil; 8 oz. molasses. Boil over a slow fire 15
minutes in a pint of urine, and when almost cold, add 1 oz. oil of
vitriol, and 4 oz. spirits turpentine. Apply it with a feather to the
wound, and cure soon follows.


Milk, or Puerperal Fever,

Is a common disease with cows in high condition, at the time of calving.
It may, in almost every case, be avoided, by keeping them in moderate
feed and flesh.

_Remedies._--Bleed freely, say 6 to 10 quarts, according to the
circulation of the blood; then give 1 to 11/2 lbs. of Epsom salts,
according to the size of the beast, to be repeated in half lb. doses
every six hours, till she purges freely.

Injections should always be given when purgatives are tardy in their
operation.


Caked Bag

May be removed by simmering the bark of the root of bitter-sweet in
lard, till it becomes very yellow. When cool, apply it to the swollen
udder once in 8 or 10 hours; or wash it several times a day in cold
water.

A pint of horseradish, fed once a day, cut up with potatoes or meal, is
useful for the same purpose.

This is also a tonic, helps the appetite, and is good for oxen subject
to heat.


Garget

Is a more intense degree of inflammation than exists in caked bag and
sore, swollen teats, and shows itself in hard bunches on the udder.

The cow should be bled, and take a large dose of physic; then wash the
udder as in caked bag.

Repeated doses of sulphur is a good remedy.

Garget, or scoke root, given of the size of a large finger, grated and
fed in their food, is a general application with farmers. The garget
plant grows from three to six feet high, with a purple stalk, and
strings of berries hanging down between the branches.


Sore Teats

May be healed by rubbing with goose oil, cream, new milk; or make the
same applications for it as for caked bag. The bag and teats should be
well cleansed with warm soft water, if to be followed by any ointment.

The following application is recommended by Youatt: One ounce of yellow
wax and three of lard; melt together, and when cooling, rub in one
quarter ounce of sugar of lead, and a drachm of alum finely powdered.


Warts

Are of two kinds; the first, on the outer skin, may be removed by
rubbing with camphorated olive oil. The others penetrate into the flesh,
and may be removed by a ligature of fine twine, or silk, or india-rubber
drawn into a string, and tied tightly around the wart, which falls off
in a few days.

_Remedies._--Nitrate of silver, (lunar caustic,) applied to the wart,
will remove it, but it produces a sore.

Apply a strong wash of alum.

Rub with the juice of milk-weed.

Poultice with grated carrot.

Cut off the wart with sharp scissors, when the cow is dry. It will bleed
little, and soon heal.


Sore Necks on Working Oxen.

These occur when worked in wet weather, or with bad yokes. The _remedy_
is, rub with a healing application. The _preventive_ is, good yokes; the
application of grease; or a decoction of white or yellow oak bark
applied to the affected parts. Or, a better preventive is a canvass or
leather cap to protect the neck entirely from the storm.


The Bite of Poisonous Snakes

May be cured by shaking together equal parts of olive oil and hartshorn,
and rubbing the wound and adjacent parts three or four times a day. For
a full-grown animal, one quart of olive oil and an ounce of hartshorn
should be administered internally, in addition to the above.


For Stings of Bees, Hornets, &c.

Apply warm vinegar and salt, rubbing the parts thoroughly.


For a Forming Tumor.

Rub thoroughly with strong brine, or a solution of sal ammoniac
dissolved in eight times its weight of water. If the tumor comes to a
head, open it near the bottom with a lancet; or place a seton in it so
as to admit the escape of purulent matter.


Lice and Vermin

Sometimes abound on cattle during the latter part of winter and spring.
These are generally the result of _mange_, which is itself the effect of
ill-feeding and ill-condition. They are removed with the cause. We doubt
if they can be permanently kept off, where the animal is losing flesh
and health.

_Remedies._--Restore the health and condition, and sprinkle sand, ashes,
or dirt plentifully around the roots of the horns, and along the ridge
of the neck and back.

A liberal application of train or other oil has nearly a similar effect.

Never apply an ointment containing corrosive sublimate or other poison,
as it may be licked by the animal or its fellows, who may thus become
seriously poisoned.


The Trembles,

Producing _milk sickness_ (a most fatal disease) in the human family,
from eating the milk or flesh of animals affected by it. This disease,
which exists principally in the region of the Wabash River, is supposed
by Dr. Drake to be owing to the _poison oak_, (Rhus Toxicodendron,) or
_poison vine_, (Radicans,) which the animals eat.

_Symptoms._--The animal mopes, is feverish and costive, but apparently
preserves its appetite. The next stage of the disease is faintness and
vertigo, which is shown when the animal is put upon exertion, being
followed by excessive _trembling_ and entire prostration.

_Remedy._--Almost every cathartic has been tried in vain. Indian corn,
both dry and green, has been fed to all animals accustomed to eating it,
and when they can be induced to feed upon it freely, purging is
generally secured. Rest of the animal is absolutely essential while the
disease continues, and is itself an effectual remedy in mild cases.

       *       *       *       *       *

Besides the diseases enumerated, there are occasional epidemics, such as
_black tongue_, _black foot_, or _foot root_, _&c._, which carry off
great numbers of animals. Remedies for these are frequently not
discovered, and the epidemic is allowed to run its course unchecked. The
only preventives are such care, food, and management as the experienced
herdsman knows to be best suited to the maintenance of the health and
thrift of his stock.

_Note._--Some ailments will be found under the head of _diseases_ of the
other animals mentioned in this work, the general resemblance of which
to each other will justify nearly a similar treatment.

If intelligent _farriers_ are at hand, they may sometimes be called in
with advantage; though we acknowledge our distrust of the quackery of
most of those passing under this title. There is little science or
intelligent study in the composition of this class, the world over; and
much of their practice is the merest empiricism. The owner should see to
it, if he employs one of whose attainments he is doubtful, that neither
medicines nor operations be used, unnecessarily severe or hazardous to
the animal. Especially, should the diabolical practice be interdicted,
of the abundant and indiscriminate use of poisons, boiling oils,
turpentine, and tar, and the hot iron applied to the sensitive wound or
naked flesh. If certain or effectual remedies for the removal of disease
cannot he applied, such as augment the suffering or endanger the life of
the poor dumb things, may at least be avoided.




CHAPTER III.

THE DAIRY.


Cows for the Dairy.

From what has been said on the various characteristics of the different
breeds of cattle, it must be evident, that no very definite criteria of
excellence can be given for all good dairy cows. But there are certain
points in a good milker, that can hardly be mistaken.

She should be descended from the best milking stock; her head should be
small or of medium size, muzzle fine, and nostrils flexible and
expanded; face long, slender, and dishing; cheeks thin; eyes full, mild,
and prominent; horns delicate and waxy, and they may be either
branching, lopped, crumpled, or hornless; long, thin, lively ear, and
the inside of an orange color; neck thin and small at its junction with
the head; deep chest, but not too heavy before; back level and broad;
well ribbed; belly large; low flank; wide thighs, but thin; short legs,
and standing well apart; large milking veins; loose, capacious udder,
coming well out behind; good teats; loose, mellow skin, of a deep
yellow; and a fine, thick coat of glossy hair; and she must be of a good
disposition, and free from tricks.

Yet, with all the skill of a well-practised taste in the selection of
animals, the dairyman will frequently find his theories and results at
sad variance. One may sometimes select a fine animal, with every
appearance of good milking qualities, which is but a medium cow at the
pail; and another, that hardly seems worthy of notice, and which sets at
defiance many established milking points, and all preconceived notions
of symmetry, may yet prove a good milker. A cow that runs to flesh while
in milk, is generally an indifferent animal for the dairy. Perfection
in a cow, consists in converting all she eats into milk while yielding
it, and when dry, in turning all she consumes into valuable meat.


Management of Dairy Cows.

A cow may have her first calf when between two and three years of age,
according to her size and development. After calving, she should be
stinted in her food for two or three days, and not fed freely for a
week. Avoid fat in a breeding cow. Too high feeding is the cause of
milk-fever, caked bag, garget, and a host of evils; and very poor feed
is almost equally objectionable.

The average time of a cow with young, is from 40 to 41 weeks; but they
sometimes go only 34, and occasionally overrun 44.

A dry, unoccupied stall or yard is best for her to calve in; and if
there is any serious delay or difficulty in the operation, she may be
assisted by placing the f[oe]tus in the right position, and gently
pulling it, with every throe of the dam. After the calf has drawn all he
wants at morning and evening, the bag should be thoroughly and quickly
emptied of all the milk. If strong and vigorous, the calf is the best
doctor for garget or caked bag. He may be allowed to suck the cow or
not, at the option of the owner; there are reasons for and against the
practice, as will be seen under the head of rearing calves, and each
person must determine in his own case on which side the balance lies.


Milking.

This is an important operation, and on its proper performance depends
much of the success of the dairyman. A cow regularly, gently, yet
quickly and thoroughly milked, will give much more than if neglected. If
a herd of cows be separated into two divisions, each yielding the same
quantity of milk, and one is given to a good milker, and the other to a
shiftless or lazy one, the latter will speedily reduce his milk much
below the quantity obtained by the former; and if the milkers then
exchange cows, they will be found to change quantity too, those before
affording the least, soon giving the most. An indifferent milker ought
never to be tolerated in a herd, good ones are cheaper at double the
price. It is best to milk at intervals of about 12 hours; which may be
done when pastures are convenient, or cows are soiled or fed in the
yard. But as this is not often the case in the season of green food,
they should be milked early in the morning and turned into pasture, to
fill themselves before the sun is oppressive; and if they are to be kept
up at night, let them browse in the pasture as long as possible, before
they are brought to the yard.


MILK

Is produced from the females of all the warm-blooded animals, which are
enumerated among the mammaliae. The milk of several animals is employed
for domestic purposes, among different nations. That of the camel is
used by the Arabs; the milk of the ass by the Spaniards, the Maltese,
and the inhabitants of the Levant; that of the mare by the Cossacks, the
Kirgheez, and other Tartars; and that of the goat, the ewe, and the cow,
by most of the ancient, and with few exceptions, by every modern
European nation. Within the last century, however, the use of all
excepting cow's milk has been almost entirely discarded, among the most
highly civilized people.

If we except some few Welsh and Swiss, or other emigrants, who resort to
the goat and ewe for their dairy materials, for the first few years of
their residence here, the cow is the only animal which is employed in
America for producing milk. For this, she is pre-eminently fitted, and
the modern improvement of this invaluable animal has carried her product
of milk almost as far as can be reasonably looked for from a given
amount of food; and although this is of about the average richness of
the goat and ewe, and before that of the ass, the quantity she yields is
frequently as 60 to 1, in favor of the cow, over the first two
competitors. As a milk-giving animal, the cow is the best fitted for the
purposes of civilized man; and she is made to contribute, not only to
his health, his comfort, and his economy, but to many of his choicest
luxuries. Milk contains every element of nutrition necessary to animal
existence; and man can subsist, with unimpaired health and strength, if
limited to this food alone.


The Constituents of Milk

Are butter, which varies from 2 to 6 per cent.; casein or cheese,
usually 4 to 5, but sometimes varying from 3 to 15 per cent.; (the last
excessive quantity, yielded only by the first milk after calving;)
milk-sugar, 4 to 6; salts or saline matter, 0.2 to 0.6; and water, 80 to
89.

_There is much diversity in the product and quality of milk_ from cows
of the same breed, the same food, and other circumstances and
conditions, apparently equal. Thus, of a herd of 22, chiefly Ayrshire,
one gave 84 quarts in one week, which afforded 31/2 lbs. of butter; two
others in the same time gave 86, yielding 51/2 lbs.; and a fourth gave 88
quarts, making 7 lbs.

The amount of butter, however, which a given quantity of milk will
produce, is not the only criterion of the value of the milk, except for
this purpose alone. Some cows will yield more butter, others will
produce more cheese; while for consumption, another may partially
compensate, in the increased quantity of milk-sugar, and the saline
matters, for a deficiency of both the other ingredients. But for dairy
purposes, butter and cheese are the only measure of the value of milk;
and a cow is esteemed good or indifferent, as she gives one or the other
in the greatest abundance.


Circumstances which modify the Quantity and Character of Milk.

Besides the accidental variation in the quantity and quality of milk in
different animals, before adverted to, there are many reliable causes
which influence both. Of these, parentage has a most decided and uniform
influence, frequently modified, however, in the particular individual,
by some personal and controlling causes. But a cow, whose maternal
ancestry on both sides are choice milkers, is almost certain to resemble
them.

Food influences the quantity, rather than the quality. Boussingault
tried numerous experiments, with cows fed on various kinds of food, and
found the difference hardly appreciable in the quality of milk. Its true
benefit is to be looked for in the increased quantity, through which,
the valuable ingredients are distributed in nearly the same proportion,
as when the product is materially lessened. By quality we mean to be
understood, the amount of the ingredients, _valuable for nutrition
only_; for it is certain, that there is a rich aromatic flavor, not only
in milk, but in butter and cheese, which is afforded in various articles
of food, and especially by the fresh green herbage which abounds in the
pastures from spring to autumn.

Activity or rest has a great effect on both quantity and quality. The
less action, and the more quiet and rest, the greater the amount of milk
and butter. But exercise is absolutely essential to the production of
cheese. Butter may be made from cows confined in a stable, but cheese
can only be profitably made from animals at pasture. It is supposed by
physiologists, that the exercise in gathering their food, rather than
any peculiarity in its character, is necessary to convert the
nitrogenized tissues into the nitrogenized principle of caseum or
cheese.

The time from calving, has also its effect. The first milk drawn from a
cow after calving, has been found to yield over 15 per cent. of casein,
while in its ordinary state it gives only three to five and a half. As
the quantity of milk diminishes in a farrow cow, the quality improves
within certain limits. Pregnancy affects the quality injuriously, and
especially towards its latter stages; and a cow that is predisposed to
giving milk, should be dried off a few weeks before its expiration, as
it is then unfit for use.

Fat cows give poorer milk than such as are moderately lean; and young
animals do not come up to the maximum of their quality, till after their
third or fourth calving.

The milk first drawn from the udder, will yield only an eighth, and
sometimes even a much less proportion of cream, than the strippings; and
the milk which is drawn three times a day, is greatly inferior to such
as is taken but once, though the latter is less abundant.

Excitement, or fretfulness; change of locality, or to a different herd,
with new companions; separation from her calf; periodical heat;
annoyance from flies, or worry from dogs; exposure to storms, severe
cold, or an oppressive sun, and many similar causes, diminish the
quantity of milk and butter; but some of these may reasonably be
expected to increase the proportion of its casein.

Dr. Playfair found that the quantity of butter in the evening milk,
after the cow had been at pasture all day, was 3.7 per cent., while the
casein was 5.4; after lying quietly all night, the milk from the same
cow, on the following morning, contained 5.6 per cent. of butter, and
only 3.9 of casein. In stabling the cow, the butter was invariably in
greater proportion than when allowed to ramble in the pasture; and the
casein, with a single exception, was equally diminished.

[Illustration: Fig. 17.

Lactometer, or Cream Guage.]

Fig. 17, is a number of glass tubes of equal size, set in a frame called
a _lactometer_ or _cream guage_. If milk from different cows be set in
these, the depth of the cream will indicate their comparative richness.


Cream.

If milk be immediately set away in shallow vessels, after being taken
from the cow, the cream rises to the surface, carrying with it most of
the butter contained in the milk, and much of its casein also. Hence,
the great nutritive properties of buttermilk, which retains the casein
in very large proportions, much of it being rejected by the butter in
its separation from the cream.

A temperature below 34 deg., will prevent the cream from rising in any
considerable quantity, and preserve the milk unaltered for some weeks.
Coagulating the milk from any cause, will equally prevent the separation
of the cream. The elevation of temperature within certain limits,
hastens the separation. Thus, at 50 deg., the cream will mostly have risen
in 36 hours; at 55 deg., in 24; at 68 deg., in 18 or 20; and at 77 deg., in 10 or 12
hours.

Heating the milk near the boiling point, and then setting it away and
allowing it to remain undisturbed, will soon cause the cream to rise. In
the celebrated Orange dairy, near Baltimore, Md., this system was
practised, by which, not only most of the cream was secured for butter,
but in consequence of its rapid separation, the skimmed milk was sent to
market within a few hours after being drawn; and the scalding imparted
to it an agreeable flavor and apparent richness, which it did not really
possess.

The celebrated clouted cream of Devonshire, England, and the butter made
from it, contains an unusual quantity of casein, the consequence of
heating the milk. "It is prepared by straining the warm milk into large
shallow pans into which a little water has previously been put, allowing
these to stand from six to twelve hours, and then carefully heating them
over a slow fire, or on a hot plate, till the milk approaches the
boiling point. The milk, however, must not actually boil, nor must the
skin of the cream be broken. The dishes are now removed into the dairy,
and allowed to cool. In summer the cream should be churned on the
following day; in winter it may stand over two days. The quantity of
cream obtained is said to be one-fourth greater by this method, and the
milk which is left is proportionably poor."--[_Johnston._]


BUTTER.


Electricity

Has much to do with the changes in milk, as in all other substances.
Glass milk-pans might, therefore, be supposed to be the best vessels for
keeping the milk unchanged and sweet.

It may possibly not afford any practical result, yet intelligent
experiments for introducing a stream of electricity might well be
justified, to aid in the separation of the butteraceous particles in the
operation of churning.


Sour Cream.

Cream, for the purpose of churning, is usually allowed to become sour.
It ought to be at least one day old, but may with advantage be kept
several days in cool weather, if it be previously well freed from milk,
and be frequently stirred to keep it from curdling. This sour cream is
put into the churn, and worked in the usual way until the butter
separates. This is collected into lumps, well beat and squeezed free
from the milk, and in some dairies is washed with pure cold water as
long as the water is rendered milky. In other localities the butter is
not washed, but after being well beat, is carefully freed from the
remaining milk by repeated squeezings and dryings with a clean cloth.
Both methods, no doubt, have their advantages. In the same
circumstances, the washed butter may be more easily preserved in the
fresh state, while the unwashed butter will probably possess a higher
flavor.


Sweet Cream

May be put into the churn and the butter be obtained, but in most cases
it requires more labor and longer time, without, in the opinion of good
judges, affording in general a finer quality of butter. In all cases the
cream becomes sour during the agitation, and before the butter begins
distinctly to form.


Clouted Cream

The churning of the clouted cream of this and other countries, forms an
exception to the general rule just stated, that more time is required in
the churning of sweet creams. Clouted cream may be churned in the
morning after it is made, that is, within twenty-four hours of the time
when the milk was taken from the cow; and from such cream it is well
known that the butter separates with very great ease. But in this case,
the heating of the cream has already disposed the oily matter to cohere,
an incipient running together of the globules has probably taken place
before the cream is removed from the milk, and hence the comparative
ease with which the churning is effected. There is something peculiar in
butter prepared in this way, as it is known in other countries by the
name of Bohemian butter. It is said to be very agreeable in flavor, but
it must contain more cheesy matter than the butter from ordinary cream.


Churning the whole Milk

Is a much more laborious method, from the difficulty of keeping in
motion such large quantities of fluid. It has the advantage, however, of
giving a larger quantity of butter. At Rennes, in Brittany, the milk of
the previous evening is poured _into the churn_ along with the warm
morning's milk, and the mixture is allowed to stand for some hours, when
the whole is churned. In this way it is said that a larger quantity of
butter is obtained, and of a more delicate flavor.

In the neighborhood of Glasgow, according to Mr. Aiton, the milk is
allowed to stand six, twelve, or twenty-four hours in the dairy, till
the whole has cooled, and the cream has risen to the surface. Two or
three milkings, still sweet, are then poured together with their cream,
into a large vessel, and are left undisturbed till the whole has become
quite sour, and is completely coagulated. The proper sourness is
indicated by the formation of a stiff _brat_ upon the surface _which has
become uneven_. Great care must be taken to keep the brat and curd
unbroken until the milk is about to be churned, for if any of the whey
be separated, the air gains admission to it and to the curd, and
fermentation is induced. By this fermentation, the quality of the butter
may or may not be affected, but that of the buttermilk is almost sure to
be injured.

In Holland the practice is a little different. The cream is not allowed
to rise to the surface at all, but the milk is stirred two or three
times a day, till it gets sour, and so thick that a wooden spoon will
stand in it. It is then put into the churn, and the working, or the
separation of the butter is assisted by the addition of a quantity of
cold water. By churning the sour milk in one or other of these ways, the
butter is said to be "rich, sound, and well-flavored." If it be greater
in quantity, it is, according to Sprengel, because the fatty matter
carries with it from the milk a larger quantity of casein than it does
in most cases from the cream alone.


Sourness of the Cream.

For the production of the best butter, it is necessary that the cream
should be sufficiently sour before it is put into the churn. Butter made
from sweet cream (not clouted) is neither good in quality, nor large in
quantity, and longer time is required in churning. It is an unprofitable
method.

[Illustration: Fig. 18.]

Fig. 18 is a _Cylindrical Thermometer Churn_, of any required size, with
false metal bottom to hold cold or hot water for bringing the cream to
the proper temperature. A thermometer, permanently set in the side,
indicates the heat.


Quickness in Churning.

The more quickly milk or cream is churned, the paler, the softer, and
the less rich the butter. Cream, according to Mr. Aiton, may be safely
churned in an hour and a half, while milk ought to obtain from two to
three hours. The churning ought always to be regular, slower in warm
weather, that the butter may not be soft and white, and quicker in
winter, that the proper temperature may be kept up.

A barrel-churn, lately introduced into this country, being placed in a
trough of water of the proper temperature, readily imparts the degree of
heat required by the milk or cream without the necessity of adding warm
water to the milk, _and churns the whole in ten or twelve minutes_. It
is said also to give a larger weight of butter from the same quantity of
milk. If the quality be really as good by this quick churning, the
alleged inferiority in the quality of butter churned quickly in the
common churn cannot be due to the mere rapidity of churning alone.


Over-churning.

When the process of churning is continued after the full separation of
the butter, it loses its fine yellowish, waxy appearance, and becomes
soft and light-colored. The weight of the butter, however, is
considerably increased; and hence, in Lancashire, over-churning is
frequently practised in the manufacture of fresh butter for immediate
sale.


Temperature of the Milk or Cream.

Much also depends upon the temperature of the milk or cream when the
churning is commenced. Cream when put into the churn should never be
warmer than 55 deg. Fahrenheit It rises during the churning from 4 deg. to 10 deg.
F. above its original temperature. When the whole milk is churned, the
temperature should be raised to 65 deg. F., which is best done by pouring in
hot water into the churn _while the milk is kept in motion_. In winter,
either of these temperatures may be easily attained. In cold weather it
is often necessary to add hot water to the cream to raise it even to
55 deg.. But in summer, and especially in hot weather, it is difficult, even
in cool and well-ordered dairies, (without the use of ice,) to keep the
cream down to this comparatively low temperature. Hence, if the cream be
then churned, a second-rate butter, at best, is all that can be
obtained.


The alleged advantages of Churning the entire Milk.

The proper temperature can be readily obtained both in winter and
summer. A hundred gallons of entire milk, will give, in summer, five per
cent. more butter than the cream from the same quantity of milk. Butter
of the best quality can be obtained without difficulty, both in winter
and summer. No special attention to circumstances, or change of method,
is at any time required. The churning in winter and summer is alike
simple and easy. The butter is not only of the best quality while fresh,
but is also best for long-keeping, when properly cured or salted.


Cleanliness in all the operations of the Dairy.

This is peculiarly necessary to the manufacture of good butter. Cream is
remarkable for the rapidity with which it absorbs and becomes tainted by
any unpleasant odors. It is very necessary that the air of the dairy
should be sweet, that it should be often renewed, and that it should be
open in no direction from which bad odors can come. (_Johnston and other
authorities._)

The statement of J. T. Lansing, who received the first premium for
butter from the New York State Agricultural Society, is as follows:--

_Keep the cows stabled through the inclement season_; feed them from
three to four times per day with good hay or green stalks; when near
coming in, add some oats, barley, or corn cracked. In summer, good
pasture, with living water accessible at all times, and plenty of salt.

_Treatment of milk and cream before churning._--Strain the milk in tin
pans; place them in a cool cellar for the cream to rise. When
sufficiently risen, separate the cream from the milk; put in stone jars,
well prepared before churning.

_The mode of churning in summer._--Rinse the churn with cold water; then
turn in the cream, and add to each jar of cream put in the churn, full
one-fourth of the same quantity of cold water. The churn used is a
patent one, moved by hand with a crank, having paddles attached, and so
constructed as to warm the milk (if too cold) with hot water, without
mixing them together. The milk and cream receive the same treatment in
winter as in summer; and in churning, use hot instead of cold water, if
necessary.

_The method of freeing the butter from the milk_, is to wash the butter
with cold water, till it shows no color of the milk, by the use of a
ladle.

_Salting the butter._--Use the best kind of Liverpool sack-salt; the
quantity varies according to the state in which the butter is taken from
the churn; if soft, more; if hard, less; always taking the taste for
the surest guide. Add no saltpetre, nor other substances.

_The best time for churning_ is the morning, in hot weather, and to keep
the butter cool till put down.

_The best mode of preserving butter_, in and through the summer and
winter, is as follows:--The vessel is a stone jar, clean and sweet. The
mode of putting it down is to put in a churning of butter, and put on
strong brine; let it remain on until the next churning is ready to put
down, and so on till the jar is filled; then cover it with fine salt the
same to remain on till used.

Mr. McWilliams, of Orange county, the celebrity of whose butter is
unsurpassed, thus details his method of butter-making:

"Our practice is not to churn the milk until it becomes thick or
loppered, the milk and cream is then churned together. The temperature
of the milk is about fifty degrees. In warm weather about a quart of
cold water is put in each pan before the milk is strained, so as to keep
it sweet as long as possible. The cellar-floor is brick. This in warm
weather is daily cleansed with cold water. A drain from the cellar
carries off the water thus applied. The churn is filled about half full
with milk, with the addition of two pails of cold water before starting
the churn. In cold weather the same quantity of warm water is applied.
When the churning is finished, which usually occupies about two hours of
time, there are then two more pails of cold water applied to raise the
butter and cool it.

The butter is then taken out of the churn and put in a large tray; this
is immediately filled with cold water, and the butter carefully washed;
after which the water is thrown off. The butter now undergoes the
process of salting; it is then placed in a cool situation, where it
stands about an hour, and is worked carefully over. This finished, it is
placed in the same situation as before, where it stands three or four
hours, and is again worked over; again replaced for five or six hours,
when it is worked over for the third time. It is now replaced, where it
stands till the next morning, and worked over for the fourth time. A
small quantity of nitre is then put in the butter. Thus finished, it is
placed in firkins holding about eighty-five pounds.

Previous to packing, the firkin is scalded with hot water, rinsed and
cooled with cold water, then rubbed all around with fine salt; this
prevents the butter from adhering to the sides of the firkin. When the
firkin is full, a linen cloth is placed over the top of the butter; on
this cloth a covering of salt is put one inch deep, and cold water
enough added to it to form a brine. It then stands till it is to be sent
to market, when the cloth and salt are removed, the firkin turned down,
the top of the butter in the keg washed with cold water, and the pickle
drained off. The firkin is now neatly headed up and sent to market."

The salt added to the butter should be from 1-24th to 1-28th of its
weight, or about two-thirds of an ounce to a pound, and this must be of
the best quality. All the buttermilk must be thoroughly extracted by
repeated washings; and when completed, the butter should be immediately
packed, and not a particle of air allowed to come in contact with it
till opened for the table.


CHEESE.

The Circumstances affecting the Quality of Cheese.

"All cheese consists essentially of the curd, mixed with a certain
portion of the fatty matter, and of the sugar of milk. But differences
in the quality of the milk, in the proportion in which the several
constituents of milk are mixed together, or in the general mode of dairy
management, give rise to varieties of cheese almost without number.
Nearly every dairy district produces one or more qualities of cheese
peculiar to itself.


Natural Differences in the Milk

It is obvious that whatever gives rise to natural differences in the
quality of the milk, must affect also that of the cheese prepared from
it. If the milk be poor in butter, so must the cheese be. If the pasture
be such as to give a milk rich in cream, the cheese will partake of the
same quality. If the herbage or other food affect the taste of the milk
or cream, it will also modify the flavor of the cheese.


Milk of Different Animals.

So the milk of different animals will give cheese of unlike qualities.
The ewe-milk cheeses of Tuscany, Naples, and Languedoc, and those of
goats' milk made on Mont Dor and elsewhere, are celebrated for qualities
which are not possessed by cheeses prepared from cows' milk in a similar
way. Buffalo milk also gives a cheese of peculiar qualities, which is
manufactured in some parts of the Neapolitan territory."

Other kinds of cheese are made from mixtures of the milk of different
animals. Thus the strong-tasted cheese of Lecca and the celebrated
Roquefort cheese are prepared from mixtures of goat with ewe milk, and
the cheese of Mont Cenis from both of these mixed with the milk of the
cow.


Creamed or Uncreamed Milk.

Still further differences are produced, according to the proportion of
cream which is left in or is added to the milk. Thus, if cream only be
employed, we have the rich _cream-cheese_ which must be eaten in a
comparatively recent state. Or, if the cream of the previous night's
milking be added to the new milk of the morning, we may have such cheese
as the _Stilton_ of England, or the small, soft, and rich _Brie_
cheeses, so much esteemed in France.

If the entire milk only be used, we have such cheeses as the _Cheshire_,
the _Double Gloucester_, the _Cheddar_, the _Wiltshire_, and the
_Dunlop_ cheeses of Britain, the Kinnegad cheese of Ireland, and the
Gouda and Edam cheeses of Holland. Even here, however, it makes a
difference, whether the warm milk from the cow is curdled alone, as at
Gouda and Edam, or whether it is mixed with the milk of the evening
before, as is generally done in Cheshire and Ayrshire. Many persons are
of opinion that cream, which has once been separated, can never be so
well mixed again with the milk, that a portion of the fatty matter shall
not flow out with the whey and render the cheese less rich.

If the cream of the evening's milk be removed, and the skimmed milk
added to the new milk of the next morning, such cheeses as the _Single
Gloucester_ are obtained. If the cream be taken once from _all_ the
milk, the better kinds of skimmed-milk cheese, such as the Dutch cheese
of Leyden, are prepared; while if the milk be twice skimmed, we have the
poorer cheeses of Friesland and Groningen. If skimmed for three or four
days in succession, we get the hard and horny cheeses of Essex and
Sussex, which often require the axe to break them up.


Buttermilk Cheese.

But poor or butterless cheese will also differ in quality according to
the state of the milk from which it is extracted. If the new milk be
allowed to stand to throw up its cream, and this be then removed in the
usual way, the ordinary skimmed-milk cheese will be obtained by adding
rennet to the milk. But if, instead of skimming, we allow the milk to
stand till it begins to sour, and then remove the butter by churning the
whole, we obtain the milk in a sour state, (_buttermilk_.) From this
milk the curd separates naturally by gentle heating. But being thus
prepared from sour milk, and without the use of rennet, buttermilk
cheese differs more or less in quality from that which is made from
sweet skimmed-milk. The acid in the buttermilk, especially after it has
stood a day or two, is capable of coagulating new milk also; and thus,
by mixing more or less sweet milk with the buttermilk before it is
warmed, several other qualities of mixed butter and sweet-milk cheese
may readily be manufactured.


Whey Cheese.

The whey which separates from the curd, and especially the white whey,
which is pressed out towards the last, contains a portion of curd, and
not unfrequently a considerable quantity of butter also. When the whey
is heated, the curd and butter rise to the surface, and are readily
skimmed off. This curd alone will often yield a cheese of excellent
quality, and so rich in butter, that a very good imitation of Stilton
cheese may sometimes be made with alternate layers of new-milk curd and
this curd of whey.


Mixtures of Vegetable Substances with the Milk.

New varieties of cheese are formed by mixing vegetable substances with
the curd. A green decoction of two parts of sage leaves, one of
marigold, and a little parsley, gives its color to the _green cheese_ of
Wiltshire; some even mix up the entire leaves with the curd. The
celebrated Schabzieger cheese of Switzerland, is made by crushing the
skim-milk cheese after it is several months old to fine powder in a
mill, mixing it then with one-tenth of its weight of fine salt, and
one-twentieth of the powdered leaves of the mellilot trefoil,
(_trifolium melilotus cerulea_,) and afterwards with oil or butter,
working the whole into a paste, which is pressed and carefully dried.


Potato Cheeses,

As they are called, are made in various ways. One pound of sour milk is
mixed with five pounds of boiled potatoes and a little salt, and the
whole is beat into a pulp, which, after standing five or six days, is
worked up again, and then dried in the usual way. Others mix three parts
of dried boiled potatoes with two of fresh curd, or equal weights, or
more curd than potato, according to the quality required. Such cheeses
are made in Thuringia, in Saxony, and in other parts of Germany. In
Savoy, an excellent cheese is made by mixing one of the pulp of potatoes
with three of ewe-milk curd; and in Westphalia, a potato cheese is made
with skimmed milk.


Preparation of Rennet.

Rennet is prepared from the salted stomach or intestines of the sucking
calf, the unweaned lamb, the young kid, or even the young pig. In
general, however, the stomach of the calf is preferred, and there are
various ways of curing and preserving it.

The stomach of the newly killed animal contains a quantity of curd
derived from the milk on which it has been fed. In most districts, it is
usual to remove by a gentle washing the curd and slimy matters which are
present in the stomach, as they are supposed to impart a strong taste to
the cheese. In Cheshire, the curd is frequently salted separately for
immediate use. In Ayrshire and Limburg, on the other hand, the curd is
always left in the stomach and salted along with it. Some even give the
calf a copious draught of milk shortly before it is killed, in order
that the stomach may contain a larger quantity of the valuable curd.


Salting the Stomach.

In the mode of salting the stomach, similar differences prevail. Some
merely put a few handfuls of salt into and around it, then roll it
together, and hang it near the chimney to dry. Others salt it in a
pickle for a few days, and then hang it up to dry; while others pack
several of them in layers, with much salt both within and without, and
preserve them in a cool place, till the cheese-making season of the
following year. They are then taken out, drained from the brine, spread
upon a table, sprinkled with salt which is rolled in with a wooden
roller, and then hung up to dry. In some foreign countries, the recent
stomach is minced very fine, mixed with salt and bread into a paste, put
into a bladder, and then dried. In Lombardy, the stomach, after being
salted and dried, is minced and mixed up with salt, pepper, and a little
whey or water into a paste, which is preserved for use.

In whatever way the stomach or intestine of the calf is prepared and
preserved, the almost universal opinion seems to be, that it should be
kept for 10 or 12 months, before it is capable of yielding the best and
strongest rennet. If newer than 12 months, the rennet is thought to make
the cheese heave or swell, and become full of eyes or holes.


Making the Rennet.

In making the rennet, different customs also prevail. In some districts,
a bit of the dried stomach is put into half a pint of lukewarm water,
with as much salt as will lie upon a shilling, is allowed to stand over
night, and in the morning the infusion is poured into the milk. For a
cheese of 60 lbs. weight, a piece of the size of a dollar will often be
sufficient, though of some skins as much as 10 square inches are
required to produce the same effect. It is, however, more common to take
the entire stomach, and to pour upon them from one to three quarts of
water for each stomach, and to allow them to infuse for several days. If
only one has been infused, and the rennet is intended for immediate use,
the infusion requires only to be skimmed and strained. But if several be
infused, or as many as have been provided for the whole season, about
two quarts of water are taken for each, and, after standing not more
than two days, the infusion is poured off, and is completely saturated
with salt. During the summer it is constantly skimmed, and fresh salt
added from time to time. Or a strong brine may at once be poured upon
the skins, and the infusion, when the skins are taken out, may be kept
for a length of time. Some even recommend, that the liquid rennet should
not be used until it is at least two months old. When thus kept,
however, it is indispensable that the water should be fully saturated
with salt.

In Ayrshire, and in some other countries, it is customary to cut the
dried stomach into small pieces, and to put it, with a handful or two of
salt and one or two quarts of water, into a jar, to allow it to stand
for two or three days, afterwards to pour upon it another pint for a
couple of days, to mix the two decoctions, and when strained, to bottle
the whole for future use. In this state it may be kept for many months.

In making rennet, some use pure water only, others prefer clear whey,
others a decoction of leaves, such as those of the sweetbrier, the
dog-rose, and the bramble, or of aromatic herbs and flowers; while
others again, put in lemons, cloves, mace, or brandy. These various
practices are adopted for the purpose of making the rennet keep better,
of lessening its unpleasant smell, of preventing any unpleasant taste it
might give to the curd, or finally of directly improving the flavor of
the cheese. The acidity of the lemon will, no doubt, increase also the
coagulating power of any rennet to which it may be added.

The rennet thus prepared is poured into the milk previously raised to
the temperature of 90 deg. or 95 deg. F., and is intimately mixed with it. The
quantity which it is necessary to add varies with the quality of the
rennet, from a tablespoonful to half a pint for 30 or 40 gallons of
milk. The time necessary for the complete fixing of the curd varies also
from 15 minutes to an hour or even an hour and a half. The chief causes
of this variation, are the temperature of the milk, and the quality and
quantity of the rennet employed.


Different Qualities of Cheese.

The temperature of new or entire milk, when the rennet is added, should
be raised to about 95 deg. F.; that of skimmed milk need not be quite so
high. If the milk be warmer the curd is hard and tough, if colder, it is
soft and difficult to obtain free from the whey. When the former happens
to be the case, a portion of the first whey that separates may be taken
out into another vessel, allowed to cool, and then poured in again. If
it prove to have been too cold, hot milk or water may be added to it; or
a vessel containing hot water may be put into it before the curdling
commences; or the first portion of whey that separates may be heated and
poured again upon the curd. The quality of the cheese, however, will
always be more or less affected, when it happens to be necessary to
adopt any of these remedies. To make the best cheese, the true
temperature should always be attained as nearly as possible, before the
rennet is added.


Mode in which the Milk is warmed.

If, as is the case in some dairies, the milk be warmed in an iron pot
upon the naked fire, great care must be taken that it is not singed or
_fire-fanged_. A very slight inattention may cause this to be the case,
and the taste of the cheese is sure to be more or less affected by it.
In Cheshire, the milk is put into a large tin pail, which is plunged
into a boiler of hot water, and frequently stirred till it is raised to
the proper temperature. In large dairy establishments, however, the
safest method is to have a pot with a double bottom, consisting of one
pot within another, after the manner of a glue-pot; the space between
the two being filled with water. The fire applied beneath, thus acts
only upon the water, and can never, by any ordinary neglect, do injury
to the milk. It is desirable in this heating, not to raise the
temperature higher than is necessary, as a great heat is apt to give an
oiliness to the fatty matter of the milk.


The time during which the Curd stands.

This is also of importance. It should be broken up as soon as the milk
is fully coagulated. The longer it stands after this, the harder and
tougher it will become.


The quality of the Rennet.

This is of much importance, not only in regard to the certainty of the
coagulation, but also to the flavor of the cheese. In some parts of
Cheshire, it is usual to take a piece of the dried membrane and steep it
overnight with a little salt for the ensuing morning's milk. It is thus
sure to be fresh and sweet, if the dried _maw_ be in good preservation.
But where it is customary to steep several skins at a time, and to
bottle the rennet for after-use, it is very necessary to saturate the
solution completely with salt, and to season it with spices, in order
that it may be preserved in a sweet and wholesome state.


The quantity of Rennet added.

This ought to be regulated as carefully as the temperature of the milk.
Too much renders the curd tough; too little causes the loss of much
time, and may permit a larger portion of the butter to separate itself
from the curd. It is to be expected also, that when rennet is used in
great excess, a portion of it will remain in the curd, and will
naturally affect the kind and rapidity of the changes it afterwards
undergoes. Thus, it is said to cause the cheese to heave or swell out
from fermentation. It is probable, also, that it will affect the flavor
which the cheese acquires by keeping. Thus it may be, that the agreeable
or unpleasant taste of the cheeses of certain districts or dairies may
be less due to the quality of the pastures or of the milk itself, than
to the quantity of rennet with which it has there been customary to
coagulate the milk.


The way in which the Rennet is made.

This, no less than its state of preservation and the quantity employed,
may also influence the flavor or other qualities of the cheese. For
instance, in the manufacture of a celebrated French cheese, that of
Epoisse, the rennet is prepared as follows:--Four fresh calf-skins, with
the curd they contain, are well washed in water, chopped into small
pieces, and digested in a mixture of 5 quarts of brandy with 15 of
water, adding at the same time 21/2 lbs. of salt, half an ounce of black
pepper, and a quarter of an ounce each of cloves and fennel seeds. At
the end of six weeks, the liquor is filtered and preserved in
well-corked bottles, while the membrane is put into salt-water to form a
new portion of rennet. For making rich cheeses, the rennet should always
be filtered clear.

On Mont d'Or, the rennet is made with white wine and vinegar. An ounce
of common salt is dissolved in a mixture of half a pint of vinegar with
21/2 pints of white wine, and in this solution a prepared goat's stomach
or _a piece of dried pig's bladder_ is steeped for a length of time. A
single spoonful of this rennet is said to be sufficient for 45 or 50
quarts of milk. No doubt the acid of the vinegar and of the wine aid the
coagulating power derived from the membrane.


The way in which the Curd is treated.

It is usual in our best cheese districts, carefully and slowly to
separate the curd from the whey, not to hasten the separation, lest a
larger portion of the fatty matter should be squeezed out of the curd,
and the cheese should thus be rendered poorer than usual. But in some
places, the practice prevails of washing the curd with hot water, after
the whey has been partially separated from it. Thus at Gouda in Holland,
after the greater part of the whey has been gradually removed, a
quantity of hot water is added, and allowed to remain upon it for at
least a quarter of an hour. The heat makes the cheese more solid and
causes it to keep better.

In Italy, the pear-shaped _caccio-cavallo_ cheeses and the round
_palloni_ cheeses of Gravina, in the Neapolitan territory, are made from
curd, which after being scalded with boiling whey, is cut into slices,
kneaded in boiling water, worked with the hand till it is perfectly
tenacious and elastic, and then made into shapes. The water in which the
curd is washed, after standing twenty-four hours, throws up much oily
matter, which is skimmed off and made into butter.


The Separation of the Whey

Is a part of the process, upon which the quality of the cheese in a
considerable degree depends. In Cheshire, more time and attention is
devoted to the perfect extraction of the whey than in almost any other
district. Indeed, when it is considered that the whey contains sugar and
lactic acid, which may undergo decomposition, and a quantity of rennet
which may bring on fermentation, by both of which processes the flavor
of the cheeses must be considerably affected, it will appear of great
importance that the whey should be as completely removed from the curd
as it can possibly be. To aid in effecting this, a curd-mill, for
chopping it fine after the whey is _strained_ off, is in use in many of
the large English dairies, and a very ingenious and effectual pneumatic
cheese-press for sucking out the whey, was lately invented.

But the way in which the whey is separated is not a matter of
indifference, and has much influence upon the quality of the cheese.
Thus, in Norfolk, according to Marshall, when the curd is fairly set,
the dairy-maid bares her arm, plunges it into the curd, and with the
help of her wooden ladle, breaks up minutely, and intimately mixes the
curd with the whey. This she does for ten or fifteen minutes, after
which the curd is allowed to subside, and the whey is drawn off. By this
agitation, the whey must carry off more of the butter and the cheese
must be poorer.

In Cheshire and Ayrshire, the curd is cut with a knife, but is gently
used and slowly pressed till it is dry enough to be chopped fine, and
thus more of the oily matter is retained. On the same principle, in
making the Stilton cheese, the curd is not cut or broken at all, but is
pressed gently and with care till the whey gradually drains out. Thus
the butter and the curd remain intermixed, and the rich cheese of
Stilton is the result. Thus, while it is of importance that all the whey
should be extracted from the curd, yet the quickest way may not be the
best. More time and care must be bestowed in order to effect this
object, the richer the cheese we wish to obtain.

The quality of the milk or of the pastures, may often be blamed for the
deficiencies in the richness or other qualities of cheese, which are in
reality due to slight but material differences in the mode of
manufacturing it.

_The kind of salt_ used, is considered by many to have some effect upon
the taste of the cheese. Thus the cheese of Gerome, in the Vosges, is
supposed to derive a peculiar taste from the Lorena salt with which it
is cured. In Holland, the efficacy of one kind of salt over another for
the curing of cheese is generally acknowledged.


The Mode in which the Salt is applied.

In making the large Cheshire cheeses, the dried curd, for a single
cheese of sixty pounds, is broken down fine and divided into three equal
portions. One of these is mingled with double the quantity of salt added
to the others, and this is so put into the cheese-vat as to form the
central part of the cheese. By this precaution, the after-salting on the
surface is sure to penetrate deep enough to cure effectually the less
salted parts.

In the counties of Gloucester and Somerset the curd is pressed without
salt, and the cheese, when formed, is made to absorb the whole of the
salt afterwards through its surface. This is found to answer well with
the small and thin cheeses made in those counties, but were it adopted
for the large cheeses of Cheshire and Dunlop, or even for the pine-apple
cheeses of Wiltshire, there can be no doubt that their quality would
frequently be injured. It may not be impossible to cause salt to
penetrate into the very heart of a large cheese, but it cannot be easy
in this way to salt the whole cheese equally, while the care and
attention required must be greatly increased.


Addition of Cream or Butter to the Curd.

Another mode of improving the quality of cheese, is by the addition of
cream or butter to the dried and crumbled curd. Much diligence, however,
is required fully to incorporate these, so that the cheese may be
uniform throughout. Still this practice gives a peculiar character to
the cheeses of certain districts. In Italy, they make a cheese _after
the manner of the English_, into which a considerable quantity of butter
is worked; and the _Reckem_ cheese of Belgium is made by adding half an
ounce of butter and the yolk of an _egg_, to every pound of pressed
curd.


Size of the Cheese.

From the same milk, it is obvious that cheeses of different sizes, if
treated in the same way, will, at the end of a given number of months,
possess qualities in a considerable degree different. Hence, without
supposing any inferiority, either in the milk or in the general mode of
treatment, the size usually adopted for the cheeses of a particular
district or dairy, may be the cause of a recognised inferiority in some
quality, which it is desirable that they should possess in a high
degree.


The Method of Curing.

This has very much influence upon the quality of the cheese. The care
with which they are salted, the warmth of the place in which they are
kept during the first two or three weeks, the temperature and closeness
of the cheese-room in which they are afterwards preserved, the frequency
of turning, of cleaning from mould, and rubbing with butter; all these
circumstances exercise a remarkable influence upon the after-qualities
of the cheese. Indeed, in very many instances, the high reputation of a
particular dairy district or dairy farm, is derived from some special
attention to some or to all of these apparently minor points.

In Tuscany, the cheeses, after being hung up for some time at a proper
distance from the fire, are put to ripen in an underground, cool, and
damp cellar; and the celebrated French cheeses of Roquefort, are
supposed to owe much of the peculiar estimation in which they are held,
to the cool and uniform temperature of the subterranean caverns in which
the inhabitants of the village have long been accustomed to preserve
them.


Ammoniacal Cheese.

The influence of the mode of curing, is shown very strikingly in the
small ammoniacal cheeses of Brie, which are very much esteemed in Paris.
They are soft unpressed cheeses, which are allowed to ripen in a room,
the temperature of which is kept between 60 deg. and 70 deg. Fahrenheit, till
they begin to undergo the putrefactive fermentation, and emit an
ammoniacal odor. They are generally unctuous, and sometimes so small as
not to weigh more than an ounce.


Inoculating Cheese.

It is said that a cheese, possessed of no very striking taste of its
own, may be inoculated with any flavor we approve, by putting into it
with a scoop a small portion of the cheese which we are desirous that
it should be made to resemble. Of course, this can apply only to cheeses
otherwise of equal richness, for we could scarcely expect to give a
Gloucester the flavor of a Stilton, by merely patting into it a small
portion of a rich and esteemed Stilton cheese. [_Johnston and various
other authorities._]

[Illustration: Fig. 19.

Cheese-Press.]

Fig. 19 is a _self-acting cheese-press_, light yet strong. The cheese
itself gives a pressure of twelve times its own weight; and if this is
insufficient, additional weight may be added as required.

The following statements were made by those receiving premiums from the
New York State Agricultural Society:

"Number of cows kept, eleven. Cheese made from two milkings, in the
English manner; no addition made of cream. For a cheese of twenty
pounds, a piece of rennet about two inches square is soaked about twelve
hours in one pint of water. As rennets differ much in quality, enough
should be used to coagulate the milk _sufficiently_ in about forty
minutes. No salt is put _into_ the cheese, nor any on the outside during
the first six or eight hours it is pressed; but a thin coat of fine
Liverpool salt is kept on the outside during the remainder of the time
it remains in press. The cheeses are pressed forty-eight hours, under a
weight of seven or eight cwt. Nothing more is required but to turn the
cheeses once a day on the shelves."

"The milk is strained in large tubs over night; the cream stirred in
milk, and in the morning strained in same tub; milk heated to natural
heat; add color and rennet; curd broke fine and whey off, and broke fine
in hoop with fast bottom, and put in strainer; pressed twelve hours;
then taken from hoop, and salt rubbed on the surface; then put in hoop,
without strainer, and pressed forty-eight hours; then put on tables, and
salt rubbed on surface, and remain in salt six days, for cheese weighing
thirty pounds. The hoops to have holes in the bottom; the crushings are
saved, and set, and churned, to grease the cheese. The above method is
for making one cheese per day. As in butter-making, the utmost
cleanliness is required in every part of the cheese-making premises."




CHAPTER IV.

SHEEP


With the exception of the dog, there is no one of the brute creation
which exhibits the diversity of size, color, form, covering, and general
appearance, which characterizes the sheep, and none which occupies a
wider range of climate, or subsists on a greater variety of food. In
every latitude between the equator and the arctic, he ranges over the
sterile mountains, and through the fertile valleys. He feeds on almost
every species of edible forage, the cultivated grasses, clovers, cereals
and roots; he browses on aromatic and bitter herbs; he crops the leaves
and bark from the stunted forest shrubs, and the pungent, resinous
evergreens. In some parts of Norway and Sweden, when other resources
fail, he subsists on fish or flesh during their long and rigorous
winters, and if reduced to necessity, he eats his own wool.

He is diminutive like the Orkney, or massive like the Teeswater. He is
policerate or many horned; he has two large or small spiral horns like
the Merino, or is polled or hornless like the mutton sheep. He has a
long tail like our own breeds; a broad tail, like many of the eastern;
or a mere button of a tail, like the fat-rumps, discernible only by the
touch. His coat is sometimes long and coarse, like the Lincolnshire;
short and hairy, like those of Madagascar; soft and furry, like the
Angola; or fine and spiral, like the silken Saxon. His color, either
pure or fancifully mixed, varies from the white or black of our own
country, to every shade of brown, dun, buff, blue, and gray, like the
spotted flocks of the Cape of Good Hope and other parts of Africa and
Asia. This wide diversity is the result of long domestication, under
almost every conceivable variety of condition.


Uses.

Among the antediluvians, sheep were immolated for sacrificial offerings,
and their fleeces probably furnished them with clothing. Since the
deluge, their flesh has with all nations been used as a favorite food
for man. By many of the rude, roving nations of the East, they are
employed in carrying burdens.

Their milk is generally used by the uncivilized, and to some extent by
the refined nations of Europe, not only as a beverage, but for making
into cheese, butter, and curds. Job refers to its use, as do Isaiah and
other of the Old Testament writers. Most of the Greek and Roman authors
describe its general use and manufacture. The ewe's milk scarcely
differs in appearance from that of the cow, but is generally thicker,
and yields a pale, yellowish butter, that is always soft and soon
becomes rancid. Culley remarks, "the cheese from their milk is
exceedingly pungent, and for that reason is preferred by many to that
from the cow." In Wales, the milk is mixed with that of the dairy, and
makes a tart, palatable cheese. We have never seen it appropriated for
dairy purposes in the United States, except by a few Welsh and Highland
emigrants. The sheep is frequently employed in the dairy regions of this
country, at the tread-mill or horizontal wheel, to pump the water, churn
the milk, or perform other light domestic work.

The dignity and importance of the shepherd's vocation have ever been
conspicuous. Abel, the supposed twin-brother of the first-born of the
human race, was a "keeper of sheep;" and from this, it may be fairly
inferred, that there is no animal which has so long been under the
immediate control of man. Abraham and his descendants, as well as most
of the ancient patriarchs, were shepherds. Job had 14,000 sheep. It is
said of Rachel, the favored mother of the Jewish race, "she came with
her father's sheep, for she kept them." The seven daughters of the
priest of Midian, "came and drew water for their father's flocks."
Moses, the statesman and lawgiver, who "was learned in all the wisdom of
the Egyptians, kept the flocks of Jethro, his father-in-law;" and David,
the future monarch of Israel, the hero, poet, and divine, was a keeper
of sheep. It was to shepherds, while "abiding in the field, keeping
watch over their flocks by night," that the birth of the Saviour was
announced. The root of the Hebrew name for sheep, signifies
fruitfulness, abundance, plenty; as indicating the blessings they were
destined to confer on the human race. With the sacred writers, they were
the chosen symbol of purity and the gentler virtues; they were the
victims of propitiatory sacrifices; and finally, they became the type of
redemption to fallen man. These may not be considered accidental
allusions in a book, whose every feature is full of design.

Nor has the sheep been less the subject of eulogy and attention with
profane writers. Among these, Homer and Hesiod, Virgil and Theocritus,
introduced them with evident delight in their pastoral themes; while
their heroes and demigods, Hercules and Ulysses, AEneas and Numa,
carefully perpetuated them throughout their regal domains.

In modern times, they have commanded the attention of the most
enlightened nations; and their prosperity has in no instance been
independent of those useful animals, wherever wool and its manufactures
have been regarded as essential staples. Spain and Portugal, for more
than two centuries, were the most enterprising nations of Europe, and
during that period, they excelled in the production and manufacture of
wool. Flanders, for a time, was before England in the perfection of the
arts and the enjoyments of life, and _England then sent the little wool
she raised to that country to be manufactured_. Her politic sovereigns
soon found this a losing game, and offered large bounties for the
importation of artists and machinery. By a systematic and thorough
course of legislation, which looked to the utmost protection and
augmentation of wool and woollens, she has carried their production
beyond any thing the world has ever seen. The small islands of Great
Britain and Ireland, in addition to the support of their 26,000,000 of
people, 15,000,000 of cattle, 2,250,000 horses, 18,000,000 swine, and
innumerable smaller domestic animals, maintain over 40,000,000 sheep,
worth $250,000,000; and besides manufacturing nearly all their fleeces,
annually import nearly an equal amount from abroad. The sumptuary law
for burying the dead in woollen, still occupies its place in their
statute book. And beyond all question, England is the leading power of
the nineteenth century, in the combination of all those qualities which
constitute national greatness, civilization, and strength.


VARIETIES.

Naturalists have divided the wild sheep into four varieties. The
_Musimon_, (_Ovis Musimon_,) inhabiting Corsica, Sardinia, and other
islands of the Mediterranean, the mountainous parts of Spain and Greece,
and some other regions bordering upon that inland sea, have been
frequently domesticated and mixed with the long-cultivated breeds.

The _Argali_, (_O. Ammon_,) ranges over the steppes, or elevated plains
of Central Asia, northward and eastward to the ocean. They are larger,
more hardy, and more untameable than the Musimon.

The _Rocky Mountain Sheep_, (_O. Montana_,) frequently called the
_Big-horn_ by our western hunters, is found on the prairies west of the
Mississippi, and throughout the wild mountainous regions, extending
through California and Oregon to the Pacific. They are larger, but in
other respects resemble the Argali, of which they are probably
descendants, as they could easily cross upon the ice at Behring's
Straits, from the northeastern coast of Asia. Like the Argali, when
caught young they are easily tamed; but we are not aware that they have
ever been bred with the domestic sheep. Before the country was overrun
by the white man, they probably inhabited the region bordering on the
Mississippi. Father Hennepin, a French Jesuit, who wrote nearly two
hundred years ago, often speaks of meeting with goats in his travels
through what is now the territory embraced by Illinois and Wisconsin.
The wild, clambering propensities of these animals, occupying the giddy
heights far beyond the reach of the traveller, and the outer coating of
hair (supplied underneath, however, with a thick coating of soft wool)
gives to them much of the appearance of that animal. In summer they are
generally found single; but when they descend from their isolated, rocky
heights in winter, they are gregarious, marching in flocks under the
guidance of leaders.

The _Bearded Sheep of Africa_ (_O. Tragelaphus_) inhabit the mountains
of Barbary and Egypt. They are covered with a soft, reddish hair, and
have a mane hanging below the neck, and large locks of hair at the
ankle.


The Domesticated Sheep (_O. Aries_)

Embraces all the varieties of the subjugated species. Whether they have
descended from any one of the wild races, is a question yet
undetermined among naturalists; but however this may be, many of the
varieties apparently differ less from their wild namesakes than from
each other.

The _fat-rumped_ and _the broad-tailed sheep_ are much more extensively
diffused than any other. They occupy nearly all the southeastern part of
Europe, Western and Central Asia, and Northern Africa. They are supposed
to be the varieties which were propagated by the patriarchs and their
descendants, the Jewish race. This is inferred from various passages in
the Pentateuch, Exodus xxix. 22; Leviticus iii. 9; viii. 25; ix. 19, and
some others, where "the fat and the rump" are spoken of in connection
with offerings, in which the fat was always an acceptable ingredient.
Dr. Boothroyd renders one of the foregoing passages, "the large, fat
tail entire, taken clear to the rump." It is certain this variety gives
indisputable evidence of remote and continued subjugation. Their long,
pendent, drowsy ears, and the highly artificial posterior developments,
are characteristic of no wild or recently-domesticated race.

This breed consists of numerous sub-varieties, differing in all their
characteristics of size, fleece, color, &c., with quite as many and
marked shades of distinction as the modern European varieties. In
Madagascar, they are covered with hair; in the south of Africa, with
coarse wool; in the Levant, and along the Mediterranean, the wool is
comparatively fine; and from that of the fat-rumped sheep of Thibet the
exquisite Cashmere shawls are manufactured. Both rams and ewes are
sometimes bred with horns, and sometimes without, and they exhibit a
great diversity of color. Some yield a carcass of scarcely 30 lbs.,
while others have weighed 200 lbs. dressed. The tail or rump varies
greatly, according to the purity and style of breeding; some are less
than one-eighth, while others exceed one-third the entire dressed
weight. The fat of the rump or tail is considered a great delicacy, and
in hot climates resembles oil, and in colder, suet.

The broad-tailed sheep were brought into this country, about 50 years
since, by Commodore Barron and Judge Peters, and bred with the native
flocks. They were called the Tunisian mountain sheep. Some of them were
subsequently distributed by Col. Pickering, of Massachusetts, among the
farmers of Pennsylvania; and their mixed descendants were highly prized
as prolific and good nurses, coming early to maturity, attaining large
weights, of a superior quality of carcass, and yielding a heavy fleece
of excellent wool. The principal objection brought against them, was
the difficulty of propagation, which always required the assistance of
the shepherd. The lambs were dropped white, red, tawny, bluish, or
black; but all excepting the black, grew white as they approached
maturity, retaining some spots of the original color on the cheeks and
legs, and sometimes having the entire head tawny or black. The few which
descended from those originally imported into this country, have become
blended with American flocks, and are now scarcely distinguishable from
them.


Native or Common Sheep of the United States.

Strictly speaking, there are no sheep indigenous to North America,
excepting the _Ovis Montana_, or Rocky Mountain sheep. Before the
introduction of the improved European breeds, during the present
century, our sheep were generally a hardy, long-legged, coarse,
open-fleeced animal, which yielded, according to attention and feed,
from 11/2 to 4 lbs. of indifferent wool. We have seen numerous flocks
within the last 20 years, of the pure-bred native, whose bellies were
entirely destitute of wool, and sometimes the whole carcass was bare,
excepting a mere strip or ridge like a mane, reaching from the head to
the tail. The wool which was retained on the neck, back, and sides, was
frequently matted almost as firmly as a leather apron; and that on the
thighs, and sometimes on the sides, was often composed almost wholly of
long hair.

Although indifferently formed in comparison with the best breeds of the
present day, being thin in the breast and back, light quartered, and
slow in coming to maturity, they yet possessed some good qualities. They
were prolific, excellent nurses, tallowed well, and yielded good mutton.
There were, occasionally, some smutty-nosed or brockle-faced sheep among
them, distinguished by their additional size, superior merits, and
courage. These were usually the leaders of the flock, in their marauding
expeditions on their neighbor's domains; and in common with the others,
they were eminently adapted to purvey for themselves on the frontier
settlements. There were, besides, some black or dark chocolate-brown
members in every flock, which were much valued by the thrifty housewife
for their wool, which afforded an economical mixture for jackets, hose,
and trousers, known as sheep's gray.

Our original stock were principally derived from England, where their
counterparts may be seen at the present day, in the refuse breeds of
that country. When these sheep were well selected and properly bred,
there was rapid and satisfactory improvement, and from such flocks,
mixed with some of the more recently improved varieties, have sprung
many valuable animals.

There was but one exception to this general character of the native
flocks, so far as our observation extended, which was a considerably
numerous, and, probably, accidental variety, known as the _Otter breed_,
or _Creepers_. These were an excessively duck-legged animal, with
well-formed bodies, full chest, broad backs, yielding a close heavy
fleece of medium quality of wool. They were deserved favorites where
indifferent stone or wood fences existed, as their power of locomotion
was absolutely limited to their enclosures, if protected by a fence not
less than two feet high. The quality of their mutton was equal, while
their aptitude to fatten was decidedly superior to their longer-legged
contemporaries. They are probably now nearly or quite extinct.

An excellent variety was produced by General Washington, from a cross of
a Persian ram, upon the Bakewell, which bore wool 14 inches in length,
soft and silky, and admirably suited to combing. They were called the
Arlington sheep, but they have long since become incorporated with the
other flocks of the country.


The Merino.

This is undoubtedly one of the most ancient race of sheep extant. The
loose descriptions and indefinite generalities of the ancient writers,
leave much to conjecture on this point; yet we have a few passages from
Pliny, Columella, and some other Roman authors, which leave little doubt
that the Merino was bred in their age, and had even been introduced into
Italy from Greece. It is a matter of history, that the Greeks had choice
breeds of sheep at an early day, which they might have derived from
Egypt, Tyre, and Asia Minor, as they were intimately connected in
commerce with those countries, where the woollen manufacture early
reached great perfection. It is supposed that the celebrated Argonautic
expedition, in quest of the golden fleece, undertaken by the Greeks
nearly 1300 years before Christ, resulted in procuring a valuable race
of sheep from Colchis, in the Euxine.

However this may be, it is certain that when Augustus extended his
peaceful sceptre over half the known world, the Romans were in
possession of some flocks, bearing fleeces of exceeding fineness and
beauty. They had been reared in the province of Apulia, on the southeast
coast of Italy, and were called Tarentine, from Tarentum, the capital of
the province. Here, then, may have been one branch of the Merino family.

Another is undoubtedly described by Pliny, who says, "the _red fleece of
Baetica_ was of still superior quality, _and had no fellow_." All the
Spanish coast on the Mediterranean, of which Baetica formed a
considerable part, comprising the modern Spanish provinces of Jaen,
Cordova, Seville, Andalusia, and Granada, was early colonized by the
enterprising Greeks; and this _red fleece that had no fellow_, was
probably introduced by them at an early day, and by their descendants
had been carried to a still higher degree of perfection than that of
Apulia. Columella, the uncle of the writer on agriculture, a wealthy
emigrant to Spain from Italy, A. D. 30, carried with him some of the
Tarentine sheep, and thus added to the fine-woolled sheep of Spain.
These two ancient streams, united perhaps with a third from the more
ancient stock of the Euxine, (for Strabo asserts that some of the
finest-woolled sheep were brought from that region in his time, and sold
for the enormous sum of $750,) flowed on in an uninterrupted current
over that broad country, and brought down to modern times the unrivalled
race of the Merino. The limited region of Italy, overrun as it
repeatedly was by hordes of barbarians during and after the times of the
late emperors, soon lost her pampered flocks; while the extended regions
of Spain, intersected in every direction by almost impassable mountains,
could maintain their more hardy race, in defiance of revolution or
change.

Whatever distrust may be attached to these scraps of history, which
apparently establish the remote antiquity of the Merino, this much is
absolutely certain, that they are a race whose qualities are inbred, to
an extent surpassed by no others. They have been improved in the general
weight and evenness of their fleece, as in the celebrated flock of
Rambouillet; in the uniformity and excessive fineness of fibre, as in
the Saxons; and in their form and feeding qualities, in various
countries; but there has never yet been deterioration either in quantity
or quality of fleece or carcass, wherever transported, if supplied with
suitable food and attention. Most sheep annually shed their wool if
unclipped; while the Merino retains its fleece, sometimes for five
years, when allowed to remain unshorn. This we conceive affords
conclusive evidence of long-continued breeding among themselves, by
which the very constitution of the wool-producing organs beneath the
skin have become permanently established; and this property is
transmitted to a great extent even among the crosses, thus marking them
as an ancient and peculiar race.

The conquest by the Moors of a part of those fine provinces in the south
of Spain, so far from checking, served rather to encourage the
production of fine wool. They were not only enterprising, but highly
skilled in the useful arts, and carried on extensive manufactories of
fine woollen goods, which they exported to different countries. After
their expulsion in the 15th century, by Ferdinand and Isabella, the
Spaniards preserved these manufactures in part, and sedulously cherished
their fine flocks; and knowing the incomparible advantage they had in
them, their sovereigns, except in a few isolated instances, strictly
prohibited their exportation.


Exportation of Merinoes from Spain.

History asserts that Henry VIII. of England, by permission of Charles
V., imported 3,000 Spanish sheep; but of what kind is not mentioned,
they having numerous varieties in Spain. If of the true Merino, it will
explain the superior quality of the English middle-wools, the Ryeland,
South Downs, and some others.

The first well-authenticated exportation of the Spanish Merino, was made
to Sweden in 1723, by Alstroemer, which solved the problem of their
capacity for sustaining their character, on rough fare and in a high
northern latitude. Lasteyrie, who wrote fifty years after the experiment
had been tried, speaks of their improvement, both in carcass and the
quality and quantity of fleece.

The next exportation was made to Saxony, in 1765, and consisted of 105
rams and 114 ewes, but from what flocks they were taken, history nowhere
mentions. A second exportation to that country was made in 1778, of 110
that were variously selected, from the best flocks in Spain. From these
have descended the high-bred, silken-fleeced Saxons, whose wool stands
confessedly without a rival.

In 1775, the Empress Maria Theresa imported 300 Merinoes into Germany,
and placed them on the imperial farm in Hungary. In 1786, an importation
was made into Denmark and her provinces; and again, in 1797, another
flock of 300 was brought into the kingdom, and placed at Esserum, about
eight leagues from Copenhagen. In 1786, 100 rams and 200 ewes were
imported into Prussia, most of which were allowed to perish from neglect
and disease; but their places were fully made up by later importations.
The same year, 400 ewes and rams were selected from the choicest Spanish
flocks, and placed on the royal farm of Rambouillet, in France, which
laid the foundation of the celebrated flock which bears that name.

A small flock of inferior animals was clandestinely procured by George
III., of England, in 1788, which attracted little attention. In 1791, a
small but choice flock was presented to that monarch by the Cortes of
Spain, which soon acquired high favor among many intelligent breeders. A
part of these were kept pure, and their descendants furnished the superb
flock of 700 Nigrettis, which procured for their owner, Mr. Trimmer, in
1829, the gold medal from the London Society of Arts. Others were mixed
with different flocks in the kingdom, to the evident improvement of
their fleeces.


The first importation of Merinoes into the United States,

Which resulted in the propagation of a pure breed,[2] was made by
Chancellor Livingston, then minister at the court of Versailles, who
sent two choice rams and ewes from the Rambouillet flock, in 1802, to
Claremont, his country seat on the Hudson. In the latter part of the
same year, Col. Humphreys, our minister in Spain, sent out nearly one
hundred Merinoes, which were followed by more numerous flocks from the
same and other sources. The largest importations of the Merino, however,
were made through Mr. Jarvis of Vermont, in 1809, then U. S. Consul in
Spain, and immediately thereafter. He first shipped, as he states, "200
Escurial, afterwards 1400 Paulars, 1700 Aqueirres, 100 Nigrettis, and
about 200 Montarcos. 2700 Montarcos were sent out by a Spaniard and a
Portuguese, and about 300 Guadaloupes by others; also 200 to 300
Paulars, by Gen. Downie, to Boston. Of the Montarco flock shipped by
others, about 2500 came to Boston, Providence, New York, and other
ports. All were imported in the latter part of 1809 and '10, and early
in 1811, and were the only Leonese Transhumantes, if we include
Humphreys' and Livingston's, (which I have no doubt were of the same
stock,) that were ever shipped to the United States."

[2] One or more pure Merinoes were imported into Massachusetts, in the
latter part of the last century, by a citizen of that state, but they
were soon mixed with other flocks, and resulted in the perpetuation of
no distinct breed.

Fig. 20 is a spirited cut of a variety of the Merino without dewlap, and
with a long and somewhat open fleece.

[Illustration: Fig. 20.

Merino Buck.]


Varieties of the Spanish Sheep.

Besides several other breeds of sheep in Spain, consisting of long,
coarse wool, and that of a medium staple, embraced under the different
names of _Chorinoes_, _Choaroes_ or _Chunahs_, the Merino is
distinguished by two general divisions; the _Transhumantes_ or
travelling, and the _Estantes_ or stationary flocks. The former are
subdivided, according to the Provinces they occupy, into Leonese,
Segovian, and Sorian. Many of the Estantes were of the best quality in
respect to carcass, constitution, and fleece; and such as were highly
bred and in the hands of intelligent breeders, were not surpassed by any
of the Spanish flocks. There were also many choice sheep among the
Segovian and Sorian Transhumantes, but in general they were decidedly
inferior to those of Leon. These last were universally regarded as the
prime flocks of Spain. They comprised the Escurial, the Paular, the
Nigretti, the Aqueirres or Muros, the Montarco, the Guadaloupe,
Infantado, and some others.

There is much contradictory testimony as to the comparative merits of
the last-mentioned flocks, as they were found in Spain; which is owing
in part, doubtless, to the difference in the specimens subjected to
examination. We subjoin some of the most reliable authorities on this
subject.

M. Lasteyrie, who investigated this matter closely, says, "The
Guadaloupe have the most perfect form, and are likewise celebrated for
the quantity and quality of their wool. The Paular bear much wool of a
fine quality, but they have a more evident enlargement behind the ears,
and a greater degree of _throatiness_, and the lambs have a coarse hairy
appearance, which is succeeded by excellent wool. The lambs of the
Infantado have the same hairy coat when young. The Nigretti are the
largest and strongest of all the travelling sheep in Spain."

Mr. Livingston says, "The Escurial is the most perfect of all the
travelling flocks in Spain; the Guadaloupe for form, fineness and
abundance of the fleece; the Paular with similar fleeces are larger
bodied. Those of Castile and Leon have the largest, with the finest
coat. Those of Soria are small, with very fine wool; and those also of
Valencia, which do not travel, and like the last have fine wool, but of
a very short staple."

Mr. Jarvis, who spent many years in Spain, under every advantage for
studying them closely, and who also imported, and has since bred large
numbers of them on his estate in Vermont, gives their characteristics
with more particularity, and at much greater length: "The Paulars were
undoubtedly one of the handsomest flocks in Spain. They were of middling
height, round-bodied, well spread, straight on the back, the neck of the
bucks rising in a moderate curve from the withers to the setting on of
the head, their head handsome, with aquiline curve of the nose, with
short, fine, glossy hair on the face, and generally hair on the legs,
the skin pretty smooth, that is, not rolling up or doubling about the
neck and body, as in some other flocks; the crimp in the wool was not so
short as in many other flocks, the wool was somewhat longer, but it was
close and compact, and was soft and silky to the touch, and the surface
was not so much covered with gum. This flock was originally owned by the
Carthusian friars of Paular, who were the best agriculturists in Spain,
and was sold by that order to the Prince of Peace when he came into
power.

The Nigretti flock were the tallest Merinoes in Spain, but were not
handsomely formed, being rather flat-sided, roach-back, and the neck
inclining to sink down from the withers; the wool was somewhat shorter
than the Paular, and more crimped; the skin was more loose and inclined
to double, and many of them were woolled on their faces and legs down to
their hoofs. All the loose-skinned sheep had large dewlaps.

The Aqueirres were short-legged, round, broad-bodied, with loose skins,
and were more woolled about their faces and legs than any other flock I
ever saw; the wool was more crimped than the Paular, and less than the
Nigretti, but was thick and soft. This flock formerly belonged to the
Moors of Spain, and at their expulsion was bought by the family of
Aqueirres. The wool in England was known as the Muros flock, and was
highly esteemed. All the bucks of these three flocks had large horns.

The Escurials were about as tall as the Paulars, but not quite so round
and broad, being in general rather more slight in their make; their wool
was crimped, but not quite so thick as the Paular or Nigretti, nor were
their skins so loose as the Nigretti and Aqueirres, nor had they so much
wool on the face and legs.

The Montarco bore a considerable resemblance to the Escurials. The
Escurial flock had formerly belonged to the crown, but when Philip II.
built the Escurial palace, he gave them to the friars, whom he placed in
a convent that was attached to the palace, as a source of revenue. These
four flocks were moderately gummed.

The Guadaloupe flock was rather larger in the bone than the two
preceding, about the same height; but not quite so handsomely formed;
their wool was thick and crimped, their skins loose and doubling, their
faces and legs not materially different from the two latter flocks, but
in general they were more gummed than either of the other flocks. In
point of fineness, there was very little difference between these six
flocks; and as I have been told by well-informed persons, there is very
little difference in this respect among the Leonese Transhumantes in
general. The Escurials, the Montarcos, and the Guadaloupes, were not, in
general, so heavy-horned as the other three flocks, and about one in six
of the bucks were without horns."


The Saxon,

We have before seen, is one of the varieties of the pure-bred Merino,
the foundation of which was laid by an importation of some of the
choicest animals into Saxony, in 1765. The great care and attention
bestowed upon these sheep by the Elector, the nobility, and the most
intelligent farmers, soon carried them to a point of uniformity and
excellence of fleece, never exceeded by the best of the original flocks.
The breeders were selected with almost exclusive reference to the
quality of the fleece. Great care was taken to prevent exposure
throughout the year, and they were housed on every slight emergency. The
consequence of this course of breeding and treatment has been to reduce
the size and weight of fleece, and partially to impair that hardiness
and vigor of constitution, which universally characterized the original
Transhumantes. In numerous instances, this management resulted in
permanent injury to the character of their flocks, which America has
severely felt in several importations of worthless animals, and which a
too great eagerness for improvement induced her flockmasters to use with
the Spanish Merinoes and their descendants, as a means for this object,
but which has resulted in the introduction of fatal diseases and serious
deterioration in their flocks.

[Illustration: Fig. 21.

Saxon Ram.]


The first Importation of Saxons into this Country

Was made in 1823, of four good rams, two of which went to Boston and the
others to Philadelphia. The next was made the following year, and
consisted of 75 rams and ewes, which were brought to Boston, and sold at
public auction, and were afterwards scattered over the country. Another
lot of 180 followed the next year, to the same place, and was sold in
the same manner, but at an increased price, some selling as high as $450
each.

These prices excited the spirit of speculation, and the following year
witnessed the importation of near 3,000, many of which were decidedly
inferior. These were all thrown upon the market for the most they would
command; and in many instances, the sales not half covering the cost of
importation, the enterprise was abandoned as a speculation, or
commercial operation.

The late Henry D. Grove, of Hoosic, New York, a native of Germany, and a
highly intelligent and thoroughly bred shepherd, accompanied some of the
best early importations to this country. He selected 105 choice animals
for his own breeding, which he imported in 1827, and 70 more equally
good, in 1828, and with these he formed the flock from which he bred to
the time of his decease, in 1844.

The average weight of fleece from the entire flock of Mr. Grove, nearly
all of which were ewes and lambs, as stated by him to the writer, in
1842, was 2 lbs. 14 ounces, thoroughly washed on the sheep's back. This
was realized after a short summer and winter's keep, when the quantity
of hay or its equivalent fed to the sheep did not exceed by actual
weight 11/2 lbs. per day, except to the ewes, which received an additional
quantity just before and after lambing. This treatment was attended with
no disease or loss by death, and with an increase of lambs, equalling
one for every ewe.

In a flock of pure Saxony sheep owned by Mr. Smith of Connecticut, as
stated in a letter from the owner, published in the American Shepherd,
104 ewes raised 101 lambs, and yielded 341 lbs. of wool, which sold at
70 cents per lb. For the 18 months preceding, he lost but three animals
out of 300, from ordinary casualties. But some flocks of pure Saxony do
not, in good condition, average 2 lbs. per head.

A recent importation, (May, 1846,) made by Mr. Taintor of Connecticut,
consisting of four bucks and four ewes, from the celebrated Saxon flock
of Baron de Spreck, show a size and apparent vigor of constitution,
equalling any of their Merino progenitors.

[Illustration: Fig. 22.

Rambouillet Buck.]


The Rambouillet Flock.

This flock was founded in 1786, by Louis XVI., from a selection of 400
of the best Spanish sheep, which were placed on the royal farm at
Rambouillet. These, like the Saxon, received all the attention which
intelligence and wealth could bestow, and the consequence was soon
manifest in their larger size, and the increased weight and uniformity
in the fineness of their fleece; the last improvement being particularly
evident, from the absence of the coarse wool, which in many cases
infested the quarters; and the jarr or hair, which frequently abounds on
the flanks, legs, and thighs of the original Merino.

Besides the crown flocks at Rambouillet, they are found in equal
perfection on several other of the royal farms, especially those of
Malmaison, Perpignan, Arles, Clermont, and some others. These flocks
have been bred for hardy constitution, large carcass, and heavy fleece,
and of as much fineness as is consistent with large weights, and as
uniform in quality throughout, as possible. Mr. Gilbert, who was
particularly familiar with them, says, "almost all the fleeces of the
rams, from two years old and upwards, weigh (unwashed) from 12 to 13
lbs.; but the mean weight, taking the rams and the ewes together, has
not quite attained to 8 lbs., after deducting the tags and the wool of
the belly." The French pound is about one-twelfth heavier than the
English; but from the general custom of folding the sheep in France,
feeding them in fallows, and wintering them in houses, the fleece
becomes very dirty. The loss in washing (fit for manufacturing) is about
60 per cent., so that the clean fleece of the ram will average about 6
lbs., and that of the whole flock something under 4 lbs.


The first Importation of the Rambouillets to this Country.

This was in 1801, by M. Dellesert, of Paris, for M. Dupont, then in New
York, and consisted of four choice rams, only one of which, Don Pedro,
reached this country. He was used among the native ewes near Kingston,
N. Y., for three years, and then transferred to Delaware, where he
effected great improvement among the native flocks. The second was that
made by the late Chancellor Livingston, before alluded to. There was
another in 1840, by Mr. Collins, of Connecticut, comprising 30 select
ewes and 2 rams. All these sheep possessed the characteristics peculiar
to the variety as described.

A still more recent importation has been made by Mr. Taintor, at the
same time with that of the Saxons previously mentioned, consisting of 23
ewes and 3 bucks, variously selected from the choicest flocks of the
descendants of the Spanish Merino. The rams, though young, are the most
promising animals of their breed, and when full grown, will weigh from
225 to 250 lbs. each. The sire of one was sold the past season for $500.
He sheared 23 lbs. of unwashed wool. The ewes measured after they were
shorn, from 251/2 to 29 inches in height over the withers. The height of
the under side of their bodies from the ground, was from 91/2 to 12
inches, which is in the proportion of good American Merino sheep. Their
weights varied, after shearing, from 124 to 153 lbs. Some of them were
quite thin in flesh, the largest especially, which, if in fine condition
with her fleece on, would weigh at least 200 lbs. The following is the
weight of their fleeces unwashed. The scales used did not mark less
than one-quarter of a pound, which will account for the absence of odd
ounces.

  No.  17        13 lbs.
   "   27        15  "
   "   64        163/4 "
   "   71        141/2 "
   "   84        161/2 "
   "   87        161/4 "
   "   94        17  "
   "  100        121/4 "
   "  109        17  "
   "  110        17  "
   "  117        163/4 "
   "  118        153/4 "
   "  133        143/4 "
   "  195        131/2 "

It was the unbiased opinion of several wool-dealers present, that the
shearing above would yield at least 35 lbs. of _cleansed_ wool, fitted
for manufacturing without further loss, out of every 100 lbs. shorn. The
fourteen ewes yielded 216 lbs. unwashed, which would be equivalent to 75
lbs. 10 oz. thoroughly cleansed, or an average of 5 lbs. 6 oz. per head.
One-third may be safely added to bring this up to _clean washed_. This
would make the average, as wool-growers usually dispose of their
fleeces, 7 lbs. 3 oz. per head, a yield totally unprecedented in this
country.


The Progress of the Merino in the United States.

Though reaching back but half a century, the Merino flocks of this
country have been very fluctuating as to their value, increase, and
improvement. When first introduced, they were viewed with distrust by
the majority of our farmers; and it was not till after several years'
experience of their paramount merits, that they were generally
disseminated. But the confidence of our flock-masters having once been
secured, it has never been withdrawn, and they have ever since been
cherished favorites. The prices for choice Merinoes rapidly increased
after their character was fully established, and Livingston states the
average price for rams, in 1811, at $1,000, and some were sold at a much
higher rate.

This was the period of the embargo, when our infant manufactures were
just starting into life; and being followed by war with the greatest
commercial nation of the world, we were thrown entirely on our own
resources for the supply of our woollen and other fabrics, and wool and
sheep maintained their full value till after the return of peace, in
1816. The flooding of our country with foreign goods, under low duties,
which succeeded this event, either broke down or effectually paralyzed
our woollen manufactures; and wool, of course, felt the full weight of
this crushing influence. The Merino rapidly declined in value, till its
price nearly approximated to that of the native sheep. Their merits had,
however, become so conspicuous, that the low prices produced a more
general diffusion, and they and their crosses were thus sown broadcast
over the country.

The introduction of the Saxons, in great numbers, in 1826, many of which
were excessively diminutive and diseased, and their indiscriminate use
with our pure-bred Merinoes, was a serious interruption to the career of
improvement in many of our flocks. Their mixture with the best Saxons
was no further detrimental, than to reduce the quantity of fleece, and,
to a certain extent, lessen the peculiar hardiness of the original
Transhumantes, which had been fully preserved by their descendants in
this country. The use of well-selected Saxon rams with Merino flocks,
was extensively practised, and it is still persisted in by many
intelligent flock-masters, after twenty years' experience, who are
satisfied that they find it for their interest to continue this style of
breeding. The animals being smaller, consume less; and they probably
produce a quantity of wool in proportion to their food, which, from its
improved and uniform quality, commands a higher price in the market.
Wherever they are not sufficiently hardy, they can be bred back towards
the Spanish Merino standard, by the use of some of the stouter rams.
Their natures are intrinsically the same. They are only divergent
streams from the same original fountain, and when again united, they
readily coalesce and flow onwards, without violence or disorder.

The Merino, as might reasonably have been anticipated, when properly
managed, has improved from a variety of causes. Though kept scrupulously
pure in Spain, they were seldom bred with that refinement of taste or
nice judgment, which distinguishes the accomplished modern breeder.
Their management was too entirely intrusted to ignorant shepherds or
careless agents, to secure that close attention which is essential to
improvement. The sheep had to perform a journey of several hundred miles
twice in a year, to and from their distant Sierras; and it was
absolutely essential that strong animals should be selected for
breeding; and to secure this object, those were frequently used which
were deficient in the most profitable qualities. They were also closely
bred in-and-in, seldom or never departing from a particular flock to
procure a fresh cross. Their wild, nomadic life, approaching nearly to
that of their natural state, and their peculiarly healthful pasturage,
alone prevented a serious deterioration from this cause.

When brought into the United States, the flocks were soon mingled with
each other, and for many years past, probably, not an unmixed descendant
of any distinct original flock could be traced. Abundance of appropriate
food has been given them, without the labor of long and fatiguing
journeys; and lastly, there has been much care used in the selection of
the most profitable animals for breed. The spirit of improvement has
been recently awakened to this important branch of American husbandry,
and as we already have all the elements within ourselves for its
attainment, if not arrested by any untoward national policy, it will
soon result in giving us numerous flocks of as choice sheep as the world
affords.


Peculiarities of the Merino.

The prominent peculiarities of the Merino, are the abundance and
fineness of its fleece; the tenacity with which it is held; its crimped
or spiral form; its felting properties; and the excessive quantity of
yolk, giving to it that softness which distinguishes it from all others.
Their large horns are common to several other varieties. Their hoofs are
sometimes singularly long, reaching 8 or 10 inches when allowed to grow.
The horns, hoofs, and wool scarcely differ in their chemical
constituents; and the peculiar development of the two former, is justly
considered as an additional evidence of their wool-bearing properties.

The yolk, in most of the sheep, forms, with the dust which adheres to
it, a firm crust on the exterior, and together with the compactness of
the fleece, it offers considerable resistance to the open hand on being
pressed, giving the impression of rigidity. This outer covering repels
the rain, the snow, and the wind like a coat of mail, thus fitting the
Merino to endure exposure beyond any other sheep. On opening the crust,
the wool is found of a brilliant, golden hue, sparkling with yolk, and
firmly held together in masses, hardly distinguishable from the cocoon
of the silk-worm. The wool closely covers every part of the body, and
frequently the entire legs and head, excepting a part of the face. Still
another peculiarity of the Merino is its longevity. They attain a great
age when properly managed, and, in healthy localities, sometimes breed
till 20 years of age.

The Merino may be described, generally, as a small-boned, closely made,
medium-sized sheep, varying from 80 lbs. of live weight, for a small
ewe, to 160 lbs. for good-sized wethers and rams, in ordinary condition.
They are light in the shoulders and chest, and altogether are more
deficient in form than the best mutton sheep. This apparent difference
is materially lessened when both are denuded of their fleece; as the
longer pile of the latter covers defects, which would manifest
themselves under the closer covering of the Merino. Yet, with this
seeming deficiency, Young found, in feeding the Merino and Bakewell,
that the latter ate the most, and gained the least, in the ratio of two
to three. We give the statement as we find it, though it apparently
contravenes a fundamental principle, which a knowledge of all the
circumstances of the trial, the peculiarities of the particular animals,
&c., might probably explain satisfactorily.

The mutton is excellent, and it is probably not surpassed by that of any
other sheep. Lord Somerville claims it as a rule, that the quality of
the flesh in each class of sheep follows that of the wool, and that the
flesh of the short and fine-woolled sheep is closer in the grain and
more highly flavored than the long-woolled. Sir Joseph Banks says, the
London butchers, after having some of the Merinoes, eagerly sought for
more, from its popularity with their best customers; and it is certain
that the flavor of our mountain-fed Merino does not suffer in comparison
with the choicest breeds.


Breeding Merinoes.

The general principles of breeding cattle and sheep, as laid down by the
most approved authorities, must be taken with some exceptions, when
applied to the Merino. Good form and feeding qualities are desirable in
this breed, but they are not as essential as with the others. _Wool_ is
the great object, and if this be sufficiently fine, even, and abundant,
something may be abated in the perfection of form. Early maturity, so
much sought after in the mutton sheep, cannot be reconciled with the
great longevity, and the prolonged productive powers of the Merino. We
must content ourselves, therefore, with slowly engrafting such
improvements on the breed, as can be effected without prejudice to his
other good qualities, and look to his crosses with others for such
qualities as are irreconcilable with his nature.

It is considered indispensable to the improvement of the Merino, that it
be not bred too young. A vigorous ewe may bring her first lamb at two
years old, but it is better that it be deferred till three. The ram
should never be used till his second year, and then but sparingly. From
21/2 to 6 years old is deemed the most vigorous age, though many may be
safely used till 8 or 10, and occasionally later. Both ewes and rams
have been known to breed till 20 years old.

The _ram_ should be large, stout, and well made, carrying his weight as
compactly as possible. The nose should be convex; the face covered with
a soft velvety hair; the eye lively and prominent; the veins near the
lachrymal glands, of a clear red; the horns rough; short neck; pendent
dewlap not objectionable; full chest; broad shoulders; broad, level
back; large quarters; tail large and well set up; good legs, and sound
hoofs; with a firm, easy, regular gait; the head carried high, with a
look of boldness and decision, without in any degree approaching to
wildness or ferocity.

The _ewe_ should possess these characteristics generally, with such
modifications as are suited to the sex. Great care should be taken to
breed from such as are most perfect in all the essential points of
constitution, form, and size; and weight, uniformity, and fineness of
fleece. The closest observation is requisite, to select the best in all
respects.

In-and-in breeding should be avoided where practicable, which can be
done where there is a careful registry of the sheep through successive
generations. Excessive use of rams can never be permitted without
decided injury to them and their progeny. In Spain, four rams are
supplied to every hundred ewes. This limited number is proper enough,
where they undergo so much fatigue in travelling, and kept too, as they
are, entirely on grass. But if moderately grained before and during
their use, and especially if kept up, and allowed to serve the ewes once
only, as they come in heat, this number may be largely increased. A
vigorous ram will suffice for 35 to 40 ewes, when running with the
flock; yet his powers would not be more taxed by double or even treble
this number, if admitted to each but once. Bread is a convenient food
for the ram while running with the sheep. If he is gentle, which he
should always be, he will come up readily and eat from the hand, without
exciting the attention of the other sheep, which crowd, and not
unfrequently injure each other when grain is placed before him; or he
may be stabled at night and fed with grain.

If young ewes have stolen lambs, they should be taken away immediately
after yeaning, and the nourishment supplied to the lamb from the milk
of a cow. The tax of nursing is nearly equal to that of gestation, and
farther injury to the dam may be avoided by this practice. Merino ewes
have had the reputation of being indifferent nurses in Spain. This is
owing to their fatigue in travelling, and scanty pasturage, rather than
to any constitutional deficiency. It is a frequent practice there, to
kill a part of the lambs, and put one on to two ewes. This has never
been found necessary in the countries where they have been transplanted,
as generous feed for the dams has invariably been found entirely
adequate to their support of the young.


The localities in which Merino Sheep can be profitably kept in the
United States,

Are wherever the pastures are sweet and dry; the climate not excessively
hot; and the land not too valuable for other purposes. Wool is generally
the great object in the sheep husbandry of this country, and when sheep
farms are remote from the large markets, the Merino will make much the
most profitable returns. In the neighborhood of cities, where large and
fat sheep and early lambs bear a high price, the mutton sheep may be
substituted.


The South Down.

This valuable sheep has been known and bred for a long time on the
chalky downs of England, where it has always maintained the character of
a hardy animal, yielding a medium quality of wool, and furnishing mutton
of a superior flavor. It was not, however, till within the last 70
years, that any considerable attention was devoted to its improvement.
Since that period, its fine points have been remarkably developed, which
is shown in its improved size and form, and its early maturity and
productiveness. The late Mr. John Ellman, of England, was the first who
took them thoroughly in hand; and so eminent was his success, that he
founded a flock which has been the source whence all the best blood has
been since derived.

[Illustration: Fig. 23.

South Down Buck.]


The form and characteristics of the South Downs.

His criteria of a good South Down, are as follows:--"The head small and
hornless; the face speckled or gray, and neither too long nor too short.
The lips thin, and the space between the nose and the eyes narrow. The
under jaw, or chap, fine and thin; the ears tolerably wide, and well
covered with wool, and the forehead also, and the whole space between
the ears well protected by it, as a defence against the fly. The eye
full and bright, but not prominent. The orbits of the eye--the eye-cap,
or bone,--not too projecting, that it may not form a fatal obstacle in
lambing. The neck of a medium length, thin towards the head, but
enlarging towards the shoulders, where it should be broad and high, and
straight in its whole course above and below. The breast should be wide,
deep, and projecting forwards between the fore-legs, indicating a good
constitution, and a disposition to thrive. Corresponding with this, the
shoulders should be on a level with the back, and not too wide above;
they should bow outward from the top to the breast, indicating a
springing rib beneath, and leaving room for it. The ribs coming out
horizontally from the spine, and extending far backward, and the last
rib projecting more than the others; the back flat from the shoulders
to the setting on of the tail; the loin broad and flat; the rump long
and broad, and the tail set on high and nearly on a level with the
spine. The hips wide; the space between them and the last rib on either
side as narrow as possible, and the ribs, generally, presenting a
circular form like a barrel. The belly as straight as the back. The legs
neither too long nor too short. The fore-legs straight from the breast
to the foot; not bending inward at the knee, and standing far apart both
before and behind; the hocks having a direction rather outward, and the
twist, or the meeting of the thighs behind, being particularly full; the
bones fine, yet having no appearance of weakness, and of a speckled or
dark color. The belly well defended with wool, and the wool coming down
before and behind to the knee, and to the hock; the wool short, close,
curled, and fine, and free from spiry projecting fibres."

[Illustration: Fig. 24.

South Down Ewe.]

Other breeders have commenced where Ellman left off, and have apparently
pushed their improvement to its utmost capacity; and especially has this
been done by Messrs. Grantham and Webb, the latter of whom, while
preserving all the essential merits of the sheep, has carried the live
weight of breeding rams to 250 lbs., and well-fattened wethers to 200
lbs. dressed weight. Many of the choicest animals have been imported
into this country, and they are now to be found, in limited numbers, in
almost every state of the Union.

The wool was formerly short, and used only for cloths, flannels, &c. It
has been considerably lengthened in many of the late flocks, and with
the improvements in the combing machinery, is now much used in England
as a combing wool. The quantity produced is nearly equal to that of the
Merino flocks when well kept, varying, according to the size and style
of breeding, from 3 to 4 lbs. of clean washed wool, which in quality
does not differ materially from half-blood Merino, and sometimes rather
exceeds it. The larger animals, of course, produce fleeces of much
greater weight, sometimes reaching to 8 or 9 lbs. The South Down will
subsist on short pasture, but well repays full feeding. It attains early
maturity, is hardy and prolific, frequently producing two at a birth.
Like all highly-improved English breeds, it is not a long-lived sheep.
It may be considered in its prime at three. The wethers may be fattened
at 18 to 30 months, and the ewes at 3 to 5 years, when first required as
breeders. The last are sometimes allowed to come in with a lamb at a
year, but they cannot be sustained in vigor if put to breeding before
two.


The Cheviot

Is thus described by Blacklock: "They have a bare head, with a long jaw
and white face, but no horns. Sometimes they have a shade of gray upon
the nose, approaching to dark at the tip; at others, a tinge of lemon
color on the face, but these markings scarcely affect their value. The
legs are clean, long, and small-boned, and covered with wool to the
hough, but there is a sad want of depth at the breast, and of breadth
both there and on the chine. A fat carcass weighs from 12 lbs. to 18
lbs. per quarter, and a medium fleece about 3 lbs. The purest specimens
of this breed are to be found on the Scotch side of the Cheviot hills,
and on the high and stony mountain farms which lie between that range
and the sources of the Teviot. These sheep are a capital mountain stock,
provided the pasture resembles the Cheviot hills, in containing a good
proportion of rich herbage."

They are eminently adapted to high lands and a severe climate, though
less so than the Black-faced or Heath sheep of Scotland. They have
become an American sheep, by their repeated introduction into this
country. A late importation of several choice sheep was made by Mr.
Carmichael of New York. The wool on these is from 5 to 7 inches long,
coarse, but well suited to combing. Like the Downs, it has heretofore
been classed among the middle-wools, but these specimens would seem to
indicate that they are verging towards the long-wools.


The Bakewell or Leicester, the Cotswold and Lincolnshire,

Possess several qualities in common, and it is only a practiced eye that
can readily detect the difference. This resemblance arises from a
recent, common origin. They are all large and hornless; of a pure white;
with long, coarse, and heavy fleeces; excellent mutton sheep; coming
early to maturity, and capable of carrying enormous quantities of fat.
There have been from time immemorial numerous flocks of these large,
coarse-woolled sheep, existing in certain parts of England, under a
variety of names, and partaking of some slight peculiarity of features,
according to the district in which they are bred. Thus, besides those
above-mentioned, there were the Teeswater, the Romney-Marsh, the
Kentish, the Bampton, the Exmoor, &c., all of which were deficient in
form, slow-feeders, and late in coming to maturity.


Improvement of the Long-Wools.

The late Robert Bakewell first commenced a decided improvement with the
Leicesters, nearly a century since. He began by selecting the choicest
sheep in England, which possessed the essential qualities; and by
judicious feeding and management throughout, he soon brought them up to
a character widely differing from the original with which he started. So
eminent was his success, that in 1787 he let three rams, for a single
season, for 1250 pounds, (about $6,200,) and was offered 1050 pounds
(about $5,200) for 20 ewes. Soon after this, he received the enormous
price of 800 guineas, or $4,000, for the use of two-thirds of a ram for
one season, reserving the other third for himself.

[Illustration: Fig. 25.

Long-wool Buck.]

He reduced the bone and offal or worthless parts of the carcass, and
increased the weight of the valuable parts, and especially their
tendency to fatten and early maturity. This was effected mainly by a
nice discrimination, which has probably never been surpassed, if it has
ever been equalled. He selected medium sizes for the breed, with as much
evenness and perfection of form as possible, for he found that
excellence and profitable feeding qualities were seldom connected with
extra size, large bones, or imperfect form. He also observed the
disposition to fatten in individuals, and used only such as were
conspicuous in this respect. He relied more than all upon their quality
of _handling_ well, depending even more upon the elastic, mellow touch,
than upon the most symmetrical figure. He used only the choicest rams, a
little under size, while the ewes were of full medium weight. The
progeny were pushed with a full supply of nutritious food, and
systematically brought to early maturity.

Connected with this, was his practice of _in-and-in breeding_, or
breeding the parent upon the progeny, for several successive
generations, which had the tendency still further to refine the bone and
offal, and impress most effectually the desirable characteristics of the
race. It is even credibly asserted, that he produced rot in such of his
fattening sheep as he wished to mature early for the shambles, as in the
first stages of that loathsome disease the fat-secreting organs
accomplish their office more rapidly than in a state of perfect health;
and it at least secured them against breeding when they left his own
hands. It is certain, that Bakewell carried his refining system to such
an extent, as partially to destroy the procreative powers; and he was
subsequently obliged to introduce new animals, to reinvigorate and
continue his flock.

The general system of Bakewell, however, was attended with complete
success. He produced a race of animals, not only far beyond what England
had ever before seen, but which, in all the qualities he endeavored to
establish, have not been since exceeded; and his _improved Leicesters_
have come down to the present day as perfect as he left them, showing
conclusively, that he not only formed, but stamped the peculiarities of
the breed, with a permanence which yet bears witness to his genius. One
of these attained the enormous live weight of 368 lbs., and dressed 248
lbs.


The Cotswold and Lincolnshire.

Other breeders were not slow in following in Bakewell's footsteps with
different breeds, and the Cotswold and Lincolnshire especially, have
become the subjects of an equally decided improvement, while the errors
of Bakewell were entirely avoided. They possess a rather more desirable
robustness, approaching, in some few specimens, almost to coarseness, as
compared with the finest Leicesters; but they are more hardy and less
liable to disease. They attain as large a size, and yield as great an
amount of wool, of about the same value. These breeds scarcely differ
more from each other, than do flocks of a similar variety, which have
been separately bred for several generations. They are prolific, and
when well fed, the ewes will frequently produce two lambs at a birth,
for which they provide liberally from their udder till the time for
weaning. The weight of the fleece varies from 4 to 8 lbs. per head.


Peculiarity of long Wool and its Uses.

The striking peculiarity of the long-wools, is in the production of a
fleece, which is perfectly adapted, by its length and the absence of the
felting property, to the manufacture of worsted stuffs, bombazines,
mousseline de laines, &c. This is a branch of manufactures, for which we
had little material that was suitable, till the introduction of the
long-wools; and its rapid extension in the United States, within the
past few years, clearly shows that a large and increasing demand for
this kind of wool will continue at remunerating prices. Besides its uses
for combing, it is extensively manufactured into blankets, carpeting,
and many other fabrics.


Importation of Long-Wools.

Several of the Bakewells were imported during the last century; and many
flocks, containing some of the best specimens, have been introduced and
scattered over every section of the country. The largest of any single
importation of the long-wools, was made by Messrs. Corning & Sotham, in
1842, and immediately preceding, and consisted of 70 or 80 choice
Cotswolds.


Breeding the Long-Wools.

Some information on this subject will be found under the head of
_breeding Merinoes_, and _improvement of the Long-Wools_. The ram and
ewe should be selected from the best specimens of the breed which is to
be perpetuated. There are peculiarities of form or appearance in each,
which should be carefully observed. A _violent cross_ should never be
permitted for the purpose of perpetuation, as suggested under the head
of _principles of breeding_, in a previous chapter; such as between
those possessing totally opposite properties, as the Merino and
long-wools; and there is no conceivable advantage in mixing the
middle-wools, South Downs, &c., with either.

Lord Western has long experimented on the blending of the Merino and
long-wools, through several generations, without any well-defined
results, nor is it believed to be attainable. There is no evenness or
integrity of character, either in the animal or fleece, from such
mixtures; nor is it possible to foretel the character of progeny from
these bastard crosses. The general rule, that like begets like, will not
hold true here, for the animal comes large or small, with a long or
short fleece, fine or coarse, or intermixed; and this, too, is repeated
through numerous generations, when the immediate parents exhibit
properties altogether unlike the offspring, and which they derive from
some remote ancestry. This practice will do to produce lambs for the
butcher, as the consequence of a fresh cross is greater stamina and
thrift; and it is found that lambs thus bred attain an early and full
development. Thousands of such are annually bred on the banks of the
Hudson, Long Island, and around our large cities, and in the worst
possible way, as the large, coarse ram is used on the delicate Saxon
ewe; yet the lambs thrive and command a good price in the market, and
the owner is satisfied to pocket the result. But nothing could be more
absurd than to propagate from such progeny for any other purpose than to
make early and profitable mutton.

The mixture of breeds of similar character, is attended with the best
consequences. Such was the intermingling of the improved Leicesters with
the Cotswold and Lincolnshire, by which their former coarseness was
removed; and such was the use of the latter with the Leicesters, when
they became impotent and almost worthless, from over-refinement in
breeding. Good results have followed the mixture of the South and
Hampshire Downs. A marked improvement in the Merino in this country, has
been claimed by Mr. Jarvis and several others, from the mixture of the
various flocks, which for ages had been kept distinct in Spain; and the
same result is known to have followed a similar course with the
Rambouillet and Saxon flocks.


The ewe goes with young

About five months, varying from 145 to 162 days. Each flock-master will
of course determine what is the proper lambing time. For early market,
or when there are few sheep, and those well looked after, the lambs may
come while the ewes are in the yards, and provision can be made for
them, by placing such as are heavy in warm stalls. Both the dam and
young thus receive a closer attention than they would in the field; and
after a week's housing, in severe weather, the lamb may be turned out
into the dry yard, where he will suffer no more, apparently, than the
full-grown sheep.

But with large flocks, early lambing is attended with much trouble, and
it is generally avoided, by deferring it till the weather has become
more settled, and a full bite of grass will afford the dam a plentiful
supply of milk. Yet in this case, the young sheep must daily be under
the eye of the shepherd, who should see that they are well supplied with
food, and especially that they are brought under cover, in severe or
stormy weather.

_A ram will serve_ from 20 to 100 ewes in a season, according to his
age, health, feed, and management. A South Down or long-woolled lamb, of
7 or 8 months, is sometimes used; and when this is done, he should be
well fed, and allowed to run only with a very few ewes. If full-grown
rams are turned into a lean pasture to remain with the ewes, not less
than four should be put in for every hundred. But if a well-fed ram, in
full health and vigor, is kept up, and led out to the ewe as she comes
into heat, and allowed to serve her once only, he will suffice for one
hundred, without injury to himself or progeny. For this purpose, the ram
should be prepared, not by being fat, for this, neither he nor the ewe
should ever be; but by being fed with grain for a short time before, and
during the continuance of the season. The ewes are more likely to come
quickly into heat, and prove prolific, if lightly fed with stimulating
food at the time.

It is reasonably enough conjectured, that if procreation, and the first
period of gestation, takes place in cold weather, the f[oe]tus will
subsequently be fitted for the climate, which rules during the early
stages of its existence. If this be so, and it is certainly in
accordance with the laws of nature, fine-woolled sheep are most likely
to maintain their excellence, by deferring the connection of the male
till the commencement of cold weather; and in the Northern states, this
is done about the first of December, which brings the yeaning time in
the last of April or first of May, when the early grass will afford a
large supply and good quality of feed.


Winter Management and Food.

Sheep should be brought into winter-quarters soon after the severe
frosts occur, as these diminish the feed, and materially impair its
nutritious qualities. They ought also to be removed from the
grass-lands, before they become permanently softened by the rains, as
they will injuriously affect their comfort and health; and allowing them
to remain is equally objectionable, from their poaching the sod. If the
number be large when brought to the yards, they must be divided into
flocks of 50 to 100, according to the size of the yards and sheds. The
young and feeble ought to be separated from the others, and the ailing
ones placed by themselves; and that no one may suffer from the others,
all should be classed as uniformly as possible as to strength. The yards
must be dry, well supplied with a trough of fresh water, and with
comfortable sheds, to which they can retire when they choose.


Shelters.

These, in northern climates, are indispensable to profitable
sheep-raising, and in every latitude north of the Gulf of Mexico they
would be advantageous. There is policy as well as humanity in the
practice. An animal eats much less when thus protected; he is more
thrifty, less liable to disease, and his manure is richer and more
abundant. The feeding may be done in the open yard in clear weather, and
under cover in severe storms. The shelters for sheep are variously
constructed, to suit the taste or circumstances of the flock-master. A
sheep-barn, built upon a side hill, will afford two floors; one
underneath, surrounded by three sides of wall, should open to the south,
with sliding or swinging doors to guard against storms; and another may
be provided above, if the floors are perfectly tight, with proper
gutters to carry off the urine; and sufficient storage for the fodder
can be furnished by scaffolds overhead. Or they may be constructed with
twelve or fifteen feet posts on level ground, allowing the sheep to
occupy the lower part, with the fodder stored above.

In all cases, however, _thorough ventilation should be provided_, for of
the two evils of exposure to cold or too great privation of air, the
former is to be preferred. Sheep cannot long endure close confinement
without injury. In all ordinary weather, a shed closely boarded on three
sides, with a tight roof, is sufficient protection; especially, if the
open side is shielded from bleak winds, or leads into a well-enclosed
yard. If the floors above are used for storage, they should be made
tight, that no hay, chaff, or dust can fall upon the fleece.


Racks or Mangers.

These are indispensable to economical feeding. If the hay is fed on the
ground, the leaves and seeds, the most valuable part of the fodder, are
almost wholly lost; and when wet, the sheep, in their restlessness while
feeding, will tread much of it into the mud. To make an economical box
or rack, take six light pieces of scantling, say three inches square,
one for each corner, and one for the centre of each side. Boards of pine
or hemlock, 12 or 15 feet long and 12 or 14 inches wide, may then be
nailed on to the bottom of the posts for the sides, which are separated
by similar boards at the ends, 21/2 feet long. Boards 12 inches wide,
raised above the lower ones by a space of 9 to 12 inches, are nailed on
the sides and ends, which completes the rack. The edges of the opening
should be made perfectly smooth, to prevent chafing or tearing out the
wool. The largest dimensions above given, are suitable for the large
breeds, and the smallest for the Saxon, and still smaller are proper for
their lambs. These should be set on dry ground, or under the sheds, and
they can easily be removed wherever necessary.

Some prefer the racks made with slats, or smooth, upright sticks, in the
form of the usual horse-rack. There is no objection to this, but it
should always be accompanied by a board trough affixed to the bottom, to
catch the fine hay which falls in feeding. These may be attached to the
side of a building, or used double. A small lamb requires fifteen inches
of space, and a large sheep two feet, for quiet, comfortable feeding;
and at least this amount of room should be provided around the racks for
every sheep.


Troughs.

They may be variously constructed. The most economical are made with two
boards of any convenient length, ten to twelve inches wide. Nail the
lower side of one upon the edge of the other, fastening both into a two
or three inch plank, fifteen inches long and a foot wide, notched in
its upper edge in the form required.


Food.

There is no better food for sheep, than well-ripened, sound, timothy
hay; though the clovers, and nearly all the cultivated grasses, may be
advantageously fed. Bean and pea straw are valuable, and especially the
former, which, if properly cured, they prefer to the best hay; and it is
well adapted to the production of wool. All the other straws furnish a
good food, and sheep will thrive on them without hay, when fed with
roots or grain.

Roots ought to be given them occasionally for a change, and especially
to the ewes after lambing, if this occurs before putting them on to
fresh pasture. They keep the stomach properly distended, the appetite
and general health good; and they render their winter forage nearly
equal to their summer feed.

Much grain is not suited to store-sheep. It is too rich, and should be
given sparingly except to the lambs, the old ewes, or feeble sheep, or
to restore the rams after hard service. For the above purposes, oats are
the best; and if any other grain, beans or peas are given, it should be
in small quantities. When there is a deficiency of hay and roots, grain
may be used with straw.

The flock ought to be so fed as to receive the same amount of
nourishment throughout every part of the year. The evenness and value of
the fleece depends much upon this. When the amount of nutrition is
great, the wool-secreting organs are distended, and the fibre becomes
enlarged; when limited, they necessarily contract, and the fibre is
small. This produces a want of trueness, which the experienced stapler
readily detects, and which he does not fail to estimate against the
value of the fleece.

Sheep ought to have a full supply of salt, and if accessible, sulphur,
ashes, tar, and clay would frequently be nibbled by them when their
stomach required either. Pine or hemlock boughs are a good substitute
for tar, and afford a most healthful change in the winter-food of sheep.
Entire cleanliness and dryness are also essential to the health of the
flock. The smaller sizes of the Saxon may be well sustained on two
pounds of hay, but larger sheep will consume from three and a half to
four, or even five pounds per day. Sheep, like all other animals when
exposed to cold, will consume much more than if well protected, or than
during a warmer season.


The Care of the Ewes with Young

Is an important consideration, as the lamb is sometimes the only profit
yielded by the flock; for when fodder is high, or wool low, the fleece
will barely pay for the food and attention. Pregnant ewes require the
same food as at all other times; but caution is necessary to prevent
injury or abortion, which is often the result of excessive fat,
feebleness, or disease. The first may be remedied by blood-letting and
spare diet; and both the last by restored health and generous food.
Sudden fright, as from dogs or strange objects; long or severe journeys;
great exertions; unwholesome food; blows in the region of the f[oe]tus,
and some other causes, produce abortion.


Yeaning.

Most flocks are turned into the pasture before yeaning time, and the ewe
is then left to nature, which is a good practice, if she is healthy and
the weather good. But a larger number of lambs will be reared by a
careful oversight of the ewes, and the use of proper precautions. As
their time approaches, which may be known by the springing of the udder
and the enlargement of the natural parts, they should be put by
themselves at night, in a warm stable or with others in the same
condition, and well looked after, late and early in the day.

They seldom need any assistance, nor should any be rendered, except in
case of wrong presentation, or feebleness in expelling the f[oe]tus. In
the former case, the shepherd may apply his thumb and finger, after
oiling, to push back the young, and assist in gently turning it till the
nose and fore-feet appear and for the latter, only the slightest aid
should be rendered, and that to help the throes of the dam.


Management of Lambs.

When lambing in the field, only a few should be together, as the young
sometimes get changed, and the dams refuse to own them. This difficulty
is generally obviated, by holding the ewe till the lamb has sucked two
or three times; or they may be shut up together, and the lamb rubbed
with a little fine salt. The lamb does not require nourishment for some
hours after its birth; but if the dam refuse to lick it as soon as it
appears, it must be carefully wiped dry. If the weather be cold and the
lamb is dropped in the field, the shepherd should be furnished with
large pockets or a well-lined basket, in which it must be placed till
the ewe is brought to the shed.

After the first day or two, the udders ought to be completely drained of
their milk by the hand, so as to prevent swollen or caked bag. In case
of deficiency of milk, the lamb may be supplied from a new milch cow, by
means of a sucking-bottle with an air vent, or it may draw a part of its
nourishment from another ewe, which can be held while the lamb is
sucking.

It is sometimes necessary to substitute a foster-mother, in which case,
the ewe may be made to own the lamb, by milking from her udder over the
lamb and under his tail, rubbing it on well; or rub the adopted lamb
with the entrails and contents of the stomach of the dead lamb, or cover
it with the skin. If the ewe proves a bad nurse, or it is desirable to
bring the lambs forward rapidly, they may be early taught to eat boiled
oats or other grain, cabbage, roots, and tender hay. Lambs should be
well fed, as this is important to produce size, constitution, and
perfection of form.

The ewes and their young ought to be divided into small flocks, and have
a frequent change of pasture. Some careful shepherds adopt the plan of
confining their lambs, and allow them to suck two or three times a day;
by which they suffer no fatigue, and thrive much faster. But this is
troublesome and injurious, as the exercise is essential to the health
and constitution of the lamb intended for rearing. It is admissible only
when they are wanted for an early market, and by those who rear them for
this purpose, it is a common practice.


Castrating and Docking Lambs.

After selecting enough of the choicest rams for stock-getters, the
castrating may be performed at any time between two and six weeks old,
when the lamb is in good health. A cool day should be chosen; or if
warm, it must be done early in the morning. The best method is for one
person to hold the lamb firmly between his legs, on an inclined plank
upon which he rests, while another with a sharp knife cuts off about
two-thirds of the lower part of the scrotum. The testicles are then
drawn out till the spermatic cord is reached, which is divided by the
thumb nail; or it is pulled out and cut with a sharp knife. It is
sometimes done by simply opening the scrotum, when the testicles and
spermatic cord are jerked out. The wound should then be rinsed with cold
water, after which apply lard.

The operation of docking is by many deferred till a late period, from
apprehension of too much loss of blood; but if the weather be favorable,
and the lamb in good condition, it may be performed at this time with
the least trouble and without injury. The tail should be laid upon the
plank, the person holding him in the same position as before. With one
hand he draws the skin towards the body, while the other person, with a
two-inch chisel and mallet, strikes it off at a blow, between the bone
joints, leaving it one and a half to two inches long. The skin
immediately slips back over the wound and is soon healed. Ewe lambs
should be docked closer than the rams. To prevent flies and maggots, and
assist in healing, it is well to apply an ointment composed of lard and
tar, in the proportions of four pounds of the former to one quart of the
latter. This is also a good application for the scrotum. The lambs
should be carefully protected from cold and wet till they are perfectly
well.


Tagging, or Clatting,

Is the removal of such wool as is liable to get fouled, when the sheep
are turned on to the fresh pastures, and of course it should be done
just before leaving their winter quarters. It is most easily
accomplished by placing the animal on a low table, and then holding it
as in shearing, till the operation is performed. All the wool near the
extremity of the sheath, and the scrotum of the males; from the udder of
the ewes; and from below the dock, the inside of the thighs, and the
legs of the sheep, should be removed.


Summer Management.

As soon as the warm weather approaches, and the grass appears, sheep
become restive and impatient for the pasture. This instinct should be
repressed till the ground has become thoroughly dry, and the grass has
acquired substance. They ought, moreover, to be provided for the change
of food, by the daily use of roots for a few days before turning out. It
would also check the tendency to excessive purging, which is induced by
the first spring feed, if they were housed at night, and fed for the
first few days with a little sound, sweet hay. They must be provided
with pure water, salt, &c., as in winter, for though they may sometimes
do tolerably well without either, yet thrift and freedom from disease
are cheaply secured by this slight attention.

Dry, sweet pastures, and such as abound in aromatic and bitter plants,
are best suited for sheep-walks. No animal, with the exception of the
goat, crops so great a variety of plants. They eat many which are
rejected by the horse and the ox, and which are even essential to their
own wants. In this respect, they are valuable assistants to the
husbandman, as they feed greedily on wild mustard, burdocks, thistles,
marsh-mallows, milkweed, and various other offending plants; and the
Merino exceeds the more recent breeds in the variety of his selections.

Many prepare artificial pastures for their flocks. This may be done with
a number of plants. Winter rye, or wheat sown early in the season, may
be fed off in the fall, without injury to the crop; and in the following
spring, the rye may be pastured till the stalks shoot up and begin to
form a head. This affords an early and nutritious food. Corn may be sown
broadcast, or thickly in drills, and either fed off in the fields, or
cut and carried to the sheep in their folds. White mustard is a valuable
crop for this purpose.

To give sheep sufficient variety, it would be better to divide their
range into smaller ones, and change them as often at least as once a
week. They seek a favorite resting-place, on a dry, elevated part of the
field, which soon becomes soiled. By removing them from this for a few
days, rains will cleanse, or the sun dry it, so as again to make it
suitable for them. More sheep may be kept, and in better condition,
where this practice is adopted, than where they are confined to the same
pasture.


Washing Sheep.

In most of that portion of the Union north of 40 deg., the washing is
performed from the middle of May till the first of June, according to
the season and climate. When the streams are _hard_, which is frequently
the case in limestone regions, it is better to do this immediately after
an abundant rain, by which the lime derived from the springs is
proportionally lessened. The practice of a large majority of our
farmers, is to drive their sheep to the washing-ground early in the
morning on a warm day, leaving the lambs behind. The sheep are confined
on the bank of the stream by a temporary enclosure; from which they are
taken, and if not too heavy, are carried into water sufficiently deep to
prevent their touching bottom. They are then washed, by gently squeezing
the fleece with the hands, after which they are led ashore, and as much
of the water pressed out as possible before letting them go, as the
great weight retained in the wool frequently staggers and throws them
down.

A good practice is to lead the sheep into the water and saturate the
fleece, after which they are taken ashore. When they commence
_steaming_, they are again led into the water, and washed clean. This
insures thorough cleansing, where the water is pure. Others make use of
a boat, one end of which rests on a bold shore, and the other is in deep
water. The operator stands in the boat and plunges the animal over the
side, when the washing is performed. It is sometimes done by sinking a
tight hogshead or large box in the water, with heavy weights, in which a
man stands, and the sheep are brought or led to him by another person,
who walks on a platform reaching from the bank to the hogshead. Either
of the last methods obviates the necessity of standing for a long time
in water, by which colds, rheumatism, &c. are frequently contracted. In
parts of Germany, and sometimes in this country, sheep are forced to
swim across a narrow stream several times, by which the fleece is
tolerably cleaned, if all the water be pressed out when they get to the
land. The yolk being a saponaceous compound, and not an oily matter as
is generally supposed, it readily combines with the water and passes out
of the wool.

An excellent practice, when streams are not convenient, is to lead a
small ripple of soft water into a tub. To this, a little soap is added,
after which the sheep are immersed and thoroughly cleansed. Perfect
whiteness and purity of the fleece is readily secured afterwards, by
throwing over the sheep a jet of water. This practice has a good effect,
in preventing or removing cutaneous disorders, and destroying ticks or
other vermin.

Many judicious farmers object to washing sheep, from its tendency to
produce colds and catarrhal affections, to which sheep are particularly
subject; but it cannot well be dispensed with, as the wool is always
more saleable, and if carefully done, need not be attended with injury.
Warm settled weather, however, is indispensable to washing with safety
to the general health of the sheep.

Fig. 26 shows a ewe, with lines indicating the usual method of sorting
wool; number 1 indicating the refina or picklock; 2 and 3, the second
and third qualities.

[Illustration: Fig. 26.

Wool Sorting]


Shearing.

The manner of shearing varies with almost every district; but as this is
an art to be acquired under a skilful master, we shall omit particular
details on the subject. First clip all the tags and filth, if any
remains or has been accumulated after the tagging in the spring; then
take off the fleece and spread it with the outside uppermost on a smooth
bench or table, and push the wool carefully together, to render it more
compact; double the sides over to the centre; throw the clean loose
locks into the middle, and roll together from each end. This makes a
smooth, dense package, which is secured by passing a stout twine one or
more times around the sides and ends. All the wool from the extremities,
should be closely sheared and saved by itself, before dismissing the
sheep, but not put up with choice fleeces.

_If wounds are made_, which is sometimes the case with unskilful
operators, a mixture of tar and grease ought to be applied. After
shearing, such horns and hoofs as are likely to be troublesome, should
be sawed and pared.

The _branding_, or _marking_, is essential to distinguish them from
other flocks, and this is done on the shoulder, side, or buttock. A
brush or marking-iron is used for this purpose, with paint made of
lampblack, to which a little spirits of turpentine is first added, and
then diluted with linseed or lard oil.

If the weather be cool, and especially, if severe storms occur after
washing or shearing, the flock should be housed. If sultry, they should
have a cool, shady retreat, where they will be shielded from the flies
and the heat. Blisters and permanent injury to the skin and fleece, are
frequently the result of such exposure. Shade trees in their pastures,
contribute much to the comfort of sheep, when exposed to a blazing sun.
A close examination of the skin should be made at shearing, for the
detection of disease or vermin.

For remedies, see article _diseases_.


Smearing or Salving Sheep

Is a custom little practised in this country. For cold, elevated, and
bleak exposures, it may be necessary, and it is, therefore, generally
adopted in Scotland. The object is, to prevent cutaneous diseases and
vermin, and furnish additional warmth and protection to the fleeces of
such breeds as are deficient in yolk. It is usually performed in the
latter part of October, but is sometimes done immediately after
shearing.

The mixture or salve consists of tar and butter or grease, in different
proportions; 1 gallon of the former to 12, or sometimes 20 lbs. of the
latter; the greater proportion of tar being required for the younger
sheep, or for more exposed situations. The grease is melted over the
fire, and the tar stirred in, and when sufficiently cool, it is applied
to the whole body of the sheep, by carefully parting the wool and
rubbing it on the skin with the fingers. The above quantity is
sufficient for 30 or 50 sheep, according to their size and the character
of the wool.

This application is not required for fine-woolled sheep, whose fleeces
are more appropriately protected by a natural secretion of yolk; and it
is better to omit it in all cases, where the health and comfort of the
animal do not render it absolutely essential. Mr. Stewart, an
experienced Scotch shepherd, uses only tallow and train oil, mixed in
equal proportions. He asserts, that the improvement in the growth and
quality of the wool is at least one-third, and it materially benefits
the condition of the sheep.


Weaning.

The lambs may be weaned from 31/2 to 4 months old. They should be put upon
rich, sweet feed, but not too luxuriant; while the dams are turned upon
the poorest, and so remote from their young, as to be out of sight and
hearing. The ewes ought to be carefully examined after a day or two, and
if necessary, the milk removed with the hand. If it continues to
accumulate, the ewe may be fed on hay for a few days.

When thoroughly dried off, they should have the best fare, to enable
them to recover condition for subsequent breeding and wintering. The
fall is a critical period to lose flesh, either for sheep or lambs; and
if any are found deficient, they should be at once provided with extra
feed and attention. If cold weather overtakes them poor or in
ill-health, they will scarcely outlive it; or if by chance they survive,
their emaciated carcass, impaired constitution, and scant fleece, will
ill repay the food and attention they will have cost.


The time for taking Sheep from the Pastures.

This must depend on the state of the weather and food. Severe frosts
destroy much of the nutriment in the grasses, and they soon after cease
to afford adequate nourishment. Long exposure to cold storms, with such
food to sustain them, will rapidly reduce their condition. The only safe
rule is to transfer them to their winter-quarters the first day they
cease to thrive abroad.


Drafting the Flock,

For the purpose of ridding it of the supernumeraries, should be done at
an earlier day. Such of the wethers as have attained their prime, and
those ewes that have passed it, ought to be withdrawn soon after
shearing, provided with the best feed, and rapidly fitted for the
shambles. If they have been properly pushed on grass, they will be in
good flesh by the time they are taken from it; and if not intended for
stall-feeding, the sooner they are then disposed of the better.


Stall-Feeding.

This will be lost on an ill-shaped, unthrifty beast. The perfection of
form and health, and the uniform good condition, which characterize the
thrifty one, indicate too plainly to be misunderstood, those which will
best repay the care of their owner. The selection of any indifferent
animal for stall-fattening, whether cattle or sheep, will inevitably be
attended with loss. Such ought to be got rid of when first brought from
the pasture, for the most they will bring.


Management of Sheep for the Prairies.

When destined for the prairies, sheep ought to commence their journey as
early after shearing as possible. They are then disencumbered of their
fleece, and do not catch and retain as much dust, as when driven later.
Feed is also generally better, and the roads are dry and hard. Young and
healthy sheep should be selected, with early lambs; or if the latter are
too young, and the distance great, they should be left and the ewes
dried off. A large wagon ought to accompany the flock, to carry such as
occasionally give out; or they may be disposed of whenever they become
enfeebled. With good care, a hardy flock may be driven at the rate of 12
or 14 miles a day. Constant watchfulness is requisite, to keep them
healthy and in good plight. One-half the expense of driving, may be
saved by the use of well-trained shepherd-dogs.

When arrived at their destination, they must be thoroughly washed, to
free them from all dirt, and closely examined as to any diseases they
may have contracted, which, if discovered, should be promptly removed. A
variety of suitable food and good shelter must be provided, for the
autumn, winter, and spring ensuing, and every necessary attention given
them. This would be necessary if indigenous to the country; how much
more so, when they have just undergone a campaign, to which neither they
nor their race have been accustomed!

Sheep cannot be kept on the prairies without much care, artificial food,
and proper attention; and from a false system of economy, hitherto
attempted by many, losses have occurred from disease and mortality in
the flocks, sufficient to have made ample provision for the comfort and
security of twice the number lost. More especially do they require
proper food and attention, after the first severe frosts set in, which
wither and kill the natural grasses. By nibbling at the _fog_, (the
frostbitten, dead grass,) they are inevitably subject to constipation,
which a bountiful supply of roots, sulphur, &c., is alone sufficient to
remove.

Roots, grain, and good hay; straw, or corn-stalks, pea or bean vines,
are essential to the preservation of their health and thrift during the
winter, everywhere north of 39 deg.. In summer, the natural herbage is
sufficient to sustain them in fine condition, till they shall have
acquired a denser population of animals, when it will be found necessary
to stock their meadows with the best varieties of artificial grasses.

The prairies seem adapted to the usual varieties of sheep introduced
into the United States; and of such are the flocks made up, according to
the taste or judgment of the owners. Shepherd-dogs are invaluable to the
owners of flocks, in those unfenced, illimitable ranges, both as a
defence against the small prairie-wolf, which prowls around the sheep,
but which are rapidly thinning off by the settlers; and also as
assistants to the shepherds in driving and herding their flocks on the
open ground.


DISEASES OF SHEEP.

The dry and healthful climate, the rolling surface, and the sweet and
varied herbage, which generally prevail in the United States, insure
perfect health to an originally sound and well-selected flock, unless
peculiarly exposed to disease. No country is better suited to sheep,
than most of the northern and some of the southern parts of our own. In
Europe, and especially in England, where the system of management is
necessarily in the highest degree artificial, consisting frequently in
early and continued forcing the system, folding on wet, plowed grounds,
and the excessive use of that watery food, the Swedes turnip, there are
numerous and fatal diseases. Hence the long list which lumbers the pages
of foreign writers on sheep.

The most destructive of these are the rot, and epidemics which are
scarcely known in America, except by report. The diseases incident to
our flocks may generally be considered as casualties, rather than as
inbred, or necessarily arising from the quality of food, or from local
causes. It may be safely asserted, that with a dry pasture, well stocked
with varied and nutritious grasses; a clear, running stream; sufficient
shade and protection against severe storms; a constant supply of salt,
tar, and sulphur in summer; good hay, and sometimes roots, with ample
shelters in winter; young sheep, originally sound and healthy, will
seldom or never get diseased on American soil.

The few diseases which it may be necessary here to mention, will be
treated in the simplest manner. Remedies of general application, to be
administered often by the unskilful and ignorant, must neither be
elaborate nor complicated; and, if expensive, the lives of most sheep
would be dearly purchased by their application.

A sheep which the owner has reared or purchased at the ordinary price,
is the only domestic animal which can die without material loss to its
owner. The wool and pelt will, in most instances, repay its cost, while
the carcasses of other animals will be worthless except for manure. The
loss of sheep from occasional disease, will leave the farmer's pocket in
a very different condition from the loss of an equal value in horses or
cattle. Yet humanity, equally with interest, dictates the use of such
simple remedies for the removal of suffering and disease, as may be
within reach.


Diarrh[oe]a or Scours,

When light and not long continued, calls for no remedy. It is a
healthful provision of nature for the more rapid expulsion of some
offending matter in the system, which, if retained, might lead to
disease. It is generally owing to improper food, as bad hay or noxious
weeds; to a sudden change, as from dry food to fresh grass; or to an
excess, as from overloading the stomach; and sometimes, from cold and
wet.

The _remedies_ are obvious.

Change to suitable food in the first two cases; enforce abstinence after
repletion; and provide warm, dry shelter, with light diet, if owing to
the latter causes.

When severe or long continued, a dose of castor oil may be given, and
after its operation, give four grains of opium and one ounce chalk, and
put them on dry food. Wheat-bran or shorts, and oat-meal or flaxseed
ground, are both good for ailing lambs and sheep; as are also ripe oats
or wheat, fed in the sheaf, with well cured, sweet hay, and plenty of
salt. Fresh boughs of the juniper, or pine and hemlock, help to check
the disorder.

_Looseness in the larger lambs_ is prevented by having chalk within
their reach; or if they refuse it, administer it in their food. When it
happens soon after birth, place it with the ewe in a warm place, and
feed the latter with plenty of oats, or other sound grain. If the milk
be deficient, give the lamb cow's milk scalded, or let it suck the cow.
The tail is sometimes glued on to the buttocks, while the scours
continue. Separate it immediately by the use of warm water, and rub the
parts with dry loam or clay.


Dysentery.

This is a different and frequently a fatal disease, but resembles the
former in its general symptoms. It is owing to prolonged diarrh[oe]a,
unwholesome or meager food, and other causes. Bleeding and physic should
be resorted to, after which give warm, nourishing gruel.


Hoven.

_For description and remedies, see hoven in cattle._


Braxy.

This is manifested by uneasiness, loathing of food, frequent drinking,
carrying the head down, drawing the back up, swollen belly, feverish
symptoms, and avoidance of the flock. It appears mostly in late autumn
and spring, and may be induced by exposure to severe storms, plunging in
water when hot, and especially by constipation brought on by feeding on
frostbitten, putrid, or indigestible herbage.

_Remedies_ are not often successful, unless promptly applied. Bleed
freely, and to effect this, in consequence of the stagnant state of the
blood, immersion in a tub of hot water may be necessary. Then give two
ounces Epsom salts, dissolved in warm water, with a handful of common
salt.

If this is unsuccessful, give a clyster made with a pipe-full of
tobacco, boiled for a few minutes in a pint of water. Administer half,
and if this is not effectual, follow with the remainder. Then bed the
animal in dry straw and cover with blankets, and assist the purgatives
with warm gruels, followed by laxative provender till
well.--(_Blacklock._) Thousands of sheep have died on the prairies from
braxy, induced by exposure and miserable forage. Entire prevention is
secured by warm, dry shelters, and nutritious, digestible food.


Costiveness.

This is removed by giving two tablespoonfuls of castor oil every twelve
hours, till the difficulty is removed; or give one ounce Epsom salts.
This may be assisted by an injection of warm, weak suds and molasses.


Stretches.

Sheep sometimes stretch out their noses on the ground, and around their
sides, as if in severe pain. This may be caused by an involution of one
part of the intestine within another. When owing to this cause, the
difficulty is frequently removed by jerking the animal by the hind-legs
several times, when the pain disappears.

But it is generally occasioned by _costiveness_, which see above. This
may be prevented by using green food, roots, &c., once a week, or by
allowing them to browse on the evergreens, pines, hemlock, and firs.


Poison,

From laurel and other plants, is cured by pouring a gill of melted lard
down the throat, or boil for an hour the twigs of the white ash, and
give half to one gill of the strong liquor immediately; to be repeated
if not successful.


Inflammation of the Lungs.

This is produced by improper exposure to cold and wet. The remedy for
slight affections, is warm, dry shelter, and light food. When severe,
resort must be had to bleeding and purging freely, then to light bran or
linseed mashes.


Rot.

This sometimes causes the death of a million of sheep in a single year
in England, yet it is a disease almost unknown in this country. Foreign
authorities ascribe it entirely to excessive humidity of climate, wet
pastures, or too watery food.

The preventives are therefore obvious. After the use of dry food and dry
bedding, one of the best is the abundant use of pure salt. In violent
attacks, early bleeding, followed by a dose of two ounces Epsom salts,
to be repeated if necessary, with a change of diet and location, is all
that can be done.


Foot-Rot.

This is frequently a prevalent disease among American sheep. It is
sometimes spontaneous, but more often produced by contagion. In the
former case, it is caused by soft, rich, or moist pastures. A dry
gravelly or rocky range, will of course be an effectual preventive when
owing to this cause.

The disorder is communicated by the absorbents of the foot coming in
contact with the suppuration which has been left on the ground from the
diseased part. Absolute safety against this contagion is secured only by
a total avoidance of the walks of the infected animals, till repeated
rains, or what is better, frosts, have disarmed the virus of its
malignity.

_Remedies_ are variously compounded, of blue vitriol, verdigris, tar,
spirits of turpentine, alum, saltpetre, salt, lime, copperas,
white-lead, antimony, alcohol, urine, vinegar, &c., all of which have
proved effectual.

The hoof should first be pared and thoroughly scraped. Then apply a wash
made of three parts of blue vitriol, one of verdigris pulverized finely,
with scalding (not boiling) vinegar; stirring briskly till it is of the
consistence of thin cream, and put it upon the affected part with a
paint brush. It is a good preventive, to apply this to the sound feet of
the affected animal.

Another remedy is to use spirits of turpentine after scraping; and if
the disease is of long standing, add to the turpentine a strong
decoction of blue vitriol dissolved in water. The foot should be
examined every week, and the remedy repeated till perfect soundness is
restored.

A feather dipped in muriatic or nitric acid, and applied to the parts
after scraping and cleansing, is a good remedy. When put upon the soles
of _foot-sore_ sheep, it hardens the hoofs, and enables them to travel
better.

Sheep are sometimes cured by keeping them on a dry surface, and driving
over a barn-floor daily, which is well covered with quicklime. It may
also be cured by dryness, and repeated washing with soap-suds.

The above ailment should not be confounded with a temporary soreness, or
inflammation of the hoof, occasioned by the irritation from the long,
rough grasses which abound in low situations, which is removed with the
cause; or if it continues, apply white paint or tar, after thorough
washing.


Corrosion of the Flesh by Flies or Maggots,

May be cured by first removing the vermin; then wash with Castile soap
and warm soft water, after which apply white-lead with linseed oil. Tar
put on the festering wound corrodes it; but this, or spirits of
turpentine placed on the sound parts near it, keep off the flies by
their strong effluvia.

If the wound be slight, and the weather moderate, apply a little spirits
of turpentine with a strong decoction of elder bark.


Flies on Sheep

May be prevented by smearing with a composition made of two pounds lard
or soft grease, one pound sulphur, half pint oil of amber, or oil of
tar, or tar alone. A small spoonful is sufficient for a sheep.--_Genesee
Farmer._


Protection from the Gad-Fly.

In July, August, and September, in the Northern states, the _gad-fly_
(_[OE]stus ovis_) attacks the nostrils of the sheep, and there deposites
its eggs, which, on being hatched, immediately crawl up and make a
lodgment in the head. They are frequently repelled by laying a thick
coat of tar on the bottom of the troughs, and sprinkling it with salt.
The smell of the tar adhering to the nose will drive off the fly. A more
effectual remedy is to apply it thoroughly with a brush to the external
part of the nose.

If a few furrows of loose earth are turned up in their pastures, the
sheep will hold their noses to them, and thus keep off the fly.

The symptoms of grubs in the head, are drooping of the head and ears,
discharge of bloody and watery matter from the nostrils, and loss of
strength in the limbs.

If worms have made a lodgment, take half a pound of good Scotch snuff,
and two quarts boiling water: stir, and let it stand till cold. Inject
about a tablespoonful of this liquid and sediment up each nostril, with
a syringe. Repeat this three or four times at intervals, from the middle
of October till January: the grubs are then small, and will not have
injured the sheep. The efficacy of the snuff will be increased, by
adding half an ounce assaf[oe]tida, pounded in a little water. The
effect on the sheep is immediate prostration and apparent death, but
they will soon recover. A decoction of tobacco will afford a substitute
for snuff.--_N. Eng. Far._

Blacklock's remedy is, to half fill the bowl of a pipe with tobacco,
light it, and then hold the sheep, while a person inserts the stem some
distance into the nostril, and blows a few whiffs into the nose. The
operation is then repeated with the other nostril.


Swollen Mouth

Is sometimes fatal. It is said to be cured by daubing the lips and mouth
plentifully with tar.--_Albany Cultivator._


Foul Noses.

Dip a small swab into tar, then roll in salt. Put some on the nose, and
compel the sheep to swallow a small quantity.--_American Far._

A disease indicated by drooping, running at the eyes, weakness in the
back and loins, inability to use the hind legs, was removed by turning
the sheep into a pasture containing lobelia, (_Indian tobacco._) Dried
lobelia was also given, and produced the same effect.--_Cultivator._


Scab.

This loathsome disease, to which fine-woolled sheep are particularly
liable, is caused, like itch in the human subject, by a small insect, a
species of the _acari_. It is first manifest by the rubbing of the
sheep, and soon after by one or more tufts of wool, which is loosened at
the roots. On feeling the skin, a hard, dry tumor is perceptible. To
prevent contagion, remove the infected sheep to a separate pasture or
yard as soon as discovered.

_Remedies._--The Spanish shepherds dissolve a little salt in their
mouth, and drop it upon the infected part.

When the tumor has become enlarged, the wool should be removed closely
to the skin, the scab scraped with a curry-comb, then wash with strong
soap-suds or ley, and afterwards rub thoroughly with sulphur or
brimstone, mixed with lard or grease.

An effectual remedy is prepared by taking one pound of tobacco, which
add to 12 quarts ley from wood ashes of sufficient strength for washing,
and four quarts urine; to this add another mixture of a gill high-wines;
1/4 oz. camphor; 1/4 oz. Spanish brown, and 1/2 gill spirits of turpentine. A
small quantity of this applied to the sore will never fail.

Immediately after shearing, scab may readily be cured by immersing the
sheep, (excepting the head,) in a strong decoction of tobacco liquor,
adding a gill of spirits of turpentine for the first, and making a
slight addition of fresh liquid for each sheep, enough to keep up the
strength of the tobacco and turpentine, and taking care to rub the
affected part thoroughly. For lambs, this liquor should be diluted, but
yet left strong enough to kill ticks in one or two minutes, which may be
ascertained by experiment.

Scab is also removed by using a composition of one pound plug tobacco to
three gallons of water, with lime-water and oil of vitriol added; or a
decoction of hellebore with vinegar, sulphur, and spirits of
turpentine.--(_H. D. Grove._)

Scab is propagated more by using the same rubbing posts, than by contact
with each other. Sheep in low condition are more subject to it than
others.


Ticks and Lice

Sometimes infest sheep. Good feeding and shelter is a partial
preventive, but when they have made their lodgment, they must be dipped
in a decoction of tobacco water. The most effectual time for their
destruction, is a few days after shearing, when they will have left the
naked bodies of the old ewes, to hide in the fleeces of the lambs. The
dipping in tobacco water, with the addition of a small quantity of
turpentine, is an effectual remedy.

After dipping the sheep or lambs, the liquor should be pressed out from
the wool, upon an inclined plane, so arranged as again to run into the
vessel.


Pelt-rot

Will be recognised as one of the staple diseases of our _native sheep_,
described on page 89. The wool in this case falls off, leaving the sheep
partially or almost wholly naked; but this is not accompanied with
soreness or apparent disease. The animal must be provided with a warm
stall and generous feed, and the naked skin should be anointed with tar
and grease. The preventive is good keeping and shelter.


Staggers or Sturdy, and Water in the Head,

Sometimes affect sheep, but more especially lambs under a year old. The
first is caused by the _hydatid_. It is considered as an almost
incurable disorder, but is sometimes removed by trepanning.

Chancellor Livingston carefully supplied two thus attacked, with food
for three months, when nature effected a cure. Removal to dry lands and
purging, is a good precaution when they are first taken.

An English lad lately cured one which had been given up, by boring with
a gimlet into the soft place on the head, when the water rushed out, and
the sheep immediately followed the others to the pasture. A
correspondent of the Albany Cultivator asserts, that 1/2 a pint of melted
lard poured down the throat, will cure blind staggers in ten minutes.


Abortion

Occurs sometimes, and is usually caused by excessive fright or exertion,
and sometimes by severe exposure and poor feed. It is seldom fatal,
except to the lamb.


The Uterus

Is occasionally protruded after lambing. It should be immediately
returned, first washing it in warm milk and water, if any dirt adheres
to it. For this, the hand only should be used. After rubbing it with
lard or oil, hold up the hind legs, and gently replace the protruded
parts, then keep the ewe quiet till fully recovered.


For Garget, or Caked Bag.

Keep the bag thoroughly drained of milk, for which purpose the lamb is
the most efficient. If it is lost, another may be temporarily
substituted. Purge freely with Epsom salts, and wash the udder
repeatedly with very warm water. If matter forms, it should be opened
with the lancet.


Bleeding.

"Nothing tends so much to the recovery of an animal from a disease in
which bleeding is required, as the rapid flow of the blood from a large
orifice. Little _impression_ can be made on an acute disease by the slow
removal of even a large quantity of blood, as the organs have time to
accommodate themselves to the loss, which might, for any good it will
do, as well be dispensed with. Either bleed rapidly, or not at all. The
nearer the commencement of an ailment, in which you employ bleeding,
the operation is resorted to, the greater the chance of its doing good.

Bleeding by nicking the under surface of the tail, does very well, where
no great deal of blood is required, but it is not to be thought of if
the veins of the face or neck can possibly be opened. These are to be
taken in preference to a vein on the leg, as they are much more readily
got at. The facial vein commences by small branches on the side of the
face, and runs downwards and backwards to the base of the jaw, where it
may be felt within two inches of the angle, or opposite the middle
grinding tooth. It is here that the orifice must be made: the thumb of
the left hand being held against the vein, so as to prevent the flow of
blood towards the heart, will make it _rise_.

Some prefer opening the jugular vein, which commences behind the eye and
runs down the side of the neck. This vessel is, however, more difficult
to open than the former, being better covered with wool, and not so
easily exposed or made to swell. _Stringing_ is the mode commonly
resorted to for this end; that is to say, a cord is drawn tightly round
the neck close to the shoulder, so as to stop the circulation through
the vein, and render it perceptible to the finger.

A lancet is the instrument generally used in bleeding, though a
well-pointed penknife will do at a pinch. The opening must always be
made obliquely; but before attempting this, the animal must be secured,
by placing it between the operator's legs, with its croup against a
wall. The selected vein is then fixed by the fingers of the operator's
left hand, so as to prevent its rolling or slipping before the lancet.
Having fairly entered the vein, the point of the instrument must be
elevated at the same time that it is pushed a little forward, by which
motion it will be lifted from or cut its way out of the vein.

_A prescribed quantity of blood should never be drawn_, for the simple
reason that this can never be precisely stated. If the symptoms are
urgent, as in all likelihood they will be, your best plan is not to stop
the flow of blood till the animal fall or is about to fall. When this
occurs, run a pin through the edges of the orifice, and finish by
twisting round it a lock of wool."--(_Blacklock._)


Large cuts are healed

By first sewing and then covering with salve. Smaller ones may be
secured with an adhesive plaster or bandage.


To protect lambs from wolves and foxes,

Smear the neck plentifully with a mixture of tar and sulphur. Bells are
also said to guard the flock, as both are excessively wary, and have a
great dislike to any thing artificial. Large dogs will keep them at bay.
A better remedy is to kill the marauders, which may be done by inserting
strychnine in fresh meat and leaving it in their haunts.




CHAPTER V.

THE HORSE.


In nearly all ages and countries, the horse has been the devoted
servant, and the object of the pride and affection of man. Among the
semi-civilized Tartars of Middle and Northern Asia; the aborigines of
our remote Western prairies, reaching even beyond the Rocky Mountains,
and many other rude nations, his flesh is used for food. Most of the
tribes among the former use the milk for domestic purposes, and
especially when fermented and changed to an unpleasantly sour and
intoxicating beverage. But throughout the civilized world, with some
slight exceptions, the horse is useful only for his labor. For this
purpose he is pre-eminently fitted by his compact, closely-knit frame;
his sinewy, muscular limbs; his easy, rapid stride; his general form,
and entire structure and habits.

He is found in his wild condition in Central Asia, Siberia, and the
interior of Africa; and for 300 years he has been turned loose to follow
his native instincts on the illimitable pampas of South America, and the
wide-spread prairies of Mexico and California. In all these regions he
closely resembles the medium varieties of the domesticated horse; but as
the natural result of his freedom, he possesses more fire and spirit
than any other, except the blood-horse.

Arabia is generally claimed as the original native locality of the
horse, and as the only source from which he is to be derived in the
requisite perfection for the highest improvement of the race. But
Strabo, who wrote more than 1,800 years ago, asserts that the horse did
not then flourish in Arabia, and it was not till some centuries later
that he attained any decided superiority there. Great attention,
however, has been paid in that country, since the era of Mahomet, to
breeding a light, agile, and enduring frame; intelligence and
tractability of character; and the perpetuation of these qualities by
the most scrupulous regard for the purity of blood.

This is equally true of the Barb or pure-bred horse of Morocco, and
those of the northern coast of Africa, in Egypt, among the Turks, and
indeed wherever the followers of the Prophet are to be found. It is
unquestionable, that the influence of the Eastern blood among the
choicest animals of modern Europe, has been followed by great
improvements in racing stock. Yet it is equally certain, that the
race-horse, both of England and the United States, has accomplished what
has never been demonstrated as within the ability of their progenitors;
and on repeated trials with the Eastern horses, he has shown himself
confessedly their superior in speed, strength, and endurance.

In 1825, two English horses ran against the two fleetest Cossacks which
could be found throughout the entire region of their best blood, and in
a continued race of 47 miles, the European took the stakes; Sharper, the
most successful, performing the distance in 2 hours and 48 minutes.
About the same time, Recruit, an English horse of moderate reputation,
easily beat Pyramus, the best Arabian on the Bengal side of India.

The Leeds, the Darley, and the Godolphin Arabian; the Lister and
D'Arcey's White Turk, and other noted Eastern horses, would not compare
in performance with many of their descendants. But these, with some
other choice Arabians, on the best mares, and with every advantage for
obtaining celebrity, have succeeded in establishing a fame as just as it
has been enduring. Yet it must at the same time be remembered, that of
the innumerable other pure-bred horses which have been tried in Europe,
a few only have rescued their names from oblivion.

The experience of Eastern blood in this country, in comparison with the
best English, is decidedly in favor of the latter. We have had one horse
of unsurpassed excellence, which a fortunate accident threw upon our
shores a short time previous to 1770. This was the white Barb _Ranger_,
which was presented by the Emperor of Morocco, as the choice of his
stud, to an English naval officer for some distinguished service. On his
route homeward, the animal was set on shore for exercise at an
intermediate port, where in his gambols he broke three of his legs, and
thinking him worthless, his owner gave him to the commander of a New
England merchantman, then present. He was readily accepted, and placed
in slings on board of his vessel, and recovered.

This animal stood for many years, in the eastern part of Connecticut;
and on their good mares, produced a numerous progeny of unrivalled
cavalry horses, which rendered invaluable services in the troop
commanded by that consummate partisan, Captain (afterwards General) Lee,
of the Revolution. It is said the favorite white field-horse of General
Washington was of the same stock. He was afterwards sold to Captain
Lindsey, as a special favor, and taken, to Virginia, where he produced
some good racers.

Bussorah, a small sorrel horse, brought into this country in 1819, from
the head of the Persian Gulf, got many choice roadsters, though no
racers of celebrity.

The Narraganset pacers, a race belonging to our Northern states, but for
many years almost extinct, possessed for a long time an unrivalled
reputation for spirit, endurance, and easy rapid motion under the
saddle. They are said to have originated from a Spanish horse, many of
which are pure descendants of the Barb.

As an offset to these isolated examples of success in this country, we
have numerous instances of the importation of the best Orientals, which
have been extensively used on some of our superior mares, without any
marked effect. We shall refer to three prominent importations only.

The first consisted of two choice Arabians, or Barbs, selected in Tunis
by General Eaton, and sent to his estate in Massachusetts. The second
was a present of four choice Barbs, from the Emperor of Morocco to our
government, in 1830; and the third consisted of two Arabians, sent by
the Imaum of Muscat, near the Persian Gulf, to our government in 1840.
These were all claimed to be, and no doubt were, of the pure Kochlani,
the unadulterated line royal; yet none have earned any distinguished
reputation, either by their own performances or those of their
descendants.

It is to England we are mainly indebted for the great improvement in our
blood, road, and farm horses. A numerous race of fine horses was reared
on that island, long previous to its authentic history; for, in his
first invasion Julius Caesar took many of them to Rome, where they
immediately became great favorites, although she had already plundered
every region of some of their best breeds.

What might have been the particular merit of the English horse at the
time of the Norman invasion, is not known, but it is certain that the
Saxon cavalry under Harold were speedily overpowered by William, at the
battle of Hastings, which at once secured the throne to the Conqueror.
History first informs us of the improvement of British horses, by
importations from abroad during this reign, which consisted of a number
of Spanish stallions. These were supposed to be strongly imbued with the
Arabian blood, which had been brought over to that country by the Moors,
who had founded the Saracenic empire in the Peninsula, three centuries
before. More than a century later, John made some importations from
Flanders, to give weight and substance to their draught and cavalry
horses. The improvement of their various breeds was afterwards pursued,
with more or less judgment and zeal, by other British monarchs, till
they reached their highest excellence during the middle of the last
century.

Flying Childers, Eclipse, Highflyer, and others on the course, have
probably exceeded in speed anything ever before accomplished; while the
draught-horse, the roadster, the hackney, the cavalry-horse, and the
hunter, attained a merit at that time which some judicious authorities
claim has not been since increased. It is even asserted, that some of
the more serviceable breeds have been seriously injured by too great an
infusion of the blood; while the almost universal absence of long heats
on the turf has tended to the improvement of speed rather than bottom in
the race-horse.

The improvement of the horse in this country has not been a matter of
record or history, till within a comparatively recent period. But it has
silently, and with no little rapidity, been going forward for more than
a century, till we have obtained a race of animals, throughout the
Eastern and Middle states at least, which probably equal those of any
other country for adaptedness to draught, the road, and the saddle. This
improvement has been mainly brought about by the importation of some of
the _best and stoutest of the English blood_. In breeding from these for
purposes of utility, particular reference has been paid to strength,
enduringness, and speed. No horses surpass our best four-mile bloods;
none equal our trotters; and though much inequality exists in those bred
for various other uses, yet for profitable service, it is believed, no
equal number of animals elsewhere can exceed those in the region above
indicated.

It would be a superfluous task to attempt enumerating all the imported
horses that have contributed to this improvement. Each good animal has
done something. But among the earlier horses which may be named with
distinction, as having effected much for our useful beasts, are Lath,
Wildair, Slender, Sourkrout, Tallyho, Figure, Bay Richmond, Expedition,
Baronet, and a host of others.

Pre-eminent among these, was imported Messenger. He was foaled in 1780,
imported in 1788, and died in 1808. He stood in different places in New
Jersey, and in Dutchess, Westchester, and Queens counties in New York;
and upon the mares derived from the foregoing and other good horses, he
got a numerous progeny of illustrious descendants. Of these we may name
those capital stallions, Potomac, Hamlintonian, Bay Figure, Engineer,
Mambrino, Tippoo Saib, Columbus, Gunn's, and Bushe's Messenger, and many
others, which were extensively disseminated over the Northern and Middle
states; and he has the credit of imparting a large share of his merits
to that nonpareil of horses, his grandson, American Eclipse. His
posterity were so numerous and widely spread, that it may be safely
asserted, that of the best horses bred in the above states, scarcely one
can now be found which does not trace one or more crosses to this
distinguished sire. His success in producing roadsters, besides his
blood qualities of speed and endurance, consisted in his great strength,
and the peculiar formation of his limbs, large forehand and deep
quarters, in which he excelled any other of the imported bloods.

As an illustration of what may be accomplished by judicious breeding
with the present materials in our hands, we mention one family of the
American roadster, which is strongly tinctured with blood, and which has
attained an enviable notoriety among the choicest of the Northern
horses. They are derived from the _Morgan horse_ of Vermont, that was
foaled in Springfield, Mass., in 1793. He was got by True Britton,
supposed to have been bred by Gen. Delancey of New York, and got by
imported Wildair, (or one of his sons,) a horse of such distinguished
excellence, as to have been re-exported to England, for the benefit of
his stock.

The Morgan horse stood in Vermont from 1795 till his death, at an
advanced age. From him and the choice mares of Vermont, descended many
excellent colts; and his merits were inherited in an eminent degree by
three of his sons, which stood in the same state and continued the
career of improvement commenced by the sire. The result has been the
production of a family of roadsters, of much similarity of
appearance[3] and uniformity of character, unsurpassed by any others
for serviceable qualities.

[3] Many of the Morgan horses have the steep rump and heavy breast and
neck, which indicate a Norman cross on the side of their dams. These
have been largely imparted through the French horse in the adjoining
Canadian settlements, but none of these are said to have characterized
the founder of the race.

They are of medium size, from 131/2 to 15 hands high; with a well-formed
head and neck; high withers; deep chest; round body; short back; long
quarters; broad flat legs; moderately small feet; long wavy mane and
tail; presenting altogether the beau ideal of the road horse. They are
spirited, docile, hardy, and easily kept. They have an easy, rapid trot,
and glide along with a good load, without clatter or apparent effort, at
the rate of ten or twelve miles an hour.

This family of horses has not of course been bred long enough within
themselves, to have attained to the eminence of a distinct breed. They
are mentioned, merely as a type of what the serviceable roadster ought
to be, and what he may become by the use of the proper instruments for
breeding. And if the materials already in our hands are intelligently
and perseveringly used, we can produce all we require of horse-flesh.

Besides our unsurpassed blood-horses, we have others derived from
various sources, and especially from the different English breeds, all
of which are variously compounded, with the first and with each other.
On our northeastern frontier, the _Canadian_ prevails, a bastard but not
degenerate race, made up of the French Norman and the English or
American. At the extreme South and West, we have the _horse of Spanish
origin_, obtained in his domestic state in Florida and Louisiana; and
from another branch of the Spanish, are descended the wild horses of
Mexico and the more northern prairies. These are diversified in
character, and generally possess medium size and merit.

The _Conestoga_, a heavy roadster, is principally reared in
Pennsylvania, and is used for the team and truck. He is an amalgamation
of several breeds, but probably owes a share of his character to the
Flemish horse, for which there was a decided partiality among the
numerous German emigrants of that state.

Several varieties of _ponies_ are to be found in different sections, but
principally among the French, the half-breed, and the Indians upon the
frontiers, who have bred a stunted race from the Canadian or wild-horse,
and such others as could survive the hard usage and scanty winter food
afforded by nature and their rude husbandry. Many of these have
considerable beauty and symmetry, and are fleet, hardy, and spirited.

[Illustration: Fig. 27.

Norman Horse.]

The _modern Norman_, or mixture of the old French Norman draught-horse,
(heavy-framed, big-limbed, but stout and hardy,) and the Andalusian, a
descendant of the Moorish barbs, has been introduced within a few years,
and will unquestionably become a very popular horse for many purposes.
He exhibits the qualities of both ancestry in the proper proportions for
farm service. He has a thick head; lively, prick ears; short, heavy
neck; large breast and shoulders; strong limbs; well-knit back; large
quarters, with much wavy mane, tail, and fetlock. Like his French
progenitor, he frequently stands low in the withers, which enables him
to throw great weight into the collar; and the diminished, flattened
leg, the wind and game derived from his Moorish blood, give him much of
the capacity and endurance of the thorough-bred.

The _English cart-horse_ has for a long time made up some of the best,
heavy dray-horses in the country, and late importations have refreshed
the breed with additional choice specimens. The _Cleveland bay_ has been
introduced of late, and promises good carriage-horses from our
well-spread, sizeable mares. The _Norfolk trotter Belfounder_ was
imported many years since, and with our high-bred mares, has produced
many choice roadsters and trotters.

The remainder of our horse-flesh deserving of any notice, is chiefly
composed of such as are superior in point of blood. The improvement in
the American horse, from this source, is conspicuous and decided.
Judicious breeders still look for qualities in the descendants, which
they sought for in their imported sires, and the infusion of some of the
stoutest of the blood is rapidly gaining an ascendency in the general
stock. Our intelligent agriculturists should look to this subject
closely, and not permit this system to proceed to an extent that may be
prejudicial to their value as draught-horses, as has been done in some
portions of England and our Southern states.

There is no danger from excess of blood, if it be of the right kind; but
it is seldom found combining that fulness and stoutness, and that
docility and tractableness of disposition, which are essential to the
gig-horse or the horse of all work. Yorke says truly, that "the
road-horse may possess different degrees of blood, according to the
nature of the country and the work required of him. [He might have added
with propriety, _and according to the character of the blood_.] His legs
will be too slender; his feet too small; his stride too long, and he
will rarely be able to trot. Three parts, or half, and for the horse of
all work, even less than that, will make a good and useful animal." For
the saddle only, the high-bred, if not disposed to be vicious, is never
objectionable to an enterprising and accomplished rider. His long
elastic pasterns, giving easy, flexible motions; his quick and almost
electrical obedience when under thorough discipline; his habitual canter
and high spirit, always commend him for this purpose.

[Illustration: Fig. 28.

Points of a Horse.

1. Muzzle.--2. Race.--3. Forehead.--4. Poll.--5. Crest.--6. Withers.--7.
Back.--8. Loins.--9. Hip.--10. Croup.--11. Dock.--12. Quarter.--13.
Thigh, or Gaskin.--14. Ham-string.--15. Point of the Hock.--16.
Cannon.--17. Fetlock.--18. Large Pastern.--19. Small Pastern.--20.
Hoof.--21. Coronet.--22. Ham, or Hock.--23. Sheath.--24. Flank.--25.
Girth.--26. Elbow.--27. Heel.--28. Hoof.--29. Small Pastern.--30. Large
Pastern.--31. Fetlock.--32. Cannon.--33. Knee.--34. Arm.--35. Breast, or
Bosom.--36. Point of the Shoulder.--37. Windpipe.--38. Gullet.--39.
Jowl.]


Some of the prominent external points of a fine Saddle or Gig Horse,

Are, a moderately small head, free from fleshiness; fine muzzle and
expansive nostrils; broad at the throat and wide between the eyes, which
denotes intelligence and courage; a dished face indicates high breeding,
and sometimes viciousness; a convex or Roman nose frequently betokens
the reverse; the ears rather long, yet so finely formed as to appear
small, and playing quickly like those of a deer; the eyes clear, full,
and confident, with a steady forward look. Glancing them backward or
askance with a sinister expression, and with none or only a slight
movement of the head, is indicative of a mischievous temper.

The neck should be handsomely arched, and fine at the junction with the
head, while the lower extremity must be full and muscular, and well
expanded at the breast and shoulders. The latter ought to be high and
run well back; the withers strong, firmly knit, and smooth; the breast
neither too prominent nor retreating, too wide nor too narrow, and
supported by a pair of straight fore-legs, standing well apart. The
chest should be deep, and the girth large; the body full, and not drawn
up too much in the flank; the back short, and the hips gathered well
towards the withers; the loins wide and rising above the spine; the ribs
springing nearly at right angles from the back, giving roundness to the
body. The hips ought to be long to the root of the tail, and the latter
may approach to near the line of the back, which is a mark of good
breeding.

Both the thigh and hock should be large and muscular; and between the
hock or knee and pastern, the legs should be broad, flat, and short; the
hind legs properly bent, and all well placed under the body; the
pasterns of moderate length, and standing slightly oblique; the hoof
hard, smooth, round before, and wide at the heel; the frog large and
sound; and the sole firm and concave. A white hoof is generally tender,
easy to fracture and to lame, and difficult to hold a shoe.

The _draught-horse_ ought to differ from the foregoing, in possessing a
heavier and shorter neck; a wider and stouter breast, and low withers,
so as to throw the utmost weight into the collar; a heavier body and
quarters; larger legs and feet; and more upright shoulders and pasterns.


Considerations which affect the Value of the Horse.

The color is not material, provided it be not pied or mealy. No better
color for horses can be found than the dark bay or brown, with black
mane, tail, and legs. But most of the other colors are frequently found
with the best horses.

Hard-mouthed horses, when accompanied with great spirit, are
objectionable, as they require peculiar bitting and the utmost
vigilance.

The paces and action of a horse are important, for if good they give a
much greater capacity for performance. Some of these depend on form and
structure, and are unchangeable; others are the result of breaking. All
horses should be taught to walk fast, as it is their easiest and most
economical pace, and it will help them over a great deal of ground in a
day, even with a heavy load, and with comparatively little effort. A
horse that steps short and digs his toes into the ground, is worthless
as a traveller, and suited only to a ferry-boat or bark-mill.

It is important that a horse be good-tempered. If inclined to
viciousness, he should be gently yet firmly managed when it is first
apparent. A resort to great severity will be justified, if necessary to
conquer him; for if once allowed to become a habit, it will be difficult
to cure him. Grooms and mischievous stable-boys, frequently do much
injury by their idle tricks with horses; and when detected, they should
be discharged at once.

Some horses are nervous, easily excited, and start at every unusual
noise or object. Others are restive and fretful, and ever anxious to be
on the move. Kindness, and firm, yet mild treatment, by which their
motions and will are at all times controlled, and their confidence
secured, are the only remedies.

Others are inclined to sluggishness. These should have stimulating food,
and never be overloaded or overworked, and then kept well to their
paces. Whatever they are capable of performing, can be got from them in
this way only. Habit has great influence with animals, as with man; and
when within the compass of his ability, he may be habituated to any
reasonable physical exertion.


Breeding.

Agreeably to the general principles before enumerated, such animals
should be selected, as most eminently possess those points which it is
desired to propagate, and these, they should not only exhibit in
themselves, but should inherit as far as possible, from a long line of
ancestry. For the perpetuation of particular points in progeny, it would
be safer to rely on the latter quality than the former.

The selection of a mare, relatively larger than the horse, is an
important rule in breeding, and it is believed that much of the success
of Arabian and other Eastern horses as stock-getters, has resulted from
the application of this principle. They possess valuable traits, but
condensed within too small a compass. When such an animal is put to a
well-bred, larger mare, the f[oe]tus has abundance of room and
nourishment to develop and perfect the circumscribed outlines of the
male parent, and acquire for itself increased volume and character.

The horse ought not to be less than four or five, and the mare one year
older, before being put to breeding. It would be still better to defer
it for two or three years, or till the frame is fully matured.


The Gestation of the Mare

Sometimes varies from 44 to 56 weeks, but she usually goes with young
from 47 to 50; and it is advisable she should take the horse at a time
which will ensure the foaling when the weather is settled, and there is
a fresh growth of grass. She will be the better for light working till
near the time of foaling, if well, but not too abundantly fed. In a few
days after this, she may resume moderate labor; and if not in the way or
troublesome, the foal may run with her; but if she is exposed to
heating, it should be confined till she cools, as suckling then is
decidedly injurious to it.

The mare is in danger of slinking her foal from blows and over-exertion,
the use of smutty grain, foul hay, or offensive objects or smell; and
when this has once occurred, which happens usually in the fourth or
fifth month, she should afterwards be generously fed at that period, and
only moderately worked, to prevent a recurrence of the casualty. When
liable to slinking, the mare should be removed from others in foal, lest
a peculiar sympathy should excite an epidemic.


The Mare comes in Heat

From nine to eleven days after foaling, when she should be put to the
horse, if it be desirable to have a colt the following season. She comes
round at intervals of about nine days.


Management of the Colt.

The colt may be weaned when five to seven months old; and preparatory to
this, while with the mare, may be taught to feed on fine hay, meal, or
oats. When taken away, he should be confined beyond a hearing distance
of the dam, and plentifully supplied with rowen or aftermath hay,
crushed oats, or wheat shorts. It is economy to provide a warm shelter
through the inclement season for all animals, and especially for colts,
which, with all other young, should have an abundance of nutritious
food. They will thus grow evenly and rapidly, and attain a size and
stamina at two years old, they would not otherwise have acquired at
three.


Castrating.

The colt should be altered at about one year, but if thin in the neck
and light before, the operation may be deferred to such time as the
requisite development is secured. Few of the French diligence and farm
horses, and scarcely any of the Oriental, are ever castrated. They are
thought to be more hardy and enduring; but the slight advantage they may
possibly possess in this respect, would hardly compensate for the
trouble and inconvenience too frequently arising from their management.

The operation should be performed late in the spring or early in autumn,
while the weather is mild. If in high condition, the animal must first
be bled and physicked. If large and fractious, he must be cast. Some
back him into the angle of a worm fence, where he is firmly held by the
head with a bridle, and the operator accomplishes the object without any
trouble or material restiveness from the animal while standing. The
scrotum should be opened on both sides, and the testicles cut, or rather
the cord scraped off, which prevents much bleeding. The wound may be
dressed with a little lard; then turn him loose in a pasture which has a
shelter from sun, wind, or rain. Another method of castrating is by
_torsion_, or twisting.


Docking

Is practised by many, but merely to gratify an absurd and cruel caprice,
without a single advantage, and the animal is better in every respect
with the tail unmutilated. If done at all, it should be when young, and
with a single stroke of the knife, or chisel and mallet; and if the
weather be favorable, no further attention is necessary.


Nicking.

This inhuman custom is now getting unfashionable, and we omit any
description of it.


Breaking.

While feeding in the stable, the colt should be gently treated, and
accustomed to the halter and bit, which prepares him for breaking. If
permitted to run with the others while at work, he becomes familiarized
to it, and when harnessed by the side of some of his well-trained mates,
he seems to consider his discipline rather a privilege than a task. The
colt may be taken in hand for breaking at three years of age, and
thoroughly broken to light work at four, but should not be put to hard
service till six or eight. A due regard to humanity and sound judgment,
in thus limiting the burden in his early years, would save much disease
and suffering to the animal, and profit to the owner, by his unimpaired
strength and prolonged life. The annual loss from neglecting this
precaution is enormous, which might be entirely avoided by less
eagerness to grasp the substance, while as yet the shadow only is within
reach. Many animals are thus broken down at twelve, and are in their
dotage at fifteen, while others of good constitution, if well treated,
perform hard service till thirty.


Longevity of the Horse.

Mr. Percival mentions one that died at 62. Mr. Mauran, of New York, has
a fine gig and saddle horse, now in his 45th year, sound, spirited, and
playful as a kitten. He is of a dark brown, with a tanned nose. We never
yet saw a horse with a buff or bear muzzle, that had not great
endurance.

American Eclipse was successfully covering mares in Kentucky at the age
of 32, the result of late and light service till his sinews became fully
matured. We have frequently seen a large, compact, flea-bitten horse at
work, dragging a heavy load in a single cart, which was formerly used as
one of Governor Maitland's coach-horses, and though upwards of 30, he
was apparently as sound and vigorous as an overtasked colt of seven or
eight.


Feeding.

The vigor and duration of the horse depend much on proper feeding. Like
the cow and sheep, he may be made to subsist on animal food, fish, and
almost every species of nutritious vegetable. But his natural and proper
aliment is the grasses, grain, and roots. In the middle and northern
sections of this country, his dry forage is almost invariably good
meadow-hay, generally timothy, which is the richest of the cultivated
grasses. At the South, this is often supplied by the blades of Indian
corn. But in all the states, a great variety of the grasses and clover
are used.

When put to hard labor, grain ought always to accompany hay in some
form. Of the different kinds of grain, oats are peculiarly the horse's
food, and they are always safe, digestible, and nutritive. Barley is the
best substitute for it. Wheat and Indian corn are sometimes given, but
both are unsuitable; the first is too concentrated, and the last too
heating. They ought to be sparingly used, and only when ground and mixed
with chaff. The offal of wheat is never objectionable.

Grain is always more advantageously fed when ground or crushed, and wet
some time previous to eating; and it is still better when cooked. On
both sides of the Mediterranean, in the Barbary States, in Spain,
France, and Italy, much of the food is given in small baked cakes, and
the saving in this way is much greater than the expense of preparing it.

When confined to dry food, roots or apples fed once a day are always
beneficial. They keep the bowels open, the appetite and general health
good, and contribute largely to the nutriment of the animal. Carrots are
the best of the roots, as besides giving muscle and working power, they,
more than any other, improve the wind and prevent all tendency to
heaves. They have even been found effectual in removing an obstinate
cough. By many of the keepers of livery stables, they are always used,
for which purpose they command the same price as oats. Potatoes,
parsnips, beets, and Swedes turnips, in the order mentioned, are next to
be preferred. Potatoes are improved by cooking.

Mixtures of food are best, as of cut hay, meal, and roots. Old horses,
or such as are put to hard labor, will do much better if their food be
given in the form easiest of digestion. No inconsiderable part of the
vital power is exhausted by the digestion of dry, raw food.

Horses ought to be fed, and if possible, exercised or worked regularly,
but never on a full stomach. This is a frequent cause of disease, and
especially of broken wind. If their food is given at the proper time,
and the horse be allowed to finish it at once, without expecting more,
he will lie down quietly and digest it. This will be much more
refreshing to him, than to stand at the rack or trough, nibbling
continually at his hay or oats. What remains after he has done feeding,
should be at once withdrawn.

They should have water in summer three times, and in winter twice a day.
Soft or running water is much the best. While working, and they are not
too warm, they may have it as often as they desire. Neither should they
be fed when heated, as the stomach is then fatigued and slightly
inflamed, and is not prepared for digestion till the animal is again
cool. Salt should always be within reach, and we have found an
occasional handful of clean wood-ashes, a preventive of disease and an
assistance to the bowels and appetite.

[Illustration: Fig. 29.

Skeleton of a Horse.

A The Head.--_a_ The posterior maxillary or under jaw.--_b_ The superior
maxillary or upper jaw. A little lower down than the letter is a
foramen, through which pass the nerves and blood-vessels which chiefly
supply the lower part of the face.--_c_ The orbit, or cavity containing
the eye.--_d_ The nasal bones, or bones of the nose.--_e_ The suture
dividing the parietal bones below from the occipital bones above.--_f_
The inferior maxillary bone, containing the upper incisor teeth.--B The
Seven Cervical Vertebrae, or bones of the neck.--C The Eighteen Dorsal
Vertebrae, or bones of the back.--D The Six Lumbar Vertebrae, or bones of
the loins.--E The Five Sacral Vertebrae, or bones of the haunch.--F The
Caudal Vertebrae, or bones of the tail, generally about fifteen.--G The
Scapula, or shoulder-blade.--H The Sternum, or fore-part of the
chest.--I The Costae or ribs, seven or eight articulating with the
sternum, and called the _true ribs_; and ten or eleven united together
by cartilage, called the _false ribs_.--J The Humerus, or upper bone of
the arm.--K The Radius, or upper bone of the arm.--L The Ulna, or elbow.
The point of the elbow is called the Olecranon.--M The Carpus, or knee,
consisting of seven bones.--N The metacarpal bones. The larger
metacarpal or cannon or shank in front, and the smaller metacarpal or
splint bone behind.--_g_ The fore pastern and foot, consisting of the Os
Suffraginis, or the upper and larger pastern bone, with the sesamoid
bones behind, articulating with the cannon and greater pastern; the Os
Coronae, or lesser pastern; the Os Pedis, or coffin-bone; and the Os
Naviculare, or navicular, or shuttle-bone, not seen, and articulating
with the smaller pastern and coffin-bones.--_h_ The corresponding bones
of the hind-feet.--O The Haunch, consisting of three portions: the
Ilium, the Ischium, and the Pubis.--P The Femur, or thigh.--Q The stifle
joint with the Patella.--R The Tibia, or proper leg bone; behind is a
small bone called the fibula--S The Tarsus, or hock, composed of six
bones. The prominent part is the Os Calcis, or point of the Hock.--T The
Metatarsals of the hind leg.]


DISEASES.

The list is long and fearful, and even the brief one subjoined, will be
found sufficiently great to inculcate the utmost caution in their
management. The horse in his natural condition is subject to few
ailments. It is only in his intensely artificial state, and when made
the slave of man, that he becomes a prey to disease in almost every
shape. A careful and judicious attention to his diet, water, exercise,
stable, and general management, will prevent many of those to which he
is subject.


Glanders.

This is one of the most alarming. The first and most marked symptom is a
discharge from the nostrils of a peculiar character. The disease
produces inflammation there and in the windpipe, and in aggravated cases
passes down to the lungs, which are soon destroyed.

_It is propagated_ by contagion, by exposure in humid stables, and is
induced by hereditary indisposition and great exhaustion. Youatt says,
there is not a disease which may not lay the foundation for glanders.
The poison resides in the nasal discharge, not in the breath. When
exposed to it, the mangers should be thoroughly scraped, washed with
soap and water, and afterwards with chloride of lime. All the clothing
and harness, which may have received any of the contagious matter, must
be thoroughly cleansed and baked.

_The best preventives_ are dry, clean, and well-ventilated stables,
proper exercise, green food in summer, and roots in winter.

_The disease may be arrested_ in its early stages, by turning the animal
on a dry pasture, but it is liable to return on subsequent confinement.
Iodine has lately been announced as a remedy, but of the certainty of
its effects, we are not aware.

It is generally considered incurable, and when thoroughly seated, it may
be deemed an act both of humanity and economy to terminate the existence
of its victim at once. This course becomes a duty, from the fact that
many grooms, by their attendance on glandered horses, have been
affected, and though the disease is, in their case, more manageable, yet
it is frequently fatal.


Farcy.

This is intimately connected with glanders, and the diseases frequently
run into each other.


Lampas.

This consists in the swelling of the bars of the mouth to a level or
even above the teeth. It may occur from inflammation of the gums;
shedding of the teeth; a febrile tendency, and from over-feeding or want
of exercise. It will generally subside by low dieting and proper
exercise; or it may be at once relieved by lancing the bars with a sharp
penknife.


Poll-evil.

This arises from some contusion or injury to the head, which produces a
swelling that eventually suppurates. The inflammation may be abated, in
its earliest stages, by a blister; and in its later, by bleeding,
physic, and cold lotions applied to the part. If these are ineffectual,
and the swelling continues, it should be hastened by poultices, and
warm, stimulating lotions; and when fully formed, the tumor must be
opened, so as to permit all the matter to run out. Repeated applications
of salt will sometimes cure it.


Heaves.

All those affections, distinguished in the English veterinary works as
_pneumonia or inflammation of the lungs_, _chronic cough_, _thick and
broken wind_, _consumption_, _&c._, are popularly designated as
_heaves_. To some or all of these the horse may have an hereditary or
constitutional tendency. Their incipient stages are also induced by a
sudden transition from heat to cold, and sometimes from cold to close
and hot stables; and by a chilly wind or damp stables, especially after
severe exercise. Feeding on musty, dry hay, or on straw, will produce an
irritation which may lead to heaves.

_Inflammation of the lungs_ is frequently dangerous, and requires the
immediate and full use of the lancet. After the inflammation is
decidedly allayed, by copious bleeding, small doses of aloes may be
given, and frequent injections of warm soap and water, which should be
omitted the moment the feces become soft and approaching to the fluid
state. Blistering the sides and brisket, to be often repeated if
otherwise ineffectual, must be resorted to. Convalescence should be
followed with sedative medicines, and during all the severe stages of
the disease, withhold all food, except light gruels after protracted
abstinence. As health returns, put the animal out to grass.

Inflammation of the lungs is sometimes succeeded by a _chronic cough_,
and the other maladies enumerated. When firmly seated, it is incapable
of removal. Its effects can be alleviated, and with suitable food and
treatment, the horse may be made to do much moderate labor for many
years, but he can never become sound or sustain great exertion. Equal
and proper temperature, moist, stimulating food, and especially carrots
or potatoes, and moderate exercise, (but never on a full stomach,) and
dry, clean stables, are all the remedies that can be prescribed.


Catarrh or Horse Distemper.

This sometimes attacks the horse in the spring or fall, and is shown by
soreness and swelling in the glands of the throat, a cough; difficulty
of swallowing; discharging at the nose; and general prostration. It is
seldom fatal, if properly managed. Give light bran-mashes, purge
thoroughly, and keep warm. If he is violently attacked, he may be bled
while fever exists; and blisters or setons may be applied, to reduce the
swelling, if extreme. The disease is contagious, and the animal should
be at once placed where he cannot communicate it.


Spasmodic Colic.

_Symptoms._--The attack of colic is usually very sudden. There is often
not the slightest warning. The horse begins to shift his posture, look
round at his flanks, paw violently, strike his belly with his feet, and
crouch in a peculiar manner, advancing his hind limbs under him; he will
then suddenly lie, or rather fall down, and balance himself upon his
back, with his feet resting on his belly. The pain now seems to cease
for a little while, and he gets up and shakes himself, and begins to
feed; the respite, however, is but short--the spasm returns more
violently--every indication of pain is increased--he heaves at the
flanks, breaks out into a profuse perspiration, and throws himself more
recklessly about. In the space of an hour or two, either the spasms
begin to relax, and the remissions are of longer duration, or the
torture is augmented at every paroxysm; the intervals of ease are fewer
and less marked, and inflammation and death supervene. The pulse is but
little affected at the commencement, but it soon becomes frequent and
contracted, and at length is scarcely tangible.

Among the _causes_ of colic are, the drinking of cold water when the
horse is heated. There is not a surer origin of violent spasm than this.
Hard water is very apt to produce this effect. Colic will sometimes
follow the exposure of a horse to the cold air or a cold wind after
strong exercise. Green food, although, generally speaking, most
beneficial to the horse, yet, given in too large a quantity, or when he
is hot, will frequently produce gripes. Doses of aloes, both large and
small, are not unfrequent causes of colic.

In some horses there seems to be a constitutional predisposition to
colic. They cannot be hardly worked, or exposed to unusual cold, without
a fit of it. In many cases, when these horses have died, calculi have
been found in some part of the alimentary canal. Habitual costiveness
and the presence of calculi, are frequent causes of spasmodic colic. The
seat of colic is occasionally the duodenum, but oftener the ileum or the
jejunum; sometimes, however, both the caecum and colon are affected.
Fortunately, we are acquainted with several medicines that allay these
spasms; and the disease often ceases as suddenly as it appeared.

_Remedies._--Turpentine is one of the most powerful remedies, especially
in union with opium, and in good warm ale. A solution of aloes will be
advantageously added to the turpentine and opium. If relief is not
obtained in half an hour, it will be prudent to bleed, for the
continuance of violent spasm may produce inflammation. Some
practitioners bleed at first, and it is far from bad practice; for
although the majority of cases will yield to turpentine, opium, and
aloes, an early bleeding may occasionally prevent the recurrence of
inflammation, or at least mitigate it. If it is clearly a case of colic,
half of the first dose may be repeated, with aloes dissolved in warm
water. The stimulus produced on the inner surface of the bowels by the
purgative, may counteract the irritation that caused the spasm.

The belly should be well rubbed with a brush or warm cloth, but not
bruised and injured by the broom-handle rubbed over it, with all their
strength, by two great fellows. The horse should be walked about or
trotted moderately. The motion thus produced in the bowels, and the
friction of one intestine over the other, may relax the spasm, but the
hasty gallop might speedily cause inflammation to succeed to colic.

Clysters of warm water, or containing a solution of aloes, should be
injected. The patent syringe will here be exceedingly useful. A clyster
of tobacco-smoke may be thrown up as a last resort.

When relief has been obtained, the clothing of the horse, saturated with
perspiration, should be removed, and fresh and dry clothes substituted.
He should be well littered down in a warm stable or box, and have bran
mashes and lukewarm water for the two or three next days. Some persons
give gin, or gin and pepper, or even spirit of pimento, in cases of
gripes. This course of proceeding is, however, exceedingly
objectionable. It may be useful, or even sufficient, in ordinary cases
of colic; but if there should be any inflammation, or tendency to
inflammation, it cannot fail to be highly injurious.


Flatulent Colic.

This is altogether a different disease from the former. It is not spasm
of the bowels, but inflation of them, from the presence of gas emitted
by undigested food. Whether collected in the stomach, or small or large
intestines, all kinds of vegetable matter are liable to ferment. In
consequence of this fermentation gas is evolved to a greater or less
extent--perhaps to twenty or thirty times the bulk of the food. This may
take place in the stomach; and if so, the life of the horse is in
immediate danger, for the animal has no power to expel this dangerous
flatus by eructation.

_The symptoms_, according to Professor Stewart, are, "The horse suddenly
slackening his pace, preparing to lie down, or falling down, as if he
were shot. In the stable he paws the ground with his fore-feet, lies
down, rolls, starts up all at once, and throws himself down again with
great violence, looking wistfully at his flanks, and making many
fruitless attempts to void his urine."

_The treatment_ is considerably different from that of spasmodic colic.
The spirit of pimento would be here allowed, or the turpentine and opium
drink; but if the pain, and especially the swelling, do not abate, the
gas, which is the cause of it, must be got rid of, or the animal is
inevitably lost. This is usually, or almost invariably, a combination
of hydrogen with some other gas. It has a strong affinity for chlorine.
Then if some compound of chlorine--the chloride of lime--dissolved in
water, is administered in the form of a drink, the chlorine separates
from the lime as soon as it comes in contact with the hydrogen, and
muriatic gas is formed. This gas, having a strong affinity for water, is
absorbed by any fluid that may be present, and, quitting its gaseous
form, either disappears, or does not retain a thousandth part of its
former bulk. All this may be very rapidly accomplished, for the fluid is
quickly conveyed from the mouth to every part of the intestinal canal.

Where these two medicines are not at hand, and the danger is imminent,
the _trochar_ may be used, in order to open a way for the escape of the
gas. The trochar should be small, but longer than that which is used for
the cow, and the puncture should be made in the middle of the right
flank, for there the large intestines are most easily reached. It is
only when the practitioner despairs of otherwise saving the life of the
animal, that this operation should be attempted. Much of the danger
would be avoided by using a very small trochar, and by withdrawing it as
soon as the gas has escaped. The wound in the intestines will then
probably close, from the innate elasticity of the parts.


Inflammation of the Bowels.

There are two varieties of this malady. The first is inflammation of the
external coats of the intestines, accompanied by considerable fever, and
usually costiveness. The second is that of the internal or mucous coat,
and almost invariably connected with purging. The muscular coat is that
which is oftenest affected. Inflammation of the external coats of the
stomach, whether the peritoneal or muscular, or both, is a very frequent
and fatal disease. It speedily runs its course, and it is of great
consequence that its early symptoms should be known.

_Symptoms._--If the horse has been carefully observed, restlessness and
fever will have been seen to precede the attack. In many cases a direct
shivering fit will occur; the mouth will be hot, and the nose red. The
animal will soon express the most dreadful pain by pawing, striking at
his belly, looking wildly at his flanks, groaning, and rolling. The
pulse will be quickened and small; the ears and legs cold; the belly
tender, and sometimes hot; the breathing quickened; the bowels costive;
and the animal becoming rapidly and fearfully weak.

_The causes_ of this disease are, first of all and most frequently,
sudden exposure to cold. If a horse that has been highly fed, carefully
groomed, and kept in a warm stable, is heated with exercise, and has
been during some hours without food, and in this state of exhaustion is
suffered to drink freely of cold water, or is drenched with rain, or
have his legs and belly washed with cold water, an attack of
inflammation of the bowels will often follow. An overfed horse,
subjected to severe and long-continued exertion, if his lungs were
previously weak, will probably be attacked by inflammation of them; but
if the lungs were sound, the bowels will on the following day be the
seat of disease. Stones in the intestines are an occasional cause of
inflammation, and colic neglected or wrongly treated will terminate in
it.

_Remedies._--The treatment of inflammation of the bowels, like that of
the lungs, should be prompt and energetic. The first and most powerful
means of cure will be bleeding. From six to eight or ten quarts of
blood, in fact as much as the horse can bear, should be abstracted as
soon as possible; and the bleeding repeated to the extent of four or
five quarts more, if the pain is not relieved and the pulse has not
become rounder and fuller. The speedy weakness that accompanies this
disease, should not deter from bleeding largely. That weakness is the
consequence of violent inflammation of these parts; and if that
inflammation is subdued by the loss of blood, the weakness will
disappear. The bleeding should be effected on the first appearance of
the disease, for there is no malady that more quickly runs its course.

A strong solution of aloes should immediately follow the bleeding, but,
considering the irritable state of the intestines at this period,
guarded by opium. This should be quickly followed by back-raking, and
injections consisting of warm water, or very thin gruel, in which Epsom
salts or aloes have been dissolved; and too much fluid can scarcely be
thrown up.

The horse should likewise be encouraged to drink plentifully of warm
water or thin gruel; and draughts, each containing a couple of drachms
of dissolved aloes, with a little opium, should be given every six
hours, until the bowels are freely opened. It will now be prudent to
endeavor to excite considerable external inflammation, as near as
possible to the seat of internal disease, and therefore the whole of the
belly should be blistered.

In a well-marked case of this disease, no time should be lost in
applying fomentations, but the blister at once resorted to. The tincture
of Spanish flies, whether made with spirits of wine or turpentine,
should be thoroughly rubbed in. The legs should be well bandaged, in
order to restore the circulation in them, and thus lessen the flow of
blood to the inflamed part; and, for the same reason, the horse should
be warmly clothed, but the air of the stable or box should be cool.

No grain or hay should be allowed during the disease, but bran mashes,
and green food if it can be procured. The latter will be the best, and
may be given without the slightest apprehension of danger. When the
horse begins to recover, a handful of grain may be given two or three
times in the day; and, if the weather is warm, he may be turned into a
paddock for a few hours in the middle of the day. Clysters of gruel
should be continued for three or four days after the inflammation is
beginning to subside, and good hand-rubbing applied to the legs.


The second variety of Inflammation of the Bowels

Affects the internal or mucous coat, and is generally the consequence of
physic in too great quantity, or of an improper kind. The purging is
more violent and continues longer than was intended; the animal shows
that he is suffering great pain; he frequently looks round at his
flanks; his breathing is laborious, and the pulse is quick and small,
and the mouth is hot and the legs and ears are warm.

_Remedies._--Unless the purging is excessive, and the pain and distress
great, the surgeon should hesitate at giving any astringent medicine at
first; but he should plentifully administer gruel or thin starch, or
arrow-root, by the mouth and by clyster, removing all hay and grain, and
particularly green food. He should thus endeavor to soothe the irritated
surface of the bowels, while he permits all remains of the purgative to
be carried off. If, however, twelve hours have passed, and the purging
and the pain remain undiminished, he should continue the gruel, adding
to it chalk, catechu, and opium, repeated every six hours. As soon as
the purging begins to subside, the astringent medicine should be
lessened in quantity, and gradually discontinued.

Bleeding will rarely be necessary, unless the inflammation is very
great, and attended by symptoms of general fever. The horse should be
warmly clothed, and placed in a comfortable stable, and his legs should
be hand-rubbed and bandaged.

_Violent purging_, and attended with much inflammation and fever, will
occur from other causes. Green food will frequently purge; and a horse
worked hard upon it will sometimes scour.

The _remedy_ is change of diet, or less labor. Young horses will often
be strongly purged, without any apparent cause. Astringents should be
used with much caution here. It is probably an effort of nature to get
rid of something that offends. A few doses of gruel will assist in
effecting this purpose, and the purging will cease without astringent
medicine.

Many horses that are not _well ribbed home_ (having too great space
between the last rib and the hip-bone) are subject to purging, if more
than usual exertion is required from them. They are recognised by the
term of _washy_ horses. They are often free and fleet, but destitute of
continuance. They should have rather more than the usual allowance of
grain, with beans, when at work. A cordial ball, with catechu and opium,
will often be serviceable either before or after a journey.


Physicking.

When a horse comes from grass to dry food, or from the cool, open air to
a heated stable, a dose, or even two doses, of physic may be useful to
prevent the tendency to inflammation, which is the necessary consequence
of so sudden and great a change. To a horse that is becoming too fat, or
has surfeit, grease, or mange, or that is out of condition from
inactivity of the digestive organs, a dose of physic is often most
serviceable. A horse should be carefully prepared for the action of
physic. Two or three bran mashes given on that or the preceding day, are
far from sufficient when a horse is about to be physicked, whether to
promote his condition, or in obedience to custom. Mashes should be given
until the dung becomes softened. A less quantity of physic will then
suffice, and it will more quickly pass through the intestines, and be
more readily diffused over them.

Five drachms of aloes, given when the dung has thus been softened, will
act more effectually and much more safely than seven drachms, when the
lower intestines are obstructed by hardened feces. On the day on which
the physic is given, the horse should have walking exercise, or may be
gently trotted for a quarter of an hour twice in the day; but after the
physic begins to work, he should not be moved from his stall. Exercise
would then produce gripes, irritation, and, possibly, dangerous
inflammation. A little hay may be put into the rack. As much mash should
be given as the horse will eat, and as much water, with the coldness of
it taken off, as he will drink. If, however, he obstinately refuses to
drink warm water, it is better that he should have it cold, than to
continue without taking any fluid; but in such case he should not be
suffered to take more than a quart at a time, with an interval of at
least an hour between each draught.

When the purging has ceased, or _the physic is set_, a mash should be
given once or twice every day until the next dose is taken, between
which and the _setting_ of the first, there should be an interval of a
week. The horse should recover from the languor and debility occasioned
by the first dose, before he is harassed by a second. Eight or ten
tolerably copious motions, will be perfectly sufficient to answer every
good purpose, although the groom may not be satisfied unless double the
quantity are procured. The consequence of too strong purgation will be,
that weakness will hang about the animal for several days or weeks, and
inflammation will often ensue from the over-irritation of the intestinal
canal.

Long-continued custom has made ALOES the almost invariable purgative of
the horse, and very properly so; for there is no other at once so sure
and so safe. The Barbadoes aloes, although sometimes very dear, should
alone be used. The dose, with a horse properly prepared, will vary from
four to seven drachms. Custom has assigned the form of a ball to physic,
but good sense will in due time introduce the solution of aloes, as
acting more speedily, effectually, and safely.

The only other purgative on which dependence can be placed is the
CROTON. The farina or meal of the nut is generally used; but from its
acrimony it should be given in the form of ball, with linseed meal. The
dose varies from a scruple to half a drachm. It acts more speedily than
the aloes, and without the nausea which they produce; but it causes more
watery stools, and, consequently, more debility.

LINSEED OIL is an uncertain but safe purgative, in doses from a pound to
a pound and a half. OLIVE OIL is more uncertain, but safe; but CASTOR
OIL, that mild aperient in the human being, is both uncertain and
unsafe. EPSOM SALTS are inefficacious, except in the immense dose of a
pound and a half, and then they are not always safe.


Worms.

The long white worm (_lumbricus teres_) much resembles the common
earth-worm, and being from six to ten inches in length, inhabits the
small intestines. It is a formidable looking animal; and if there are
many of them, they may consume more than can be spared of the nutritive
part of the food, or the mucus of the bowels. A tight skin, and rough
coat, and tucked-up belly, are sometimes connected with their presence.
They are then, however, voided in large quantities.

_Remedies._--A dose of physic will sometimes bring away almost
incredible quantities of them. Calomel is frequently given as a
vermifuge. The seldomer this drug is administered to the horse, the
better. When the horse can be spared, a strong dose of physic is an
excellent vermifuge, so far as the long round worm is concerned. But a
better medicine, and not interfering with either the feeding or work of
the horse, is emetic tartar, with ginger, made into a ball with linseed
meal and treacle, and given every morning, half an hour before the horse
is fed.

A smaller, darker colored worm, called the needle-worm, or _ascaris_,
inhabits the larger intestines. Hundreds of them sometimes descend into
the rectum, and immense quantities have been found in the c[oe]cum.
These are a more serious nuisance than the former, for they cause a very
troublesome irritation about the fundament, which sometimes sadly annoys
the horse. Their existence can generally be discovered by a small
portion of mucus, which, hardening, is found adhering to the anus.

_Remedies._--Physic will sometimes bring away great numbers of these
worms; but when there is much irritation about the tail, and much of
this mucus, indicating that they have descended into the rectum, an
injection of linseed oil, or of aloes dissolved in warm water, will be a
more effectual remedy. The tape-worm is seldom found in the horse.


Bots.

While they inhabit the stomach of the horse, cannot give the animal any
pain, for they have fastened on the cuticular and insensible coat. They
cannot stimulate the stomach and increase its digestive power, for they
are not on the digestive portion of the stomach. They cannot, by their
roughness, assist the trituration or rubbing down of the food, for no
such office is performed in that part of the stomach--the food is
softened, not rubbed down. They cannot be injurious to the horse, for he
enjoys the most perfect health when the cuticular part of his stomach is
filled with them, and their presence is not even suspected until they
appear at the anus.

They cannot be removed by medicine, because they are not in that part of
the stomach in which medicine is usually conveyed; and if they were,
their mouths are too deeply buried in the mucus for any medicine, that
can be safely administered, to affect them; and, last of all, in due
course of time they detach themselves, and come away. Therefore, the
wise man will leave them to themselves, or content himself with picking
them off when they collect under the tail and annoy the animal.


Wind-galls.

In the neighborhood of the fetlock, there are occasionally found
considerable enlargements, oftener on the hind-leg than the fore one,
which are denominated _wind-galls_. Between the tendons and other parts,
and wherever the tendons are exposed to pressure or friction, and
particularly about their extremities, little bags or sacs are placed,
containing and suffering to ooze slowly from them, a mucous fluid to
lubricate the parts. From undue pressure, and that most frequently
caused by violent action and straining of the tendons, or often from
some predisposition about the horse, these little sacs are injured. They
take on inflammation, and sometimes become large and indurated. There
are few horses perfectly free from them. When they first appear, and
until the inflammation subsides, they may be accompanied by some degree
of lameness; but otherwise, except when they attain a great size, they
do not interfere with the action of the animal, or cause any
considerable unsoundness. The farriers used to suppose that they
contained wind--hence their name, wind-galls; and hence the practice of
opening them, by which dreadful inflammation was often produced, and
many a valuable horse destroyed.

_Remedies._--A slight wind-gall will scarcely be subjected to treatment;
but if these tumors are numerous and large, and seem to impede the
motion of the limb, they may be attacked first by bandage. The roller
should be of flannel, and soft pads should be placed on each of the
enlargements, and bound down tightly upon them. The bandage should also
be wetted with warm water, two or three times a day, for half an hour
each time. The wind-gall will often diminish or disappear by this
treatment, but will too frequently return, when the horse is again
hardly worked.

A blister is a more effectual, but too often temporary remedy. _Firing_
is still more certain, if the tumors are sufficiently large and annoying
to justify our having recourse to measures so severe; for it will not
only effect the immediate absorption of the fluid, and the reduction of
the swelling, but, by contracting the skin, will act as a permanent
bandage, and therefore prevent the reappearance of the tumor. The iodine
and mercurial ointments have occasionally been used with advantage, in
the proportion of three parts of the former to two of the latter.


Inflammation of the Fetlock.

The fetlock-joint is a very complicated one, and from the stress which
is laid on it, and its being the principal seat of motion below the
knee, it is particularly subject to injury. There are not many cases of
sprain of the back-sinew, that are not accompanied by inflammation of
the ligaments of this joint; and numerous supposed cases of sprain
higher up, are simple affections of the fetlock. It requires a great
deal of care, and some experience, to distinguish the one from the
other. The heat about the part, and the point at which the horse least
endures the pressure of the finger, will be the principal guides.

_Remedy._--Occasionally, by the application of cooling lotions, the
inflammation may be subdued, but at other times, the horse suffers
dreadfully, and is unable to stand. A serious affection of the
fetlock-joint demands prompt treatment.


Cutting.

The inside of the fetlock is often bruised by the shoe or the hoof of
the opposite foot. Many expedients used to be tried to remove this; the
inside heel has been raised and lowered, and the outside raised and
lowered; and sometimes one operation has succeeded, and sometimes the
contrary; and there was no point so involved in obscurity or so
destitute of principles to guide the practitioner.

_Remedy._--The most successful remedy and that which in the great
majority of cases supersedes all others, is Mr. Turner's shoe, of equal
thickness from heel to toe, and having but one nail, and that near the
toe, on the inside of the shoe; care being taken that the shoe shall not
extend beyond the edge of the crust, and that the crust shall be rasped
a little at the quarters.


Sprain of the Coffin-Joint.

The proof of this is when the lameness is sudden, and the heat and
tenderness are principally felt round the coronet.

_Remedy._--Bleeding at the toe, physic, fomentation, and blisters, are
the usual means adopted. This lameness is not easily removed, even by a
blister; and if removed, like sprains of the fetlock and of the
back-sinews, it is apt to return, and finally produce a great deal of
disorganization and mischief in the foot. Sprain of the coffin-joint
sometimes becomes a very serious affair. Not being always attended by
any external swelling, and being detected only by heat round the
coronet, the seat of the lameness is often overlooked by the groom and
the farrier; and the disease is suffered to become confirmed before its
nature is discovered.


Ringbone.

This is a deposite of bony matter in one of the pasterns, and usually
near the joint. It rapidly spreads, and involves not only the
pastern-bones, but the cartilages of the foot, and spreading around the
pasterns and cartilages, thus derives its name. When the first deposite
is on the lower pastern, and on both sides of it, and produced by
violent inflammation of the ligaments of the joints, it is recognised by
a slight enlargement, or bony tumor on each side of the foot, and just
above the coronet.

Horses with short upright joints, and with small feet and high action,
are oftenest, as may be supposed, the subjects of this disease, which is
the consequence either of concussion or sprain of the pastern-joints. It
is also more frequent in the hind foot than the fore, because, from the
violent action of the hind legs in propelling the horse forward, the
pasterns are more subject to ligamentary injury behind than before; yet
the lameness is not so great there, because the disease is confined
principally to the ligaments, and the bones have not been injured by
concussion; while, from the position of the fore limbs, there will
generally be in them injury of the bones to be added to that of the
ligaments.

_Remedy._--In its early stage, and when recognised only by a bony
enlargement on both sides of the pastern-joint, or in a few cases on one
side only, the lameness is not very considerable, and it is not
impossible to remove the disease by active blistering, or by the
application of the cautery; but there is so much wear and tear in this
part of the animal, that the inflammation and the disposition to the
formation of bone rapidly spread. The pasterns first become connected
together by bone instead of ligament, and thence results what is called
an anchylosed or fixed joint. From this joint the disease proceeds to
the cartilages of the foot, and to the union between the lower pastern,
and the coffin and navicular bones. The motion of these parts likewise
is impeded or lost, and the whole of the foot becomes one mass of spongy
bone.


Enlargement of the Hock.

First, there is inflammation, or _sprain of the hock-joint generally_,
arising from sudden violent concussion, by some check at speed, or
over-weight, and attended with enlargement of the whole joint, and great
tenderness and lameness.

_Remedy._--This, however, like all other diffused inflammations, is not
so untractable as an intense one of a more circumscribed nature, and by
rest and fomentation, or, perchance, firing, the limb recovers its
action, and the horse becomes fit for ordinary work. The swelling,
however, does not always subside. Enlargement, spread over the whole of
the hock-joint, remains.

A horse with an enlarged hock must always be regarded with suspicion. In
truth, he is unsound. The parts, altered in structure, must be to a
certain degree weakened. The animal may discharge his usual work during
a long period, without return of lameness; but if one of those
emergencies should occur when all his energies require to be exerted,
the disorganized and weakened part will fail. He may be ridden or driven
moderately for many a year without inconvenience, yet one extra hard
day's work may lame him forever.


Curb.

There are often injuries of particular parts of the hock-joint. _Curb_
is an affection of this kind. It is an enlargement at the back of the
hock, three or four inches below its point. It is either a strain of the
ring-like ligament which binds the tendons in their place, or of the
sheath of the tendons; oftener, however, of the ligament than of the
sheath. Any sudden action of the limb of more than usual violence may
produce it, and therefore horses are found to throw out curbs after a
hardly-contested race, an extraordinary leap, a severe gallop over heavy
ground, or a sudden check in the gallop.

Young horses are particularly liable to it, and horses that are
_cow-hocked_, whose hocks and legs resemble those of the cow, the hocks
being turned inwards, and legs forming a considerable angle outwards.
This is intelligible enough; for in hocks so formed, the annular
ligament must be continually on the stretch, in order to confine the
tendon. Curbs are generally accompanied by considerable lameness at
their first appearance, but the swelling is not always great. They are
best detected by observing the leg sidewise.

_Remedies._--The first object in attempting the cure, is to abate
inflammation, and this will be most readily accomplished by cold
evaporating lotions, frequently applied to the part. Equal portions of
spirit of wine, water, and vinegar, will afford an excellent
application. It will be almost impossible to keep a bandage on. If the
heat and lameness are considerable, it will be prudent to give a dose of
physic, and to bleed from the subcutaneous vein, whose course is near
it; and whether the injury is of the annular ligament, or the sheath of
the tendon, more active means will be necessary to perfect a cure.

Either a liquid blister should be rubbed on the part, consisting of a
vinus or turpentine tincture of cantharides, and this daily applied
until some considerable swelling takes place; or, what is the preferable
plan, the hair should be cut off, and the part blistered as soon as the
heat has been subdued. The blister should be repeated, until the
swelling has disappeared, and the horse goes sound.

In severe cases it may be necessary _to fire_; but a fair trial,
however, should be given to milder measures. If the iron is used, it
should be applied in straight lines.

There are few lamenesses in which absolute and long-continued rest is
more requisite. It leaves the parts materially weakened, and, if the
horse is soon put to work again, the lameness will frequently return. No
horse that has had curbs, should be put even to ordinary work in less
than a month after the apparent cure; and, even then he should very
gradually resume his former habits.

A horse with a curb, is manifestly unsound, or generally condemned as
unsound. Curb is also an hereditary complaint; and therefore a horse
that has once suffered from it, should always be regarded with
suspicion, especially if either of the parents have exhibited it.


Bone Spavin.

This is an affection of the bones of the hock-joint. Spavined horses are
generally capable of slow work. They are equal to the greater part of
the work of the farm, and therefore they should not always be rejected
by the small farmer, as they may generally be procured at a small price.
These horses are not only capable of agricultural work, but they
generally improve under it. The lameness in some degree abates, and even
the bony tumor to a certain degree lessens. There is sufficient moderate
motion and friction of the limb to rouse the absorbents to action, and
cause them to take up a portion of the bony matter thrown out, but not
enough to renew or prolong inflammation. It cannot be said that the plow
affords a _cure_ for spavin, but the spavined horse often materially
improves while working at it. For fast work, and for work that must be
regularly performed, spavined horses are not well calculated; for this
lameness behind produces great difficulty in rising, and the
consciousness that he will not be able to rise without painful effort,
occasionally prevents the horse from lying down at all; and the animal
that cannot rest well, cannot long travel far or fast.

_Remedies._--The treatment of spavin is simple enough, but far from
being always effectual. The owner of the horse will neither consult his
own interest, nor the dictates of humanity, if he suffers the chisel and
mallet, or the gimlet, or the pointed iron, or arsenic to be used; yet
measures of considerable severity must be resorted to. Repeated blisters
will usually cause either the absorption of the bony deposite, or the
abatement or removal of the inflammation of the ligaments, or, as a last
resource, the heated iron may be applied.


Swelled Legs.

The fore-legs, but oftener the hind ones, and especially in coarse
horses, are sometimes subject to considerable enlargement. Occasionally,
when the horse does not seem to labor under any other disease, and
sometimes from an apparent shifting of disease from other parts, the
hind legs suddenly swell to an enormous degree from the hock, and almost
from the stifle to the fetlock, attended by a greater or less degree of
heat, and tenderness of the skin, and sometimes excessive and very
peculiar lameness. The pulse likewise becomes quick and hard, and the
horse evidently labors under considerable fever. It is acute
inflammation of the cellular substance of the legs, and that most sudden
in its attack, and most violent n its degree, and therefore attended by
the effusion of a considerable quantity of fluid into the cellular
membrane. It occurs in young horses, and in those which are over-fed and
little exercised.

_Remedies._--Fomentation, diuretics, or purgatives, or, if there is much
fever, a moderate bleeding, will often relieve the distention almost as
suddenly as it appeared. Mild cases will generally yield to their
influence; but, if the animal has been neglected, the treatment must be
decisive. If the horse is in high condition, these should be preceded or
accompanied by bleeding; but if there are any symptoms of debility,
bleeding would only increase the want of tone in the vessels.

Horses taken from grass and brought into close stables, very speedily
have swelled legs, because the difference of food and increase of
nutriment rapidly increase the quantity of the circulating fluid, while
the want of exercise takes away the means by which it might be got rid
of. The remedy here is sufficiently plain.

Swelled legs, however, may proceed from general debility. They may be
the consequence of starvation, or disease that has considerably weakened
the animal; and these parts, being farthest from the centre of
circulation, are the first to show the loss of power by the accumulation
of fluid in them. Here the means of cure would be to increase the
general strength, with which the extremities would sympathize. Mild
diuretics and tonics would therefore be evidently indicated.

Horses in the spring and fall are subject to swelled legs. The powers of
the constitution are principally employed in providing a new coat for
the animal, and the extremities have not their share of vital influence.
Mingled cordials and diuretics are indicated here; the diuretic to
lessen the quantity of the circulating fluid, and the cordial to
invigorate the frame.


Grease.

Swelled legs, although distinct from grease, is a disease that is apt to
degenerate into it. Grease is a specific inflammation of the skin of the
heels, sometimes of the fore-feet, but oftener of the hinder ones. Bad
stable management is the true cause of it. Grease is a local complaint.
The heel should be well but gently washed with soap and water, and as
much of the scurf detached as is easily removable. An ointment should
be applied, to supple, cool, and heal the part.

When _cracks_ appear, the mode of treatment will depend on their extent
and depth. If the cracks are deep, with an ichorous discharge and
considerable lameness, it will be necessary to poultice the heel. A
poultice of linseed meal will be generally effective, unless the
discharge is thin and offensive, when an ounce of finely-powdered
charcoal should be mixed with the linseed meal; or a poultice of
carrots, boiled soft and mashed. After the chaps or cracks have healed,
the legs will sometimes continue gorged and swelled. A flannel bandage,
evenly applied over the whole of the swelled part, will be very
serviceable; or should the season admit of it, a run at grass,
particularly spring grass, should be allowed.

The feeding should likewise vary with the case, but with these rules,
which admit of no exception; that green food should be given, and more
especially carrots, when they are not too expensive; and mashes, if the
horse will eat them; and never the full allowance of grain.

Walking exercise should be resorted to as soon as the horse is able to
bear it, and this by degrees may be increased to a gentle trot.

From bad stable-management at first, and neglect during the disease, a
yet worse kind of grease occasionally appears. The ulceration extends
over the skin of the heel and the fetlock, and a fungus springs from the
surface of both, highly sensible, bleeding at the slightest touch, and
interspersed with scabs. By degrees portions of the fungus begin to be
covered with a horny substance, protruding in the form of knobs, and
collected together in bunches. These are known by the name of _grapes_.
A f[oe]tid and very peculiar exudation, proceeds from nearly the whole
of the unnatural substance. The horse evidently suffers much, and is
gradually worn down by the discharge. The assistance of a veterinary
surgeon is here indispensable.

Some horses are more subject to grease than others, particularly
draught-horses, both heavy and light, but particularly the former, and
if they have no degree of _blood_ in them. It was the experience of
this, which partly contributed to the gradual change of coach and other
draught-horses to those of a lighter breed. In the great majority of
cases, grease arises from mismanagement and neglect.

Every thing that has a tendency to excite inflammation in the skin of
the heel is a cause of grease. Therefore want of exercise is a frequent
source of this disease. When high feeding is added to irregular or
deficient exercise, the disease is evidently still more likely to be
produced. Want of cleanliness in the stable is a fruitful source of
grease. When the heels are imbedded in filth, they are weakened by the
constant moisture surrounding them. The absurd practice of washing the
feet and legs of horses when they come from their work, and either
carelessly sponging them down afterwards, or leaving them to dry as they
may, is, however, the most common origin of grease.

When the horse is warmed by his work, and the heels share in the warmth,
the momentary cold of washing may not be injurious, if the animal is
immediately rubbed dry; yet even this would be better avoided; but to
wash out the heels, and then leave them partially dry or perfectly wet,
and suffering from the extreme cold that is produced by evaporation from
a moist and wet surface, is the most absurd, dangerous, and injurious
practice that can be imagined. It is worse, when the post-horse or the
plow-horse is plunged up to his belly in the river or pond immediately
after his work.


Cutting the Hair from the Heels.

Custom has very properly retained the hair on our farm-horses. Nature
would not have given it had it not been useful. It guards the heel from
being injured by the inequalities of the plowed field, and prevents the
dirt, in which the heels are constantly enveloped, from reaching, and
caking on, and irritating the skin. When the horse is carefully tended
after his work is over, and his legs quickly and completely dried, the
less hair he has about them the better, for then both the skin and the
hair can be made perfectly dry before evaporation begins, or proceeds so
far as to deprive the legs of their heat. Grease is the child of
negligence and mismanagement.


Setons

Are pieces of tape or cord, passed, by means of an instrument resembling
a large needle, either through abscesses, or the base of ulcers with
deep sinuses, or between the skin and the muscular or other substances
beneath. They are retained there by the ends being tied together, or by
a knot at each end. The tape is moved in the wound twice or thrice in
the day, and occasionally wetted with spirits of turpentine, or some
acrid fluid, in order to increase the inflammation which it produces,
or the discharge which is intended to be established.

_In abscesses_, such as occur in the withers or the poll, and when
passed from the summit to the very bottom of the swelling, setons are
highly useful by discharging the purulent fluid, and suffering any fresh
quantity of it that may be secreted to flow out; and, by the degree of
inflammation which they excite on the interior of the tumor, stimulating
it to throw out healthy granulations, which gradually occupy and fill
the hollow. In deep fistulous wounds they are indispensable, for except
some channel is made through which the matter may flow from the bottom
of the wound, it will continue to penetrate deeper into the part, and
the healing process will never be accomplished. On these accounts, a
seton passing through the base of the ulcer in poll-evil and fistulous
withers is so beneficial.

"Setons are sometimes useful by promoting a discharge in the
neighborhood of an inflamed part, and thus diverting and carrying away a
portion of the fluids which distend or overload the vessels of that
part; thus, a seton is placed with considerable advantage in the cheek,
when the eyes are much inflamed."--(_Youatt._)


Founder,

Or inflammation of the foot, arises from various causes; excessive
exertion, great heat, and particularly when followed by drinking cold
water, or overloading the stomach in any way, sudden transition from
great cold to excessive heat, and change of inflammation from some other
part.

_Remedies._--When the attack is severe and confined to the fore-feet,
Youatt recommends removing the shoe and paring the hoof as much as
possible, taking four quarts of blood from each toe, placing the feet in
warm water, and afterwards applying soft poultices of linseed meal to
the whole foot and pastern. If this is ineffectual, take three quarts of
blood from each foot the succeeding day. It may then be necessary to
blister the foot and coronet. The animal should be kept on green food or
light mashes, and allowed to run on grass without labor. An effectual
cure has followed from taking off the shoe, and applying lard, raised to
the boiling point, to every part of the foot.


Poison

From weeds, sometimes gives to horses ulcerated tongues and lips, and
swollen legs and sheath. If there be much inflammation, bleeding should
be resorted to, then give daily bran mashes, with Glauber salts in doses
of 1/2 to 11/2 pounds, according to the size of the horse, with half a
teaspoonful of saltpetre. Washing the ulcerated parts with warm
soap-suds, copperas, and sugar-of-lead may follow.


Epidemics among Horses,

Sometimes occur, producing great mortality. One of these was prevalent
in the neighborhood of New York, in 1846, termed a _malarious congestive
fever_, staggers, or apoplexy, which destroyed many valuable animals. It
occurred during the heat of summer, and was principally confined to such
as were at pasture. By many it was attributed to excessive heat and
exposure at night. The animals that were opened, appeared sound in all
respects excepting the brain, which exhibited one mass of clotted blood.

The _remedy_ found to be the most effectual, consisted in taking about
one quart of blood from the head, swathing it with cloths saturated with
cold water, and giving two drachms daily of calomel. The horse should be
kept in a cool stable.

A similar disease in Spain is cured by copious bleeding, and swathing
the head in blankets constantly wet with hot water.


Inflammation of the Eyes.

Shut up in a dark stable, and feed on fresh-cut grass and bran mashes.
Bleed freely from the mouth, and give 11/2 lbs. Glauber salts, 2 drachms
nitre, and 15 grains tartarized antimony, dissolved in a bucket of
water, which the animal will drink when thirsty. This to be repeated
daily till purging is effected. If it fails, bleed from the large veins
just below the eye, taking 15 to 20 ounces of blood.--(_Dr. Campbell._)


The Sting of Hornets,

Bees, or snakes, may be relieved by immediate external application of
strong spirits of hartshorn: salt and vinegar are also good.


For Sprains,

Take a mixture of one ounce sweet oil, four ounces spirits of hartshorn,
half an ounce oil of thyme, and rub with it frequently. The remedies
mentioned below are also effectual for sprains.


For a Bruise or Blow.

Apply hot water a long time with wet cloths. Beef brine is an excellent
lotion for both sprains and bruises. A veteran among horses, claims,
that it will almost set a joint or heal a fracture. Wormwood or tansy
lotions are also good.


Fistula.

This is frequently cured by repeated applications of salt.


Wounds

Should be washed twice a day with clean, soft water, or with a little
Castile soap added, and then rub with whale-oil. This answers for all
seasons, keeps off flies, restores the hair, and of the original color.


Galls,

Or wounds on the back from the saddle, are most effectually healed by
white-lead, moistened with sweet-oil or milk. The saddle ought always to
fit easily and be well padded, and it should be taken off and the
animal's back washed at every baiting.


Shoeing.

This is an important operation, and should never be attempted but under
the supervision of an experienced person; nor ought the shoes to remain
so long as to produce contraction of the hoof, which is followed by
lameness and corns. They should be reset as often as every five or six
weeks.


Contraction of the Foot.

This is also caused by standing on the dry stable for some days. In this
case, the hoof should be stopped with fresh cow-manure and clay, or with
a thick felt, soaked in water, and cut to suit the foot. This is also a
good application over night, for horses that have accomplished a hard
day's work on a dry road.


Litter.

This is not objectionable to the feet, if clean and not too damp. Some
suppose this the cause of contraction, but it is the reverse. It is
besides of great benefit when shook out for a bed, by inducing the
horse to rest himself. He is thus enabled to do more work, and with a
less expenditure of food.


Corns.

In the angle between the bars and the quarters, the horn of the sole has
sometimes a red appearance, and is more spongy and softer than at any
other part. The horse flinches when this portion of the horn is pressed
upon, and occasional or permanent lameness is produced. This disease of
the foot is termed _corns_; bearing this resemblance to the corn of the
human being, that it is produced by pressure, and is a cause of
lameness. When corns care neglected, so much inflammation is produced in
that part of the sensible sole, that suppuration follows, and to that,
_quittor_ succeeds, and the matter either undermines the horny sole, or
is discharged at the coronet.

_Remedies._--The cure of old corns is difficult; for as all shoeing has
some tendency to produce pressure here, the habit of throwing out this
diseased horn is difficult to get rid of when once contracted; recent
corns, however, will yield to good shoeing. The first thing to be done
is well to pare out the angle between the crust and the bars. Two
objects are answered by this; the extent of the disease will be
ascertained, and one cause of it removed. A very small drawing-knife
must be used for this purpose. The corn must be pared out to the very
bottom, taking care not to wound the sole. It may then be discovered
whether there is any effusion of blood or matter underneath. If this is
suspected, an opening must be made through the horn, the matter
evacuated, the separated horn taken away, the course and extent of the
sinuses explored, and introduce into them a _saturated solution of
sulphate of zinc_, by means of a small syringe. Place over this dressing
the common cataplasm, or the turpentine ointment, and renew the
application every twenty-four hours. Three or four such applications
complete a cure.

Should there be no collection of fluid, the butyr of antimony should be
applied over the whole extent of the corn, after the horn has been
thinned as closely as possible. The object of this is to stimulate the
sole to throw out more healthy horn. In bad cases, a bar-shoe may be put
on, so chambered that there shall be no pressure on the diseased part.
This may be worn for one or two shoeings, but not constantly, for there
are few frogs that would bear the constant pressure of the bar-shoe;
and the want of pressure on the heel, generally occasioned by their use,
would produce a softened and bulbous state of the heels, that would of
itself be an inevitable source of lameness. Turning out to grass, after
the horn is a little grown, first with a bar-shoe, and afterwards with
the shoe fettered on one side, or with tips, will often be serviceable.
A horse that has once had corns to any considerable extent should, at
every shoeing, have the seat of corn well pared out, and the butyr of
antimony applied.


An Over-reach

Is a tread upon the heel of the coronet of the fore foot, by the shoe of
the corresponding hind foot, and either inflicted by the toe, or by the
inner edge of the inside of the shoe.

_The preventive treatment_ is the bevelling, or rounding off of the
inside edge or rim of the hind shoes.

_The cure_ is the cutting away of the loose parts, the application of
Friar's balsam, and protection from the dirt.


Forging, or Clicking,

"Is a singular species of over-reaching. The horse, in the act of
trotting, strikes the toes of the hind shoes against the fore one. This
noise of the clicking is unpleasant, and the trick or habit is not
altogether free from danger. It is most frequent in young horses, and is
attributable to too great activity, or length of stride in the hind
legs.

_Remedies._--The rider may do something by keeping the head of the horse
well up; but the smith may effect more by making the hind shoes of
clicking horses short in the toe, and having the web broad. When they
are too long, they are apt to be torn off; when too narrow, the hind
foot may bruise the sole of the fore one, or may be locked fast between
the branches of the fore shoe."--_Youatt._


The Bearing Rein

Is a matter of much controversy; some claiming that it should be
entirely abolished, while others as strenuously contend for its almost
universal use. Nimrod, who is deemed perfectly competent authority,
insists on its use with fast roadsters and coach-horses. With
team-horses, it may generally be dispensed with, and always should be in
ascending hills, as it materially diminishes their capacity for
exertion. The fault in its use is its excessive tightness, and when
standing, the horse ought never to be tormented with it.

[Illustration: Fig. 30.

Safety Rein illustrated.]

_Directions for use of Safety Rein._--In putting on the rein for a gig,
keep the buckle to the left hand, or near side; that will place the
loop, which is on the middle of the rein, below the hook or head of the
bridle, which prevents it from being thrown out by the motion of the
horse's head. For a pair of horses, keep the two short chapes outmost,
and the loops on the middle downward. For saddle, keep the buckle to the
left hand.

When the rein is used either for running, rearing, kicking, or going
backward, it should be applied suddenly with a strong arm, keeping up
the pressure until the horse is still; it should then be relieved
suddenly, at the same time motioning the horse to go on. If he is only a
runaway he will obey it at once, such horses being generally of a
willing, good temper. After the horse has been a few times firmly
gripped with it, use it occasionally, instead of the bit-rein, to stop
him on ordinary occasions; this will remind the horse of his subjection,
and will accustom the rider or driver to the ready and accurate use of
it in case of an emergency.


The Bit

Is a frequent cause of injury to the mouth of the horse, fretting and
teasing him, and in many cases inducing permanent injury and
viciousness. It should never be made annoying to the horse beyond the
absolute necessity for his proper restraint.


An Unruly Stud may be controlled

By passing the rein from the ring on the off-side over the head and
through the left ring. This gives a purchase to the groom which the
horse cannot resist.


Blinds

Have for a long time been fashionable, but in few cases are necessary,
while in nearly all they are decidedly injurious.

[Illustration: Fig. 31.

The Crib Biter.]


The Crib Biter.

This small instrument is made entirely of iron, and riveted firmly to
the head-stall. It answers the threefold purpose, to prevent biting,
crib-biting, and wind-sucking. All of the foregoing are bad habits for
horses, for which there is no effectual cure, but in adopting the use of
the above implement.


The Stable

Is an important matter connected with the proper management of horses.
This should be as much as possible of a uniform temperature, cool in
summer, warm in winter, and always clean, dry, and well-ventilated. But
no air must be allowed to blow directly upon the animal. The horse is a
native of a warm climate, and ought to be well protected against cold.
The stable should be neither too light nor too dark, nor must the light
ever be admitted before the eye of the horse. For judicious and extended
arrangement of stables, and management of horses, the inquiring reader
is referred to _Stewart's Stable Economy_.




CHAPTER VI.

THE ASS, THE MULE, AND THE COMPARATIVE LABOR OF WORKING ANIMALS.


THE ASS

Is a native of Arabia, Persia, and the central parts of Asia and Africa.
Like the horse, he goes in troops and displays great natural sagacity,
activity, and courage. Job says, "He scorneth the multitude of the city,
neither regardeth the crying of the driver." Like the horse, too, he has
from time immemorial been tamed, and become the faithful servant of man;
but unlike him, he is subject to few maladies, is hardy and enduring,
and subsists and even thrives on coarse and scanty forage. Thus Job says
of his natural haunts, "Whose house I have made the _wilderness_, and
the _barren land_ his dwellings; the range of the _mountains_ is his
pasture, and he searcheth after _every green thing_." Xenophon, in his
Anabasis, a thousand years later, says of one of the Asiatic deserts
through which he passed with the army of Cyrus, "that it was full of
wormwood; if any other kinds of shrubs or reeds grew there, they had all
an aromatic smell; but no trees appeared. Of wild creatures, the most
numerous are _wild asses_, which our horses sometimes chased; but the
wild asses exceeded them much in speed."


Varieties.

The different breeds of asses are supposed to be quite as numerous as
those of the horse. Four distinct races are mentioned in the earliest
scriptures. In modern times we find a similar diversity. There are two
kinds in Persia, the largest a slow, heavy brute, used only for burdens;
the other smaller and more spirited, and used for the saddle. In Egypt,
a considerable though less marked difference exists, those near the
Delta being inferior to those which are bred in Upper Egypt and Nubia.
In Spain, a difference in size and spirit prevails, greater even than in
Persia.

The _Zebra_ is nearly allied in size, shape, and character to the wild
ass, but his untameable ferocity has hitherto effectually bid defiance,
alike to the scourges and caresses, the frowns and the favors of man.

Arabia produces some of the most spirited and hardy asses, but their
size, like that of their horses, is too small for purposes of the
greatest utility. The Maltese Jack is by American breeders deemed the
choicest animal from which to propagate. He is evidently of Arabian
descent, and possesses all the good qualities of his ancestry, with
considerable additional size.

We have several varieties, all of which are imported, as there are no
natives of the Western Continent. The early importations were
principally made from the Azores, and Cape de Verd Islands, and were
mostly of an inferior character. A superior Maltese Jack was presented
to Gen. Washington, in 1787, by La Fayette, and is believed to be the
first ever sent to this country. Mr. Custis describes him as of moderate
size, clean-limbed, possessing great activity, the fire and ferocity of
a tiger, of a dark brown and nearly black, with white belly and muzzle,
and manageable only by one groom, nor then safely. He lived to a great
age. His mules were all active, spirited, and serviceable, and when from
stout mares, attained considerable size.

A Spanish Jack and Jennet were also presented to Washington about the
same time, by the King of Spain. The first is characterized by the same
authority, as a huge, ill-shapen animal, nearly 16 hands high, very
large head, clumsy limbs, and to all appearance little calculated for
active service; he was of a gray color, and not much valued for his
mules, which were unwieldy and dull. From the Maltese Jack and Spanish
Jennet, which approach the size of the large Spanish Jack, was bred a
valuable animal, _Compound_, which partook of all the good qualities of
the sire, with the weight of the dam. From him descended many of the
best mules of Mount Vernon.

Many other valuable importations followed these animals, and it is
believed we have for many years had as fine specimens of the ass as the
world affords.

Jennets, or she-asses, are used among us principally for breeding Jacks,
and of course are not numerous. They are sometimes, though seldom, bred
to the horse. It is difficult to induce the horse to notice them, and
the produce, which is called a _hinny_, is less hardy and useful than
the mule. The milk of the she-ass is lighter and more digestible than
that of any other animal, and in former times was in great request for
invalids.

The ass is occasionally used in the cart, or as a beast of burden. Such
as are employed for these purposes are generally of an inferior kind,
and are only used for the lightest work. They may sometimes be seen
among the fishmongers and small vegetable dealers about our city
markets, but little larger than a Newfoundland dog or Shetland pony,
trundling along a light cart with a wheelbarrow load. In ancient times
they have been, and in foreign countries--even at the present time, they
are extensively used. But the most enlightened of the moderns have
adopted the mule as the proper and almost exclusive substitute for the
ass; and it would show a still greater intelligence and economy, if it
much more extensively took the place of the horse.


THE MULE

Is the hybrid produced by the ass with the mare. How early this animal
was bred, is uncertain, but we know he was in high repute in the reign
of David, near 3,000 years ago, for he was rode by Absalom, the favorite
prince of Israel, on the field of battle. They have from time immemorial
been bred in various parts of the East, on the borders of the
Mediterranean, and throughout Spain, Portugal, and other countries, many
of them being of splendid appearance and of fine qualities. In these
countries, they are frequently used by the grandees and nobles, and
indeed by royalty itself; and however much they may be undervalued
elsewhere, when they are finely bred and trained, and richly
caparisoned, they exhibit a stateliness and bearing, that few of the
highest bred horses can match.


Breeding Mules in the United States,

Was commenced with much spirit in some of the New England states, soon
after the American revolution. The object was not to breed them for
their own use, but only as an article of commerce. They were at first
shipped exclusively to the West Indies; and afterwards to the South and
West, for employment in the various work of the plantation. Indifferent
animals, both as sires and dams, were used at first, as any thing which
bore the name of mule, then commanded a ready sale. The progeny were
necessarily inferior brutes, and viewed with almost universal derision;
and being considered the type of their race, a prejudice was excited
against them, which more than half a century has not been sufficient to
dispel.

Among a few thinking men at the North, they have been adopted and made
highly useful in the various duties of the farm. They have been largely
introduced at the South and West, but principally in the slave states,
where the management of the team devolves upon the ignorant and
heedless. It is there, and in other and hotter climates, that the
superior merits of the mule over the horse as a laboring animal, are
peculiarly manifest. In many instances they are indifferently fed,
hardly worked, and greatly neglected by their drivers; yet they sustain
themselves for years, in defiance of usage that would annihilate two
generations of horses. Their powers have been largely increased and
their merits improved, by the introduction of some of the best Maltese
and Spanish Jacks, and the use of large, blood mares. The propriety of
this course is seen in the value of the product; for while some of the
inferior are unsaleable at $50, others of the same age, and reared under
the same circumstances of keep and condition, could not be purchased for
$150.


The Breeding, Rearing, and Management of Mules

Is similar to that of colts. They will be found, equally with horses, to
repay generous keep and attention, by their increased and rapid growth.
But they should not be pampered by high feed, as it not only has a
tendency to produce disease, but to form habits of fastidiousness, which
materially lessens their economical feeding in after life. The diseases
to which mules are subjected, (which are always few, and if properly
managed will seldom or ever occur,) require a treatment like that of
horses.

_The breeding from mules_ has sometimes been questioned, but it has been
demonstrated in several instances. Neither the sexual development nor
propensities are wanting, but they are seldom indulged with effect. Mr.
Kilby, of Virginia, states in the Farmer's Register, that a mare mule
brought two colts from a young horse, which they closely resembled. The
first was a male, and died, apparently with staggers, which no treatment
could arrest, at six months old. The second was a female, 16 months
younger than the first, marked like the sire, being jet-black,
excepting a white foot and star in the forehead, and died at a year old,
after two days' illness, notwithstanding the utmost care was bestowed
upon it. Successful propagation of this hybrid, however, beyond the
first cross, seems to be incompatible with the fixed laws of nature.

With a view of encouraging the substitution of mules for a part of the
horses now employed in American husbandry, we give the following
testimony from experienced individuals, of great intelligence and
careful observation.


ADVANTAGES OF MULE OVER HORSE LABOR.

The official report of an agricultural committee in South Carolina, in
1824, says:--"The annual expense of keeping a horse is equal to his
value. A horse at four years old would not often bring more than his
cost. Two mules can be raised at less expense than one horse. The mule
is fit for service earlier, and if of sufficient size, will perform as
much labor as the horse; and if attended to when first put to work, his
gait and habits may be formed to suit the owner."

Mr. Pomeroy, who used them near Boston for 30 years, and to such an
extent as to have had more labor performed by them probably than any
person in New England, says:--"I am convinced the small breed of mules
will consume less in proportion to the labor they are capable of
performing than the larger race, but I shall confine myself to the
latter in my comparison, such as stand 141/2 to 16 hands, and are capable
of performing any work a horse is usually put to. From repeated
experiments, I have found that three mules of this description, which
were constantly at work, consumed about the same quantity of hay, and
only one-fourth the provender, which was given to two middling-size
coach-horses, only moderately worked. I am satisfied a large-sized mule
will not consume more than three-fifths to two-thirds the food to keep
him in good order, that will be necessary for a horse performing the
same labor. The expense of shoeing a mule the year round, does not
exceed one-third that of the horse, his hoofs being harder, more horny,
and so slow in their growth, that shoes require no removal, and hold on
till worn out; and the wear from the lightness of the animal is much
less.

Mules have been lost by feeding on cut straw and corn meal; in no other
instance have I known disease in them, except by inflammation of the
intestines, caused by the grossest exposure to cold and wet, and
excessive drinking cold water, after severe labor, and while in a high
state of perspiration. It is not improbable a farmer may work the same
team of mules for twenty years, without having a farrier's bill
presented to him.

In my experience of thirty years, I have never found but one mule
inclined to be vicious, and he might have been easily subdued while
young. I have always found them truer pullers and quicker travellers,
with a load, than horses. Their vision and hearing are much more
accurate. I have used them in my family carriage, in a gig, and under
the saddle; and have never known one to start or run from any object or
noise, a fault in the horse, that continually causes the maiming and
death of numerous human beings.

The mule is more steady in his draught, and less likely to waste his
strength than the horse, hence more suitable to work with oxen; and as
he walks faster, he will habituate them to a faster gait. In plowing
among crops, his feet being small and following each other so much more
in a line, he seldom treads down the ridges or crops. The facility of
instructing him to obey implicitly the voice of the driver is
astonishing. The best plowed tillage land I ever saw, I have had
performed by two mules tandem, without lines or driver. The mule is
capable of enduring labor in a temperature of heat that would be
destructive to a horse.

Although a large mule will consume something over one-half the food of a
horse, yet the saving in shoeing, farrying, and insurance against
diseases and accidents, will amount to at least one-half. In addition,
the owner may rely with tolerable certainty on the continuance of his
mule capital for thirty years; whereas the horse owner must, at the end
of fifteen years, look to his crops, his acres, or a bank for the
renewal of his. The longevity of a mule is so proverbial, that a
purchaser seldom inquires his age. Pliny mentions one 80 years old; and
Dr. Rees, two in England, that reached the age of 70. I saw one
performing his labor in a cane-mill in the West Indies, which the owner
assured me was 40 years old. I have now a mare-mule 25 years old, that I
have had in constant work for 21 years. She has often within a year
taken a ton weight in a wagon to Boston, five miles, and manifests no
diminution of her powers. A neighbor has one 28 years old, which he
would not exchange for any horse in the country. One in Maryland, 35
years old, is now as capable of labor as at any former period."

Mr. Hood of Maryland, in the American Farmer, estimates the annual
expense of a horse for 12 months, at $44, and that of a mule at $22,
just half price, and his working age at more than twice that of the
horse, and that too after 30 years' experience in keeping both.

A correspondent of the Baltimore Patriot, asserts that "Col. John E.
Howard had a pair of mules that worked 30 years, after which they were
sold to a carter in the city, and performed hard service for several
years longer. Many mules 25 years old, and now in this country, perform
well. Many have been at hard work for 12 or 15 years, and would now sell
for $100 each. They are not subject to the colt's ailments, the
glanders, heaves, yellow-water, and colic, like horses; and seldom are
afflicted with spavin, ringbones, or bots; and they will not founder."

General Shelby says, "he has known mules to travel 12 miles within the
hour in light harness, and has himself driven a pair 45 miles in six
hours, stopping an hour by the way." Four match mules have been sold in
this country for $1,000. They were of course superior animals, and made
elegant coach-horses. These animals were driven 80 miles in a day
without injury; and they proved a first-rate team for many years.

Mr. Ellicott, of the Patuxent Furnaces, asserts that, "out of about 100
mules at the works, we have not lost on an average one in two years.
Bleeding at the mouth will cure them of nearly every disease, and by
being turned out on pasture, they will recover from almost every
accident. I do not recollect we have ever had a wind-broken one. They
are scarcely ever defective in the hoof, and though kept shod, it is not
as important as with the horse. Their skin is tougher than that of the
horse, consequently they are not as much worried by flies, nor do they
suffer so much with the heat of summer."

To the foregoing testimony may be added that of the late Judge Hinckley
of Massachusetts; a shrewd and close observer through a long life of 84
years. He bred mules at an early day, and always kept a team of them for
his farm work, much preferring them to horses for this purpose, after an
experience of 50 years. He had a pair nearly 30 years old, which, with
light pasturage in summer, and with a moderate supply of hay with little
grain in winter, and no grooming, performed all the drudgery, though he
kept his stable full of horses besides. They outlived successive
generations of horses, and though the latter were often sick and out of
condition, the mules never were. One from his stock, 45 years old, was
sold for the same price paid for a lot of young mules, being at that
mature age perfectly able to perform his full share of labor.

For the caravans that pass over the almost inaccessible ranges which
form the continuation of the Rocky Mountains, and the extensive arid
plains that lie between and west of them, on the route from Santa Fe to
California, mules are the only beasts of burden used in these exhausting
and perilous adventures. Their value may be estimated from the
comparative prices of mules and horses; for while a good horse may be
bought for $10 to $20, a good mule is worth $50 to $75.

Dr. Lyman, who recently passed through those regions, informs us that
their caravan left Santa Fe with about 150 mules, 15 or 20 horses, all
beasts of burden, and two choice blood-horses, which were led and
treated with peculiar care. On the route, all the working-horses died
from exhaustion and suffering; the two bloods that had been so carefully
attended, but just survived; yet of the whole number of mules but 8 or
10 gave out. A mule 36 years of age was as strong, enduring, and
performed as hard labor, as any one in the caravan. When thirst
compelled them to resort for successive days to the saline waters, which
are the only ones furnished by those sterile plains, the horses were at
once severely, and not unfrequently fatally affected; while the mules,
though suffering greatly from the change, yet seldom were so much
injured as to require any remission of their labor.

The mules sent to the Mexican possessions from our western states,
Missouri, Tennessee, and Kentucky, are considered of much more value
than such as are bred from the native (usually wild) mares. The
difference probably arises, in part, from the Mexicans using jacks so
inferior to most of the stock animals used by the citizens of those
states.

Mare mules are estimated in those regions at one-third more than horse
mules. The reason assigned for this is, that after a day's journey of
excessive fatigue, there is a larger quantity of blood secreted in the
bladder, which the female, owing to her larger passage, voids at once,
and without much apparent suffering, while the male does not get rid of
it, frequently, till after an hour of considerable pain. The effect of
this difference is seen in the loss of flesh and strength in the male to
an extent far beyond that of the female.

_The method of reducing refractory mules_ in the northern Mexican
possessions, is for the person to grasp them firmly by the ears, while
another whips them severely on the fore-legs and belly.

_Estimated annual saving to the United States from the employment of
mules in the place of horses._--To sum up the advantages of working
mules over horses, we shall have as advantages: 1. They are more easily,
surely, and cheaply raised. 2. They are maintained, after commencing
work, for much less than the cost of keeping horses. 3. They are not
subject to many of the diseases of the horse, and to others only in a
mitigated degree, and even these are easily cured in the mule. 4. They
attain a greater age, and their average working years are probably twice
that of the horse.

In 1840, there were reported to be 4,335,669 horses and mules in the
Union, no discrimination having been made between them. Suppose the
total number at the present time is 4,650,000, and that of these 650,000
are mules. If we deduct one-fourth, supposed to be required for the
purposes of breed, fancy-horses, &c., we shall have 3,000,000 horses,
whose places may be equally well supplied by the same number of mules.
We have seen that Mr. Hood, of Maryland, estimates the expense of a
working horse at $44 per annum, (not an over estimate for the Atlantic
states,) while that of the mule is $22. The difference is $22, which it
is proper to reduce to meet the much lower rate of keeping at the West.
If we put the difference at $10, we shall find the saving in the keep,
shoeing, farriery, &c., by substituting mules for the 3,000,000 horses
that can be dispensed with, will be $30,000,000 per annum. But this is
not all.

The working age of the horse will not exceed an average of eight years,
while that of the mule is probably over sixteen. To the difference of
keep, then, must be added the annual waste of the capital invested in
the animal. A mule is more cheaply raised to working age than a horse,
but allowing them to cost equally, we shall have the horse exhausting
one-eighth of his capital annually for his decay, when the mule is using
up but one-sixteenth; and if we allow $48 as the first cost of both
animals, we shall find the horse wasting $6 annually for this item,
while the mule deteriorates but $3, making an additional item of
$9,000,000. This will give an aggregate of $39,000,000, as the annual
saving to the United States by substituting good mules for three-fourths
of the horses now used in this country. When will our farmers have the
good sense to make this change? It may be fairly answered, when they
shall prefer utility, interest, and a just taste, to a diseased fancy;
for though we admit the superiority in appearance of the race of horses
over mules, we deny that a bad horse looks better or even as well as a
good mule; and with the same keep and attention, a good mule will
outwork and outlook most horses of any breed.


The comparative Economy of Horse and Ox Labor.

This is a question which has been often discussed, and when with candor,
the conclusion has generally been in favor of ox-labor. The different
employments, the variety of situation, the season, and the kind of stock
reared on the farm, are all questions which should be fully considered
in arriving at their true comparative advantages. Most farmers would
find it for their interest to keep teams of each, where there is
employment for more than one; or if this be not the case, the preference
should be given to that which is best suited in all respects to their
particular position.

If work upon the road is required, a horse team will generally be best.
Their superiority will consist principally in their greater speed; for
even with a heavy load, they will be able to trot occasionally, and when
driven without it, they may increase their pace to nearly double the
natural gait of the ox. This will amount to a large annual saving in the
time of the driver when steadily employed. The same is true when
removing manures or crops on the farm to remote distances, over a smooth
surface, which admits of trotting with the empty wagon. Harrowing ought
always to be done with a quick team, as a violent stroke of the teeth
breaks the clods and pulverizes the earth much better than when slowly
dragged.

But we should assume in this comparison, that oxen shall not only be
well adapted to their work by their natural formation, like the
Hereford, the Devon, and others equally good, but also that they be well
trained, well managed, accustomed to quick movements, and as well fed
and looked after as horses. We shall then find their walk equal to a
quick horse team, and that in this case the horse will have no advantage
over the ox in harrowing. For plowing, the teams are on a par, as a good
ox team will do as much in a day in cool weather as horses.

_The situation of the farm_ may materially affect this estimate. In a
warm climate, horses, and more especially mules, would be more
serviceable than oxen, as they are capable of enduring much greater
heat with impunity. If the farm be small and convenient to market, the
labor may, in general, be best accomplished by oxen, as little
travelling will be required. So, too, if the land be stony or rough, the
plowing and harrowing will be more kindly and patiently done by oxen
than by spirited horses. Other considerations will suggest themselves as
affecting the comparative economy of this labor.

_The time of work_ is to be fully considered. If much and heavy work be
required in summer, as is often the case in plowing extensive wheat
farms, horses are to be preferred; yet if the ox-team be started at
early dawn, and worked briskly four or five hours, and then turned out
to rest with a supply of suitable food, they may again commence when the
extreme heat has abated, and accomplish a day's work that few horses
will exceed. During the season of muddy roads, the horse, with his
broad, compact foot, and longer leg, has a decided advantage over the
ox. If the ox draws by the yoke, (which on the whole is the best mode,)
he is liable to a sore neck when working in wet or snowy weather, and at
such times he is overmatched by his competitor.

_The kind of stock raised on the farm_ has an important bearing on this
question. Some farms are devoted to rearing horses, and some exclusively
to rearing cattle. These occasionally remain on hand after they are fit
for market, from the want of a profitable demand. They can then be
employed not only without injury, but in consequence of the thorough
training thus secured, with positive benefit to their future value.

Even if intended for the shambles, the well-developed ox may
advantageously be put to light work at three, after which it may be
gradually increased till he is six or eight, and during all this time he
will be improving. After doing an early spring's work, he may then be
turned on to good pasture, and if followed with proper stall-feeding, he
will in the latter part of the winter or spring yield a tender,
better-flavored, and more profitable carcass, than can be procured by
any other mode of fattening.

The first cost of oxen is less than that of horses, and they are at all
times cheaply reared on the coarser herbage of the farm. The expense of
working-gear, tackle, and shoeing, is much less than with horses. They
are subject to fewer diseases, and these are more within the reach of
ordinary medicines. The cost of food is also less, and while the horse
is depreciating, the ox is increasing in value till eight or nine years
old.

Accidents are less frequent with oxen, from their slower movements; and
when they occur, the ox may be turned out to fatten, and still be worth
as much for this purpose as for the yoke. A permanent injury to the
horse is perhaps a total loss of the beast, with a large farrier's bill
in addition, for which there is nothing to liquidate it but the hide.

The small farmer can make out a most serviceable team, by putting a
single horse before a yoke of cattle. If well trained, they will soon
accommodate themselves to each other's pace, and work as advantageously
together as an entire team of either class would do alone.

Bulls are frequently put to the draught, and when they have not other
services that fully test their powers, they cannot be better employed.
Heifers and cows are sometimes worked, but hitherto they have not been
used to any extent in this country. In the absence of other animals,
they might perform light work to advantage, but severe labor would stint
their growth or impair their milk beyond the benefit derived from it.
The _spayed heifer_ is an exception to the foregoing remark, and by many
is esteemed even more useful than an ox of equal weight.

We have no definite statements of the comparative money value of the
labor of oxen and horses. But in England repeated trials have been made,
and while some have discovered no advantage in the employment of oxen
over horses, others have proved them decidedly superior. One Anglesey
farmer found in an experience of three years, with 12 horses and 20
oxen, which accomplished an equal amount of work, that he had saved by
the latter, $1150.

The foregoing facts prove the subject to be one of sufficient
importance, to justify the closest investigation of every farmer to
determine for himself the comparative value of ox, horse, or mule labor.




CHAPTER VII.

SWINE.


The hog is a cosmopolite of almost every zone, though his natural
haunts, like those of the hippopotamus, the elephant, the rhinoceros,
and most of the thick-skinned animals, are in warm climates. They are
most abundant in China, the East Indies, and the immense range of
islands which extends over the whole Southern and Pacific Oceans; but
they are also numerous throughout Europe, from its southern coast to the
Russian dominions within the Arctic.

[Illustration: Fig. 32.

The Wild Boar.]

In the United States, swine have been an object of attention since its
earliest settlement, and whenever a profitable market could be found for
pork abroad, it has been exported to the full extent of the demand. For
near twenty years following the commencement of the general European
wars, soon after the organization of our national government, it was a
comparatively large article of commerce; but from that time, exports
have not been justified to any extent, till within the last two years,
since which, a material reduction in the British import duty on pork,
lard, and hams, has again brought it up as a prominent article of trade
with that country. The recent use which has been made of the carcass in
converting it into lard oil, has still further increased its
consumption.

Swine are reared in very part of the Union, and when properly managed,
always at a fair profit. At the extreme North; in the neighborhood of
large markets; and on such of the Southern plantations as are
particularly suited to sugar or rice, they should not be raised beyond
the number required for the consumption of the coarse or refuse food
produced. Swine are advantageously kept in connection with a dairy or
orchard, as with little additional food besides what is thus afforded,
they can be put into good condition for the butcher. But it is on the
rich bottoms and other lands of the West, where Indian corn is raised in
profusion, and at small expense, that they can be reared in the greatest
numbers and yield the largest profit. The Sciota, Miami, Wabash,
Illinois, and other valleys, and extensive tracts in Kentucky,
Tennessee, Missouri, and some adjoining states, have for many years
taken the lead in the production of swine; and it is probable the
climate and soil, which are peculiarly suited to their rapid growth, as
well as that of their appropriate food, will enable them forever to
remain the leading pork-producers of the North American continent.


Breeds of Swine.

The breeds cultivated in this country are numerous, and like our native
cattle, they embrace many of the best, and a few of the worst to be
found among the species. Great attention has for many years been paid to
their improvement in the Eastern states, and nowhere are there better
specimens than in many of their yards. This spirit has rapidly extended
West and South; and among most of the intelligent farmers who make them
a leading object of attention, on their rich corn grounds, swine have
attained a high degree of excellence. This does not consist in the
introduction and perpetuity of any distinct races, so much as in the
breeding up to a desirable size and aptitude for fattening, from such
meritorious individuals of any breed, or their crosses, as come within
their reach.

Fig. 33, represents an English breed of hogs, a century or more ago:
though coarse and slouch-eared, it is yet the portrait of a tolerable
hog, and far before many of the swine that still maintain their
ascendency in various parts of the European continent. This breed is
nearly extinct, having been crossed successively by the Chinese and
other good breeds, thus diminishing the size and materially improving
its thrift and tendency to fattening. We have few such animals in the
United States, though we have many that are worse.

[Illustration: Fig. 33.

Old English Hog.]

The _Byefield_, some 30 years ago, was a valuable hog in the Eastern
states, and did much good among the species generally. They are white,
with fine curly hair, well made and compact, moderate in size and
length, with broad backs, and at 15 months attaining some 300 to 350
lbs. net.

The _Bedford_ or _Woburn_ is a breed originating with the Duke of
Bedford, on his estate at Woburn, and brought to their perfection,
probably, by judicious crosses of the China hog, on some of the best
English swine. A pair was sent by the duke to this country, as a present
to Gen. Washington, but they were dishonestly sold by the messenger in
Maryland, in which state and Pennsylvania they were productive of much
good at an early day, by their extensive distribution through different
states. Several other importations of this breed have been made at
various times, and especially by the spirited masters of the Liverpool
packet ships, in the neighborhood of New York. They are a large, spotted
animal, well made, and inclining to early maturity and fattening. They
are an exceedingly valuable hog, but are nearly extinct both in England
and this country, as a breed.

The _Leicesters_ are a large, white hog, generally coarse in the bone
and hair, great eaters, and slow in maturing. Some varieties of this
breed differ essentially in these particulars, and mature early on a
moderate amount of food. The crosses with smaller compact breeds, are
generally thrifty, desirable animals. _Other large breeds_ deserving
commendation in this country, are the large _Miami white_, the
_Yorkshire white_, and the _Kenilworth_, each frequently attaining, when
dressed, a weight of 600 to 800 lbs.

[Illustration: Fig. 34.

China Hog.]

The _Chinese_ is among the smaller varieties, and without doubt is the
parent stock of the best European and American swine. They necessarily
vary in appearance, size, shape, and color, from the diversity in the
style of breeding, and the various regions from which they are derived.

The Fig. represents the pure China pig, and is a striking likeness of
many of the imported and their immediate descendants that we have seen
in this country. They are too small an animal for general use, and
require to be mixed with larger breeds to produce the most profitable
carcass for the market. For the purpose of refining the coarse breeds,
no animal has ever been so successful as this. They are fine-boned,
short, and very compact, with bellies almost touching the ground, light
head and ears, fine muzzle, of great docility and quietness, small
feeders, and producing much meat for the quantity of food consumed.

From the rapidity with which generations of this animal are multiplied,
the variety of other breeds on which they are crossed, and the treatment
to which they are subjected, it is not surprising that their descendants
should rapidly assume distinct features. They furnish not only a strong
dash of blood in the best class of large breeds, but in such of the
smaller as have any pretensions to merit, they constitute the greater
part of the improvement. Such are the _Neapolitan_, the _Essex
half-black_, the _Grass breed_, and some others.

[Illustration: Fig. 35.

Berkshire Hog.]

The _Berkshires_ are an ancient English breed, formerly of large size,
slow feeders, and late in maturing. Their color was a buff or sandy
ground, with large black spots, and the feet, lower part of the legs,
and tuft on the tail, buff. The latter color has given place, in most
of the modern age, to white in the same parts. This variation, with the
more important ones of early maturity and good feeding properties, are
by Professor Low ascribed to a Chinese cross, which has added the only
characteristic in which they were before deficient.

They were first introduced and reared as a distinct breed in this
country by Mr. Brentnall, of Orange Co., and Mr. Hawes, of Albany, N.
York. In their hands, and those of other skilful breeders, their merits
were widely promulgated. No other breeds have been so extensively
diffused in the United States, within comparatively so brief a period,
as the Berkshires, since 1832, and they have produced a marked
improvement in many of our former races.

They weigh variously, from 250 to 400 lbs. net, at 16 months, according
to their food and style of breeding; and some full-grown have dressed to
more than 800 lbs. They particularly excel in their hams, which are
round, full, and heavy, and contain a large proportion of lean, tender,
and juicy meat, of the best flavor.

None of our improved breeds afford long, coarse hair or bristles; and it
is a gratifying evidence of our decided improvement in this department
of domestic animals, that our brush-makers are under the necessity of
importing most of what they use from Russia and northern Europe. This
improvement is manifest not only in the hair, but in the skin, which is
soft and mellow to the touch; in the finer bones, shorter head, upright
ears, dishing face, delicate muzzle, and mild eye; and in the short
legs, low flanks, deep and wide chest, broad back, and early maturity.


Breeding.

Swine should not be allowed to breed before 12 or 15 months old, unless
the animals are large and coarse, when they may be put to it somewhat
younger. Not only choice individuals, but such as are well descended,
should be selected for the purpose of breeding. The sow should be in
good condition, but not fat, nor approaching to it; and a proper degree
of exercise is essential to the development of the f[oe]tus and the
health of the parent; for which reason, she should have an extended
range connected with her pen.

The sow goes with young about 114 days. A week before the time comes
round, a comfortable, quiet place should be prepared for her under
cover, and well-protected from cold, if the weather be severe; or if
warm, a range in a pasture with an open shed to retire to, is
sufficient. Too much litter for bedding must be avoided, and no change
or disturbance of the sow permitted, till two or three weeks after
pigging, as the restlessness thereby produced may result in the loss of
the pigs. The sow should be fed only with a small quantity of the
lightest food or thin gruel, for two or three days, nor put on full feed
for a week. If inclined to eat her pigs, she should be fed two or three
times with raw pork or fresh meat. The pigs may be taught to crack oats
or soaked corn after three weeks, and if provided with a trough
inaccessible to the dam, they will soon learn to feed on milk and other
food, preparatory to weaning. This may take place when they are 8 or 10
weeks old; and to prevent injury to the sow, let one or two remain with
her a few days longer, and when finally removed, if her bag appears to
be full, they may be allowed to drain the milk after 20 or 30 hours. The
sow should be restricted to a light, dry diet for a few days at this
period.


Management and Fattening.

There are but two objects in keeping swine, for breeding and for
slaughter, and their management is consequently simple. Those designed
for breeding, should be kept in growing condition, on light food, and
have every advantage for exercise. Such as are destined exclusively for
fattening, ought to be steadily kept to the object.

It is the usual, though a bad practice in this country, to let spring
pigs run at large for the first 15 months, with such food as is
convenient; and if fed at all, it is only to keep them in moderate
growth till the second autumn. They are then put up to fatten, and in
the course of 60 or 90 days are fed off and slaughtered. During this
brief period, they gain from 50 to 100 per cent. more of dressed weight
than in the 15 or 18 months preceding: nor even then do they yield a
greater average weight than is often attained by choice, thrifty pigs,
which have been well-fed from weaning to the age of 8 or 9 months.

Three pigs of the Bedford breed, when precisely 71/2 months old, dressed
230, 235, and 2381/2 lbs. Two of the Berkshire and Leicester breeds, at 9
months, dressed 304 and 310 lbs. Three others of the Berkshire and Grass
breeds, 7 months and 27 days old weighed 240, 250, and 257 lbs. net.
Innumerable instances could be adduced of similar weights, gained
within the same time, with a good breed of animals under judicious
treatment. We have no one accurate account of the food consumed, so as
to determine the relative profit of short or long feeding. But that an
animal must consume much more in 18 or 20 months to produce the same
quantity of dressed meat, which is made by others of 8 or 9 months, does
not admit of a doubt.

We have seen that an ox requires but little more than double the
quantity of food to fatten, that is necessary for supporting existence.
If we apply this principle to swine, and state the quantity of food
which will fatten the pig rapidly, to be three times as great as for the
support of life, we shall find that the pig will fatten in 7 months, on
the same food he would consume to keep him alive for 21. This is based
on the supposition that both animals are of equal size. But the pig that
matures and is slaughtered at 7 months, has only a moderate capacity for
eating. During the early stages of his growth, his size and the
consequent incapacity of the digestive organs, prevent the consumption
of the same quantity which the larger animal requires; and his
accumulating fat, his limited respiration, consequent upon the
compression of his lungs, and his indisposition to exercise, all
conspire to keep the consumption of food within the smallest possible
limit. This result, in the absence of any experiment, must be
conjectural entirely; but we believe that experiments will show, that of
two thrifty pigs from the same litter, one of which is properly fed to
his utmost capacity for 7 months, and the other fed with precisely
double the quantity of similar food for 21 months, the first will yield
more carcass and of a better and more profitable quality than the
latter, which has consumed 100 per cent. the most.

The food is only one item in this calculation. The oldest requires the
most attention, is liable to more accidents and disease, besides the
loss of interest. We are necessarily forced to the conclusion, that by
far the cheapest mode of wintering pigs is in the pork-barrel. We can
readily anticipate one objection to this practice, which is the want of
food at the requisite season of the year to fatten them. This can be
obviated, by reserving enough of the previous year's grain, to keep the
animal in a rapidly thriving state, till the next crop matures
sufficiently to feed.

In the rich corn regions, on its beginning to ripen, as it does in
August, the fields are fenced off into suitable lots, and large herds
are successively turned into them, to consume the grain at their
leisure. They waste nothing except the stalks, which in that region of
plenty are considered of little value, and they are still useful as
manure for succeeding crops; and whatever grain is left by them, leaner
droves which follow, will readily glean. Peas, early buckwheat, and
apples, may be fed on the ground in the same way.

There is an improvement in the character of the grain from a few months'
keeping, which is fully equivalent to the interest of the money and cost
of storage. If fattened early in the season, they will consume less food
to make an equal amount of flesh than in colder weather; they will
require less attention; and generally, early pork will command the
highest price in market.

It is most economical, to provide the swine with a fine clover pasture
to run in during the spring and summer; and they ought also to have
access to the orchard, to pick up all the unripe and superfluous fruit
that falls. They should also have the wash of the house and the dairy,
to which add meal, and sour in large tubs or barrels. Not less than
one-third, and perhaps more, of the whole grain fed to swine, is saved
by grinding and cooking or souring. Yet care must be observed that the
souring be not carried so far as to injure the food by putrefaction. A
mixture of meal and water, with the addition of yeast or such remains of
a former fermentation as adhere to the side or bottom of the vessel, and
exposure to a temperature between 68 deg. and 77 deg. will produce immediate
fermentation.

In this process there are five stages. The _saccharine_, by which the
starch and gum of the vegetables, in their natural condition, are
converted into sugar; the _vinous_, which changes the sugar into
alcohol; the _mucilaginous_, sometimes taking the place of the vinous,
and occurring when the sugar solution, or fermenting principle is weak,
producing a slimy, glutinous product; the _acetic_, forming vinegar,
from the vinous or alcoholic stage; and the _putrefactive_, which
destroys all the nutritive principles and converts them into a poison.
The precise point in fermentation when the food becomes most profitable
for feeding, has not yet been satisfactorily determined; but that it
should stop short of the putrefactive, and probably the full maturity of
the acetic, is certain.

The roots for fattening animals ought to be washed, and steamed or
boiled; and when not intended to be fermented, the meal may be scalded
with the roots. A small quantity of salt should be added. Potatoes are
the best roots for swine; then parsnips; orange or red carrots, white or
Belgian; sugar beets; mangel-wurzel; ruta-bagas; and the white turnips,
in the order mentioned. The nutritive properties of turnips are diffused
through so large a bulk, that we doubt if they can ever be fed to
fattening swine with advantage; and they will barely sustain lift when
fed to them uncooked.

There is a great loss in feeding roots to fattening swine, without
cooking. When unprepared grain is fed, it should be on a full stomach,
to prevent imperfect mastication, and consequent loss of the food. It is
better indeed to have it always before them. The animal machine is an
expensive one to keep in motion, and it should be the object of the
farmer to put his food in the most available condition for its immediate
conversion into fat and muscle.

Swine ought to be kept perfectly dry and clean, and provided with a warm
shelter, to which they can retire at pleasure. This will greatly hasten
the fattening and economize the food. They thrive better and are
generally less subject to disease, when long confined in yards, by
having a clear running stream always accessible, to wallow in. This is
one of the best preventives of vermin and cutaneous diseases. A hog
ought to have three apartments, one each for sleeping, eating, and
evacuations, of which the last may occupy the lowest, and the first the
highest level, so that nothing shall be drained, and as little carried
into the first two as possible. They must be regularly fed three times a
day, and if there is a surplus, it should be removed at once. If they
are closely confined in pens, give them as much charcoal twice a week as
they will eat. This corrects any tendency to disorders of the stomach.
Rotten wood is an imperfect substitute for charcoal.

Graves, scraps, or cracklings, as they are variously called, the
residuum of rough lard or tallow, after expressing the fat, are a good
change and an economical food. Some animal food, although not essential,
is always acceptable to swine. When about to finish them off, many feed
for a few weeks on hard corn. This is proper when slops or indifferent
food has been given, and meal cannot be conveniently procured; but when
fattened on sound roots and meal, it is a wasteful practice, as the
animal thus falls behind his accustomed growth. It is better to give him
an occasional feed of the raw grain, for a change, and to sharpen his
appetite.

_The products furnished by the carcass of swine_ are numerous. Every
part of the animal is used for food, and it admits of a far greater
variety of preparation for the table, than any other flesh. From the
remotest antiquity to the present time, and in every grade of barbarous
and civilized life, it has been esteemed as one of the choicest
delicacies of the epicure.

_Lard-oil_ (_oleine_) has, within a few years, given to pork a new and
profitable use, by which the value of the carcass is greatly increased.
At some of the large pork-packing depots of the West, one-third of the
whole quantity has been thus disposed of. This has withdrawn a large
amount of pork from the market, and prevented the depression which must
otherwise have occurred.

Where the oil is required, the whole carcass, after taking out the hams
and shoulders, is placed in a tub having two bottoms, the upper one
perforated with holes, on which the pork is laid, and then tightly
covered. Steam, at a high temperature, is then admitted into the tub,
and in a short time all the fat is extracted and falls upon the lower
bottom. The remaining mass is bones and scraps. The last is fed to pigs,
poultry, or dogs, or affords the best kind of manure. The bones are
either used for manure, or are converted into animal charcoal, worth
about three cents per pound, which is valuable for various purposes in
the arts. When the object is to obtain lard of a fine quality, the
animal is first skinned, and the adhering fat carefully scraped off. The
oily, viscid matter of the skin is thus avoided. When tanned, the skin
makes a valuable leather. An aggregate weight of 1790 lbs. from four
well-fattened animals, after taking out the hams and shoulders, say
about 400 lbs., gave within a fraction of 1200 lbs. of the best lard.

_Stearine and Oleine._--Lard and all fatty matters consist of three
principles, of which stearine contains the stearic and margaric acids,
both of which, when separated, are solid, and used as inferior
substitutes for wax or spermaceti candles. The other, oleine, is fluid
at a low temperature, and in American commerce, is known as _lard-oil_.
It is very pure, and extensively used for machinery, lamps, and most of
the purposes for which olive or spermaceti oils are used.


Curing Hams and Pork.

After dressing, the carcass should be allowed to hang till perfectly
drained and cool, when it may be cut up and salted. The usual way is to
pack the pork in clean salt, adding brine to the barrel when filled. But
it may be dry salted, by rubbing it in thoroughly on every side of each
piece, with a strong leather rubber firmly secured to the palm of the
right hand. The pieces are then thrown into heaps and sprinkled with
salt, and occasionally turned till cured; or it may at once be packed in
dry casks, which are occasionally rolled to bring the salt into contact
with every part.


Hams and Shoulders

May be cured in the same manner, either dry or in pickle, but with
differently arranged materials. The following is a good pickle for 200
lbs. Take 14 lbs. of Turk Island salt; 1/2 lb. of saltpetre; 2 qts. of
molasses, or 4 lbs. of brown sugar, with water enough to dissolve them.
Bring the liquor to the scalding point, and skim off all the impurities
which rise to the top. When cold, pour it upon the ham, which should be
perfectly cool but not frozen, and closely packed; and if not sufficient
to cover it, add enough pure water for this purpose. Some extensive
packers in Cincinnati and elsewhere, who send choice hams to market, add
pepper, allspice, cinnamon, nutmegs, or mace and cloves.

The hams may remain six or eight weeks in this pickle, then hung up in
the smoke-house, with the small end down, and smoked from 10 to 20 days,
according to the quantity of smoke. The fire should not be near enough
to heat the hams. In Holland and Westphalia, the fire is made in the
cellar, and the smoke carried by a flue into a cool, dry chamber. This
is undoubtedly the best method of smoking. The hams should at all times
be dry and cool, or their flavor will suffer. Green sugar-maple chips
are best for smoke; next to them are hickory, sweet-birch, corn-cobs,
white-ash, or beech.

The smoke-house is the best place to keep hams till wanted. If removed,
they should be kept cool, dry, and free from flies. A canvass-cover for
each, saturated with lime, which may be put on with a whitewash brush,
is a perfect protection against flies. When not to be kept long, they
may be packed in dry salt, or even in sweet brine, without injury. A
common method is to pack in dry oats, baked sawdust, &c.


DISEASES OF SWINE.

Mortifying as the fact may be to human pride, it is nevertheless
certain, that the internal arrangements, the viscera, digestive organs,
omnivorous propensities, and the general physiological structure of the
hog and the bear, more nearly resemble man, than any other animal. Many
of their diseases may therefore be expected to be a modification of
those of the human species, and require a similar treatment.

[Illustration: Fig. 36.

Skeleton of a Pig.

A Maxilla inferior, vel posterior; lower jaw.--B Dentes; the teeth.--C
Ossa nasi; the nasal bones.--D Maxilla superior, vel anterior; upper
jaw.--E Os frontis; the frontal bone.--F Orbiculus; the orbit or socket
of the eye.--G Os occipitis; the occipital bone.--H Atlas; the first
vertebra of the neck.--I Vertebrae colli, vel cervicales; the vertebrae of
the neck.--J Vertebrae dorsi, vel dorsales; the vertebrae of the back.--K
Vertebrae lumborum, vel lumbales; the vertebrae of the loins.--L Ossa
coccygis; the bones of the tail.--_a_ Scapula; the shoulder-blade.--_b_
Humerus; the round shoulder-bone.--_c_ Sternum; the breastbone.--_d_
Ulna; the elbow.--_e_ Radius; the bone of the fore-arm.--_f_ Os
naviculare: the navicular bone.--_g_ Phalanges vel ossa pedis; the first
and second bones of the foot.--_h_ Phalanges, vel ossa pedis; the bones
of the hoof.--_i_ Pelvis, (ossa innorninata;) the haunch bones.--_j_ Os
femoris; the thigh-bone.--_k_ Patella; the stifle-bone.--_l_ Tibia; the
upper bone of the leg--_m_ Tarsus, (one of which is the (N) os calcis;)
the hock-bones.--_n_ Os naviculare; the navicular bone.--_o_ Digiti, vel
phalanges, (ossa pedis;) the first digits of the foot.--_p_ Digiti, vel
phalanges, (ossa pedis;) the second digits of the foot.]


Pulmonary Affections, Colds, Coughs, and Measles.

To each of these, swine are peculiarly liable, and, as with most other
evils, prevention of disease in swine is more easy and economical than
cure. A dry warm bed, free from winds or storms, and suitable food, will
most effectually prevent any injuries, or fatal attacks. The hog has
little external covering to protect him against cold. Nature has
provided this immediately within the skin, in the deep layer of fat
which surrounds the full, plump hog. Fat is one of the best
non-conductors of heat, and the pig which is well-fed bids defiance to
the intense cold, which would produce great suffering, and consequent
disease, in the ill-conditioned animal. By the observance of a proper
medium between too much fat or lean, for the store or breeding swine,
and providing them with comfortable beds and proper feed, nearly all
diseases will be avoided.

For _Coughs and Inflammation of the Lungs_, bleeding should immediately
be resorted to, after which give gentle purges of castor oil, or Epsom
salts; and this should be followed with a dose of antimonial powders--2
grains, mixed with half a drachm of nitre.

For _Costiveness_ or loss of appetite, sulphur is an excellent remedy,
given in a light mess.

_Itch_ may be cured by anointing with equal parts of lard and brimstone.
Rubbing-posts, and a running stream to wallow in are preventives.

The _Kidney Worm_ is frequently fatal; and always produces weakness of
the loins and hind legs, usually followed by entire prostration. A pig
thus far gone, is hardly worth the trouble of recovering, even where
practicable.

_Preventives_, are general thrift, a range in a good pasture, and a dose
of half a pint of wood-ashes every week or fortnight in their food. A
small quantity of saltpetre, spirits of turpentine, or tar, will effect
the same object. When attacked, apply spirits of turpentine to the
loins, and administer calomel carefully; or give half a tablespoonful of
copperas daily for one or two weeks.


Blind Staggers.

This is generally confined to pigs, and manifests itself in foaming at
the mouth, rearing on their hind legs, champing and grinding their
teeth, and apparent blindness. The proper remedies are bleeding and
purging freely, and these frequently fail. Many nostrums have been
suggested, but few are of any utility. It is important to keep the
issues on the inside of the fore-legs, just below the knee, thoroughly
cleansed.

The _tails_ of young pigs frequently _drop_ or _rot off_, which is
attended with no further disadvantage to the animal than the loss of the
member. The _remedies_ are, to give a little brimstone or sulphur in the
food of the dam; or rub oil or grease daily on the affected parts. It
may be detected by a roughness or scabbiness at the point where
separation is likely to occur.

_Bleeding._--The most convenient mode, is from an artery just above the
knee, on the inside of the fore-arm. It may be drawn more copiously from
the roof of the mouth. The flow of blood may usually be stopped, by
applying a sponge or cloth with cold water.

The diseases of swine, though not numerous, are formidable, and many of
them soon become fatal. They have not been the subject of particular
scientific study, and most of the remedies applied, are rather the
result of casual or hap-hazard suggestion, than of well-digested
inference, from long-continued and accurate observation.




CHAPTER VIII.

FARM-DOGS.


No grazing farm is complete without one or more intelligent,
well-trained dogs, adapted to the various wants of their owners; and the
general taste has made their presence almost universal in every rural
household. The dog is peculiarly the friend of man. Many other animals
have a temporary though feeble attachment to him, which seems the result
rather of constant companionship, or the selfishness of dependence, than
any well-settled affection towards a master.

The dog alone, of all the brute creation, seems capable of a
disinterested, self-sacrificing affection; and this, united with his
usefulness and adaptedness to all climes and countries, has made him a
favorite in every quarter of the globe. Since this animal is the
habitual tenant of the farm, and, when suited to his peculiar duties,
can be made of great utility by the assistance he is capable of
affording in its management, we deem it entirely appropriate to our
subject to indicate such of the species as are deserving the farmer's
attention. Discarding all ideas of fancy or sportsmanship, and looking
to utility alone, we may safely affirm that the farmer needs only such
as may be found in the four breeds of the Newfoundland, the Shepherd's
and Drover's dog, and the Terrier.

[Illustration: Fig. 37.

Newfoundland Dog.]


The Newfoundland Dog.

This dog, of which we give a portrait, is always above medium height,
and frequently is of the largest size. He is long-haired and shaggy, and
has a thick coat of fine, soft fur, beneath the outer covering, which is
almost impenetrable by water. His color is most frequently black; often
spotted and partially flecked or grayish; and occasionally buff. The
Newfoundland is of the Spaniel family, but derives its name from the
island where it has been bred for centuries, to the great advantage of
its inhabitants. There are two varieties: the large, used in the north,
called the Labrador; and the smaller, more docile and intelligent, of
the south, called the St. John's. They are employed by the islanders,
and the people of the neighboring coast, in drawing their sleds and
carts loaded with fish, wood, &c. They aid them in various ways in their
fishing operations; they are strong, courageous, and watchful; and with
slight training, they are scarcely inferior to the best hunting-dogs in
pursuing the wild game that abounds in those high northern latitudes.
These estimable qualities, coupled with their uniform good-nature, have
always made them favorites with the farmer.

The Newfoundland is an excellent watch-dog; sagacious in discriminating
between a friend and a foe, and with courage and strength to follow out
his prompt and judicious conclusions. He is easily trained for the
drover, to whom he is frequently a great assistant; and with a scent
sufficiently acute to pursue game, he is readily broken in as a useful
companion to the sportsman. He can also be made serviceable in the
various duties of the farm: destroying noxious vermin, taking the cattle
and horses to the field or water, drawing a light load, churning the
butter, &c. It is true, he has not all the sagacity of the Poodle, whose
intelligence approaches nearer to human reason than any other of the
brute creation. But if he has not that quick apprehension, which too
often leads, as in the case of forward children, to the attainment of
every worthless accomplishment and the indulgence of every loaferish
habit, he seems to have a sedate, well-formed judgment, which makes all
his wit available for some useful purpose. He is unsurpassed as a
water-dog; and his courageous efforts, wherever an opportunity has been
afforded, in rescuing numberless human beings from a watery grave,
together with his unswerving fidelity and devotion, commend him as the
prince of the canine family.


The Shepherd's Dog.

This animal, of which we give a beautiful portrait on the next page, of
the long-haired Scottish breed, belongs to the same family as the
Newfoundland and Poodle, which embraces the most intelligent and useful
of the canine species. There are two classes of these dogs, which differ
widely in their size and characteristics.

The larger is of great size and courage, and when protected by a stout
leather collar studded with spikes, is a full match for the wolf. These
are used by the Spanish and Mexican shepherds, on their wild sierras, as
effective guards against the attacks of all marauders, and are
essentially the same race as the far-famed dogs of Mount St. Bernard.
They are not sufficiently gentle for guides, and the shepherds who
employ them rely on some well-trained wethers or goats to lead the flock
at their call. Some have been imported into this country, but on account
of their headstrong and ferocious character, and occasional depredations
upon the flocks, they have been found unsuited to our wants, except on
the borders of the wilderness.

The Colley or Scottish sheep-dog, the English, and those extensively
used upon the continent, differ much in their form and appearance, but
agree in their intelligence, docility, and usefulness. They are of
medium size, with a sharp nose, broad forehead, and small upright ear;
they are both shaggy and smooth-haired, with a bushy tail, and much hair
about the neck; variously colored, though more frequently inclined to
black or darkly spotted and gray; and one branch of the family is
entirely destitute of a tail. They possess an instinctive sagacity for
the management of sheep; and in company with a well-trained dog, under
the direction of the shepherd, they soon become entirely competent to
the control of the flock. They perceive his wishes by a word or sign,
and with almost the speed of the greyhound, dart off to execute them.
Accounts of their performances have been frequently related, which seem
almost incredible to those unacquainted with their peculiar character.
The following anecdote, often told by the gifted poet, Mr. James Hogg,
more generally known by the soubriquet of the Ettrick Shepherd, will
show their capacity more fully than any description.

[Illustration: Fig. 38.

Shepherd's Dog]

"On one night, a large flock of lambs that were under the Ettrick
Shepherd's care, frightened by something, scampered away in three
different directions across the hills, in spite of all that he could do
to keep them together. 'Sirrah,' said the shepherd, 'they're a' awa!' It
was too dark for the dog and his master to see each other at any
considerable distance, but Sirrah understood him, and set off after the
fugitives. The night passed on, and Hogg and his assistant traversed
every neighboring hill in anxious but fruitless search for the lambs;
but he could hear nothing of them nor of the dog, and he was returning
to his master with the doleful intelligence that he had lost all his
lambs. 'On our way home, however,' says he, 'we discovered a lot of
lambs at the bottom of a deep ravine called the Flesh Cleuch, and the
indefatigable Sirrah standing in front of them, looking round for some
relief, but still true to his charge. We concluded that it was one of
the divisions which Sirrah had been unable to manage, until he came to
that commanding situation. But what was our astonishment when we
discovered that not one lamb of the flock was missing! How he had got
all the divisions collected in the dark, is beyond my comprehension. The
charge was left entirely to himself from midnight until the rising sun;
and, if all the shepherds in the forest had been there to have assisted
him, they could not have effected it with greater promptitude. All that
I can say is, that I never felt so grateful to any creature under the
sun as I did to my honest Sirrah that morning.'"

They are quiet and good-natured, never inclined to roam or neglect their
duties, and as little disposed to injure the animals intrusted to their
keeping. They have almost the intelligence of the shepherd in discerning
the vagaries of the flock, and ten times his efficiency in driving it.
No extensive sheep-walks, unless closely hemmed in by impassable fences,
should be without one or more of these useful animals.


The Drover's Dog.

This animal is shown in the annexed figure. He is closely allied to the
sheep-dog, from which he derives all his intelligence and capacity,
differing only in being somewhat larger and heavier, which is essential
to his controlling the sturdier bullocks under his charge. His
additional size is acquired by crossing with some of the stouter races,
such as the Newfoundland or the pointer, and even the bull-dog and large
shaggy terrier have sometimes been resorted to for a strain of that
indomitable courage and game, which is frequently requisite to the
proper discharge of his duties. He requires more training than the
sheep-dog, as his peculiar instincts are rather to the management of the
flock than the herd; but when fairly broken in, he is equally expert in
its management. The drover's dog may also be useful for watching, if
crossed with a reference to this object, which the sheep-dog seldom is.

[Illustration: Fig. 39.

Drover's Dog.]


The Terrier.

This, in addition to the foregoing, is the only dog necessary to the
farm. He is needed principally for his great sagacity and indefatigable
perseverance in exterminating rats and other vermin, that frequently
congregate in swarms around the farmer's premises, producing such an
aggregate of annoyance and devastation. Other dogs may occasionally be
good ratters, but the terrier takes to them from instinct, as the
Newfoundland does to the water, or the sheep-dog to his flock. He has
great ingenuity and activity in ferreting out and capturing his prey,
and whenever a fair opportunity is afforded, he seldom fails of success.
The famous English terrier, Billy, on two occasions, killed 100 rats in
a ring at each time, in an average of less than six and a half minutes.

The terrier is usually below the medium size, but sometimes fully comes
up to or even exceeds it. He is smooth-haired or rough according to the
breed, of which there are several, each claiming to be equally pure.
Besides his capacity for the destruction of small game, his innate love
for the sport renders him a valuable assistant in keeping off vagrant
cattle from the premises; and his quick ear, habitual watchfulness, and
prompt courage, fully qualify him, to the extent of his size, for an
excellent watch-dog.

The fancy of country residents may incline them to keep a variety of
other dogs than are herein enumerated, some of which, with good
training, can be made partial assistants to their masters. But it is
unnecessary to specify the various breeds that may possibly be of some
use on the farm, as the slight crossing they will be likely to have,
equally with their opportunities and the attention bestowed upon them,
will serve materially to develop or obscure their peculiar instincts.
The Spaniel family and its crosses will be found to combine the greatest
intelligence, fidelity, and aptitude to learn; the hound has the keenest
scent and greatest endurance in the pursuit of game; while the bull-dog
has the most courage, sullen ferocity, and strength. Each may
occasionally be wanted for a strain of blood for some particular
objects; and this is especially necessary from the bull-dog in the
management of refractory cattle, or to give the terrier greater
stoutness and courage.

The absurd custom of keeping from one to a dozen dogs, untrained for any
valuable purpose, or supernumeraries even if capable of rendering
occasional service, ought to be abandoned by every rational man. Besides
the great annual cost, the danger of communicating rabies or madness is
sufficient to justify a legal restraint on their numbers. The sad havoc
they commit on the flocks, demands the extermination by law of every dog
that is guilty, whether

    Mongrel, puppy, whelp, or hound,
    Or cur of low degree.

And even if it includes the _fides Achates_, or parlor companions,

    Tray, Blanche, and Sweetheart,

the work of extirpation should proceed, to the extent of curtailing this
branch of farm-stock to its wholesome and legitimate proportions.




CHAPTER IX.

POULTRY.


Choice varieties of fowls add a pleasant feature to the farm premises.
They engage the attention and sympathy of the juvenile farmers, and the
time bestowed in the poultry yard keeps them from mischief: it is an
agreeable and salutary relief from toil and study, and elicits the
taste, the judgment, and the kindlier feelings of humanity, which are to
be matured in the future accomplished breeder. When properly managed,
poultry are a source of considerable profit, yielding more for the food
they consume, than any other stock, although their value is not often
considered. The agricultural statistics of the United States, for 1839,
give us over $12,000,000 in poultry, and it probably exceeds $15,000,000
at the present time. It is estimated by McQueen, that the poultry of
England exceeds $40,000,000, and yet McCulloch says she imports
60,000,000 eggs annually from France, (McQueen states it at near
70,000,000;) and from other parts of the continent, 25,000,000; besides
80,000,000 imported from Ireland. Poultry, then, ceases to be an
unimportant object of agricultural attention, and assumes its
appropriate place among the other staples of the farmer.


Hens

Are the most numerous and profitable, and the most generally useful of
the feathered tribe. The hen is peculiarly an egg-producing bird. She
has the same predisposition for laying, that the cow has for secreting
milk. Some breeds are better adapted for this object than others: but in
all that have ever come within our notice, the proper food and
circumstances are alone wanting, to produce a reasonable quantity of
eggs.

The _egg_ consists of three distinct parts; the shell, the white, and
the yolk. A good-sized egg will weigh 1,000 grains, of which about 107
are shell, 604 are white, and 289 are yolk. Of the shell, 97 per cent.
is carbonate of lime, 1 per cent. phosphate of lime and magnesia, and 2
per cent. albumen. The white consists of 12 per cent. of albumen, 2.7 of
mucus, 0.3 of salts, and 85 of water. The yolk has about 17.4 per cent.
of albumen, 28.6 of yellow oil, 54 of water, with a trace of sulphur and
phosphorus.

The foregoing are the constituents of eggs, which have been formed when
the bird has free access to the various articles which constitute her
natural food. But they vary with circumstances. When full-fed and denied
all access to lime, she will form an egg without the shell, and deliver
it enclosed in the membrane or sack which always surrounds the white,
when covered by the shell. When scantily fed, they will frequently lay;
but from a deficiency of nutriment, the egg will be meager and watery,
and possess but a small portion of the nutritious qualities peculiar to
them.

To produce the largest number of good eggs, several conditions are
important; and they must especially have an abundance of the right kind
of food. This is the most readily obtained in part from animal food. In
warm weather, when they have a free range, they can generally supply
their wants in the abundance of insects, earth-worms, and other animal
matters within their reach. The large proportion of albumen contained in
their eggs, requires that much of their food should be highly
nitrogenized, and when they cannot procure this in animal matter, it
must be given in grains containing it.

If to the usual qualities of hens, a breed of peculiar elegance, of
graceful form, and beautiful plumage, be added, together with entire
adaptation to the economical purposes required, good layers and good
carcass, we have a combination of utility, luxury, and taste in this
bird, which should commend them as general favorites. They can
everywhere be kept with advantage, except in dense cities. A hen that
costs a shilling or two, if provided with a suitable range, will consume
30 or 40 cents worth of food, and produce from 80 to 150 eggs per annum,
worth three or four times the cost of feed and attention.


The Food

Of hens may consist of different kinds of grain, either broken, ground,
or cooked; roots, and especially boiled potatoes, are nutritious and
economical; green herbage as clover and most of the grasses, chickweed,
lettuce, cabbage, &c., will supply them with much of their food, if
fresh and tender.

Fig. 40, is a Food fountain. The grain is placed in the hopper, which is
closely covered, and the grain falls into the bottom below. It is
accessible on four sides by spring doors, which are thrown open by the
weight of the fowl on the connecting spring. One is shown as opened by
the fowl in stepping up to feed. This is a protection against dirt and
vermin.

[Illustration: Fig. 40.

Food Fountain.]

Though not absolutely essential to them, yet nothing contributes so much
to their laying, as unsalted, animal food. This is a natural aliment, as
is shown by the avidity with which they pounce on every fly, insect, or
earth-worm which comes within their reach. It would not of course pay to
supply them with valuable flesh, but the blood and offal of the
slaughter-houses, refuse meat of all kinds, and especially the scraps or
cracklings to be had at the inciters' shops, after soaking for a few
hours in warm water, is one of the best and most economical kinds of
food. Such with boiled meal is a very fattening food. Grain is at all
times best for them when cooked, as they will lay more, fatten quicker,
and eat much less when fed to them in this state; and it may be thus
used unground, with the same advantage to the fowls as if first crushed,
as their digestive organs are certain to extract the whole nutriment.
All grain is good for them, including millet, rice, the oleaginous
seeds, as the sun-flower, flax, hemp, &c. It is always better to afford
them a variety of grains where they can procure them at their option,
and select as their appetite craves.

They are also fond of milk, and especially when it has become curdled;
and indeed scarcely any edible escapes their notice. They carefully pick
up most of the waste garbage around the premises, and glean much of
their subsistence from what would otherwise become offensive; and by
their destruction of innumerable insects and worms, they render great
assistance to the gardener. Of course their ever-busy propensity for
scratching, is indiscriminately indulged just after the seeds have been
sown and while the plants are young, which renders it necessary that
they be confined in some close yard for a time; yet this should be as
capacious as possible.

[Illustration: Fig. 41.

Water Fountain.]

Water is placed in the cask as represented in the Fig., and it is then
closely stopped, except an opening through a tube leading into a vessel
below. As the water is exhausted from this, it descends from the cask
above, and a supply is thus at all times within reach of the poultry.

Their food is better when given to them warm, not hot, and there should
always be a supply before them to prevent gorging. It is better to be
placed on shelves or suspended boxes or hoppers, which are variously and
cheaply constructed, to keep it clean and out of the reach of rats.
Besides their food, hens ought to be at all times abundantly supplied
with clean water, egg or pounded oyster shells, old mortar or slacked
lime. If not allowed to run at large, where they can help themselves,
they must also be furnished with gravel to assist their digestion; and a
box or bed of ashes, sand, and dust, is equally essential to roll in for
the purpose of ridding themselves of vermin.

[Illustration: Fig. 42.

Poultry House]


The Hen-house

May be constructed in various ways to suit the wishes of the owner, and
when tastefully built it is an ornament to the premises, It should be
perfectly dry throughout, properly lighted, and capable of being made
tight and warm in winter, yet afford all the ventilation desirable at
any season. In this, arrange the nests in boxes on the sides, in such a
manner as to humor the instinct of the hen for concealment when she
resorts to them. When desirable to set the hen, these nests may be so
placed as to shut out the others, yet open into another yard or beyond
the enclosure, so that they can take an occasional stroll and help
themselves to food, &c. This prevents other hens laying in their nests,
while setting; and it may be easily managed, by having their boxes
placed on the wall of the building, with a moveable door made to open
on either side at pleasure. Hens will lay equally well without a
nest-egg, but when broken up, they ramble off and form new nests, if
they are not confined. They will lay if kept from the cock, but it is
doubtful if they will thus yield as many eggs. Hens disposed to set at
improper times, should be dismissed from the common yard, so as to be
out of reach of the nests, and plentifully fed till weaned from this
inclination.

[Illustration: Fig. 43.

Egg-Hatcher, or Eccalobeon.]

Fig. 43 represents an egg-hatcher or Eccalobeon, made of different
sizes, with shelves so arranged as to hold from 200 to 800 eggs without
touching each other. The outer box is a non-conductor, so as to retain
the heat conveyed to every part by water tubes, connected by a reservoir
below, the bottom of which is heated by the flame from a spirit-lamp.
The temperature is indicated by a thermometer on the door inside, which
should be made equal to that of the hen, say about 106 deg. Fahrenheit. Her
natural temperature is somewhat elevated by the feverish condition of
the bird at the period of incubation.

_Chickens_ require to be kept warm and dry, for a few days after
hatching, and they may be fed with hard-boiled eggs, crumbs of bread or
pudding, and milk or water, and allowed to scratch in the gravel in
front of the hen, which should be confined in a coop for the first three
or four weeks. After this, they may be turned loose, when they will
thrive on any thing the older ones eat. Many use them for the table when
they are but a few weeks old; but they are unfit for this purpose, till
they have attained full maturity.

The white-legs are preferred by some, from the whiteness and apparent
delicacy of the meat; but the yellow-legged are the richest and most
highly-flavored. The color of the feathers does not seem to affect the
quality of the flesh or their character for laying. If we consider the
chemical principles of the absorption and retention of heat, we should
assume the white coat to be best, as it is coolest in summer when
exposed to the sun, and warmest in winter. Yet some of the white breeds
are delicate, and do not bear rough usage or exposure.

[Illustration: Fig. 44.

The Dorking]


Varieties.

These differ materially in their sizes, shapes, and colors.

The _Dorking_ is esteemed one of the best, being large, well formed and
hardy, good layers and nurses, and yielding an excellent carcass. They
are both white and speckled, and generally have five toes.

The _Poland_ is both white and black, with a large tuft, generally of
white feathers, on the head. They are of good size, and excellent
layers, but are seldom inclined to set, which makes them peculiarly
desirable for such as wish eggs only.

The _Dominique_ is a speckled fowl, of barely medium size, compact,
hardy, good layers, and valuable for the table. The _Bucks county
fowls_, heretofore principally reared near Philadelphia, possess but
moderate pretensions to notice, except in their immense size, a brace of
capons having been fattened to 191/4 lbs. when dressed.

[Illustration: Fig. 45.

The Bantam.]

The _Bantam_ is but little larger than a pigeon, and is usually of a
pure white, but is sometimes speckled. It is generally feathered to the
toes, but may be bred with clean legs. It is very domestic, and a
pleasant little bird around the premises, and is not unprofitable. The
_Game cock_ is of medium weight, and yields good flesh, but is a poor
layer, and an undesirable tenant for the farm-yard. Besides these, there
are many fanciful varieties, as the _Creeper_, with excessively short
legs; the _Rumpless_, without a tail; the _Frizzled_, with irregular
feathers turned towards the head; the _Silky_ or _Merino_ fowl, with
brown or buff down, instead of feathers; the _Negro_, with its black
crest, wattles, skin, legs, and feathers; the _Java_ and _Cochin China_,
of great size; several varieties of the _Top-knot_, and others.


The Diseases of Hens.

These are not numerous or complicated, and may be mostly avoided by
proper treatment and food, which are indicated with sufficient
minuteness in the foregoing observations.

_Gapes_ or _Pip_ is generally owing to drinking unwholesome or dirty
water. Remove the white blister on the tip of the tongue, and wash with
sharp vinegar, diluted with warm water; or compel the bird to swallow a
large lump of fresh butter, mixed with Scotch snuff. It has been cured
by opening the mouth and forcing a pigeon feather, with a tuft of the
feathers left on the end, (the others having been stripped off,) down
the windpipe, and gently turning it as withdrawn, to be repeated the
following day if necessary. This detaches large numbers of a slender red
worm, collected in the larynx of the throat, which impedes respiration
and swallowing. A little spirits of turpentine mixed with the food is a
preventive; as are also clean, whitewashed premises, and good food.
After these attacks, feed for a few days with light food, soaked bran
and cabbage, or lettuce chopped fine.

_Roup_, _Catarrh_, or _swelled head_, is shown by feverish symptoms,
swollen eyelids, frequently terminating in blindness, rattling in the
throat, and temporary strangulation. These are accompanied with a highly
offensive watery discharge, from the mouth and nostrils, loss of
appetite, and much thirst. They should be placed near the fire; their
head bathed in warm Castile soap-suds, or milk and water. Stimulating
food, as flour or barley-meal, mustard and grated ginger, mixed and
forced down the throat, Boswell says, has been effectual in their speedy
restoration. This, like many other diseases, is contagious, and when it
appears, the bird should be at once separated from the flock.

_Flux_ is cured by the yolk of an egg boiled hard; and boiled barley
soaked in wine.

_Costiveness_ is removed by giving bran and water with a little honey;
or give a small dose of castor oil.

_Vermin_ are destroyed by giving them clean sand and ashes to roll in,
adding a little quicklime if necessary.

_Entire cleanliness_ is necessary for the avoidance of this and other
diseases. A perfectly dry range is also essential, nor should there be
too many together, as this is a fruitful source of disease.


THE TURKEY.

This bird was unknown to the civilized world till the discovery of this
Continent. It was found here both in its wild and domesticated state;
and still occupies the whole range of the western hemisphere, though the
wild turkey disappears as the country becomes settled. The wild is
larger than the domesticated bird, sometimes weighing over 30 lbs.
dressed. The color of the male is generally a greenish brown,
approaching to black, and of a rich, changeable, metallic lustre. The
hen is marked somewhat like the cock, but with duller hues.
Domestication through successive generations dims the brilliancy of
their plumage, and lessens their size and hardiness. It also produces a
variety of colors, though they are mostly of a black, buff, pure white,
or speckled.

They give evidence of the comparative recency of their domestication, in
the instinct which frequently impels the cock to brood and take care of
the young. Nothing is more common than for the male bird to supply the
place of the hen, when any accident befalls her, and to bring up a
family of young chicks with an equally instinctive regard for their
helplessness and safety.

The flesh of this bird, both wild and tame, is exceedingly delicate and
palatable; and though not possessing the high game flavor of some of the
smaller wild-fowl, and especially of the aquatic, as the canvass-back
duck, &c., it exceeds them in its digestibility and healthfulness. The
turkey is useful principally for its flesh, as it seldom lays over a
nest-full of eggs in one season, when they brood on these and bring up
their young. If full-fed, and their first eggs are withdrawn from them,
they frequently lay a second time.


Breeding.

Those intended for breeders should be compact, vigorous, and large,
without being long-legged. They should be daily, yet lightly fed through
the winter, on grain and roots, and some animal food is always
acceptable and beneficial to them. They are small eaters, and without
caution will soon get too fat. One vigorous male will suffice for a
flock of 10 or 12 hens, and a single connection is sufficient for each.
They begin to lay on the approach of warm weather, laying once a day, or
every other day, till they have completed their litter; which in the
young or indifferently fed, may be 10 or 12, and in the older ones,
sometimes reaches 20. The hen is sly in secreting her nest, but usually
selects a dry, well-protected place. She is an inveterate setter, and
carefully hatches most of her eggs.

The young may be allowed to remain for 24 hours without eating, then fed
with hard-boiled eggs made fine, or crumbs of wheat bread. Boiled milk,
curds, and buttermilk afford an excellent food. As they get stronger,
oat or barley-meal is suitable, but Indian-meal, uncooked, is hurtful to
them when quite young. They are very tender, and will bear neither cold
nor wet, and it is of course necessary to confine the old one for the
first few weeks. When able to shift for themselves, they may wander over
the fields at pleasure; and from their great fondness for insects, they
will rid the meadows of innumerable grasshoppers, bugs, and beetles,
which often do incalculable damage to the farmer. Early chickens are
sufficiently grown to fatten the latter part of autumn or the beginning
of winter, which is easily done on any of the grains or boiled roots.
Both are better for being cooked. They require a higher roosting-place
than hens, and are impatient of too close confinement, preferring the
ridge of a barn, or a lofty tree, to the circumscribed limits of the
ordinary poultry-house. When rightly managed and fed, turkeys are
subject to few maladies; and even these, careful attention will soon
remove.


THE PEACOCK AND GUINEA-HEN.

The _Peacock_ is undoubtedly the most showy of the feathered race. It is
a native of the southern part of Asia, and is still found wild in the
islands of Java and Ceylon, and some parts of the interior of Africa.
They are an ornament to the farm premises, and are useful in destroying
reptiles, insects, and garbage; but they are quarrelsome in the
poultry-yard, and destructive in the garden. Their flesh is coarse and
dark, and they are worthless as layers. The brilliant silvery green and
their ever-varying colors give place to an entire white, in one of the
varieties.

The _Guinea-hen_ is a native of Africa and the southern part of Asia,
where it abounds in its wild state. Most of them are beautifully and
uniformly speckled; but occasionally they are white on the breast, like
the Pintados of the West India Islands, and some are entirely white.
They are unceasingly garrulous; and their excessively pugnacious
character renders them uncomfortable inmates with the other poultry.
Their flesh, though high-colored, is delicate and palatable, but, like
the peacock, they are indifferent layers. Both are natives of a warm
climate, and the young are tender and rather difficult to rear. Neither
of these birds is a general favorite, and we omit further notice of
them.


THE GOOSE.

There are many varieties of the goose. Main enumerates twenty-two, most
of which are wild; and the tame are again variously subdivided. The
_common white_ and _gray_ are the most numerous and profitable. The
_white Bremen_ is much larger, often weighing over 20 lbs. net. It is of
a beautiful snowy plumage, is domestic and reared without difficulty,
though not as prolific and hardy as the former. The _China Goose_ is
smaller than the gray, and one of the most beautiful of the family,
possessing much of the gracefulness and general appearance of the swan.
It is prolific and tolerably hardy, but has not thus far been a
successful rival with the first. The _Guinea_ or _African goose_ is the
largest of the species, and equals the size of the swan, often dressing
over 25 lbs. It is a majestic and graceful bird, and very ornamental to
water scenery. Several other varieties are domesticated in the United
States.


Breeding.

Geese pair frequently at one year old, and rear their young; but with
some kinds, especially of the wild, this is deferred till two and
sometimes three. They require a warm, dry place for their nests, and
when undisturbed, they will sit steadily; and if the eggs have not been
previously chilled or addled, they will generally hatch them all, if
kept on the nest. To insure this, it is sometimes necessary to withdraw
the first hatched, to prevent the old ones wandering before all are out.
The young should be kept in a warm sheltered place till two or three
weeks old, if the weather be cold or unsettled. The best food for the
goslings, is barley or oat, or boiled Indian meal and bread. Milk is
also good for them. They require green food, and are fond of lettuce,
young clover, and fresh tender grass; and after a few weeks, if they
have a free range on this, they will forage for themselves.

Geese are not a profitable bird to raise, unless in places where they
can procure their own subsistence, or at least during the greater part
of the year. This they are enabled to do, wherever there are extensive
commons of unpastured lands, or where there are streams or ponds, lakes
or marshes with shoal sedgy banks. In these, they will live and fatten
throughout the year, if unobstructed by ice. They may be fed on all
kinds of grain and edible roots, but it is more economical to give them
their food cooked. The well-fattened gosling affords one of the most
savory dishes for the table.

Geese live to a great age. They have been known to exceed 100 years. If
allowed a free range on good food and clean water, they will seldom get
diseased. When well fed, they yield nearly a pound of good feathers in a
season, at three or four pluckings; and the largest varieties even
exceed this quantity.


DUCKS

Are more hardy and independent of attention than the goose, and they are
generally the most profitable. They are omnivorous, and greedily eat
every thing which will afford them nourishment, though they seldom
forage on the grasses like the goose, when they can procure other food.
They are peculiarly carnivorous, and devour all kinds of meat, putrid or
fresh; and are especially fond of fish, and such insects, worms, and
other creeping things, as they can find imbedded in the mud or
elsewhere. They will often distend their crop with young frogs, almost
to the ordinary size of their bodies. Their indiscriminate appetite
often renders them unfit for the table, unless fattened out of the reach
of garbage and offensive matters. An English admiral used to resort to
well-fattened rats for his fresh meat when at sea, and justified his
taste by saying, they were more cleanly feeders than ducks, which were
general favorites.

The most profitable for domestic use, is undoubtedly the _common black
duck_. They lay profusely in the spring, when well fed, often producing
40 or 50 eggs, and sometimes a greater number, if kept from setting.
They are much larger than those of the hen, and equally rich and
nourishing, but far less delicate. They are careless in their habits,
and generally drop their eggs wherever they happen to be through the
night, whether in the water, the road, or farm-yard; and as might be
expected from such prodigality of character, they are indifferent
setters and nurses.

The _ducklings_ are better reared by setting the eggs under a sedate,
experienced hen, as the longer time necessary for hatching, requires
patience in the foster-mother to develop the young chick. They should be
confined for a few days, and away from the water. At first they may be
fed with bread, or pudding made from boiled oat, barley, or Indian meal;
and they soon acquire strength and enterprise enough to shift for
themselves, if afterwards supplied with pond or river water. They are
fit for the table when fully grown, and well fattened on clean grain.
This is more economically accomplished by feeding it cooked.

_The varieties_ of ducks are almost innumerable. Main describes 31, and
some naturalists number over 100. Besides the black duck above
described, several others, as the _light gray_, the _white duck_, and
some of the _tufted_, are prolific, hardy, and profitable.

We omit further notice of other varieties; and of the swan, brant,
pigeons, &c., as not profitable for general rearing, and only suited to
ornamental grounds.

       *       *       *       *       *

Transcriber's Notes

Page 49; Figure 14 caption: "Sessamoid" changed to "Sesamoid" (18.
Sesamoid bones.)

Page 59: "he" changed to "be" (effectual remedies for the removal of
disease cannot be applied)

Page 174: added missing open quotes ("Setons are sometimes useful ...)

Page 215: "When-full fed" changed to "When full-fed" (When full-fed and
denied all access to lime, ...)





End of the Project Gutenberg EBook of Domestic Animals, by Richard L. Allen

*** 